Omron Microswitch PDF
Omron Microswitch PDF
Omron Microswitch PDF
X018-E1-08
Basic Switches
Basic Switches
OM R ON Corporation
Shiokoji Horikawa, Shimogyo-ku,
Kyoto, 600-8530 Japan
Electronic Components Company
Switch Division
Detection Switch Department
Tel: (81)75-344-7096/Fax: (81)75-344-7049
Industrial Automation Company
Industrial Devices and Components Division H.Q.
Industrial Control Components Department
Tel: (81)75-344-7119/Fax: (81)75-344-7149
In the interest of product improvement, specifications are
subject to change without notice.
Authorized Distributor:
Printed in Japan
0704-3M (O)
THAILAND
OMRON ELECTRONICS CO., LTD.
Rasa Tower 20th Floor, #555 Phaholyothin Rd.,
Chatuchak, Bangkok 10900 THAILAND
Tel: 66-2-937-0500/Fax: 66-2-937-0501
OMRON ELECTRONIC COMPONENTS CO., LTD. (*)
Phaholythin Place Building, 41st Floor, 408/166,
Phaholythin Road, Samsen-nai, Phayathai,
Bangkok 10400 THAILAND
Tel: 66-2-619-0292/Fax: 66-2-619-0624-5
VIETNAM
OMRON ASIA PACIFIC PTE. LTD.
HANOI/HCM REPRESENTATIVE OFFICE
2, Lang Ha, 6th Floor Vinaconex Building, Hanoi
Vietnam
Tel: 844-831-3121/Fax: 844-831-3122
AUSTRALIA
OMRON ELECTRONICS PTY. LTD.
71 Epping Road, North Ryde, Sydney NSW 2113
AUSTRALIA
Tel: 61-2-9878-6377/Fax: 61-2-9878-6981
NEW ZEALAND
OMRON ELECTRONICS LTD.
65 Boston Road, Mt Eden Auckland
NEW ZEALAND
Tel: 64-9-358-4400/Fax:64-9-358-4411
NORTH/SOUTH AMERICA
UNITED STATES
OMRON ELECTRONICS LLC
One Commerce Drive Schaumburg, IL 60173-5302
U.S.A.
Tel: 1-847-843-7900/Fax: 1-847-843-7787
OMRON ELECTRONIC COMPONENTS LLC (*)
55 East Commerce Drive, Suit B, IL 60173 U.S.A.
Tel: 1-847-882-2288/Fax: 1-847-882-2192
CANADA
OMRON CANADA INC.
885 Milner Avenue, Scarborough, Ontario, M1B 5V8
CANADA
Tel: 1-416-286-6465/Fax: 1-416-286-6648
BRAZIL
OMRON ELECTRONICA DO BRASIL LTDA.
Av. Santa Catarina, 935 04378-300
So Paulo-SP-BRAZIL
Tel: 55-11-5564-6488/Fax: 55-11-5564-7751
EUROPE
AUSTRIA
OMRON Electronics G.m.b.H
Brunner Strasse 81, Box 323, A-1230 Vienna
AUSTRIA
Tel: 43-1-801-90-0/Fax: 43-1-804-48-46
BELGIUM
OMRON ELECTRONICS NV/SA
Stationsstraat 24 B-1702 Groot-Bijgaarden
BELGIUM
Tel: 32-2-4662-480/Fax: 32-2-4660-687
CZECH REPUBLIC
OMRON ELECTRONICS Spol.s.r.o.
Jankovcova 53, 170 00
CZECH REPUBLIC
Tel: 420-234-602-602/Fax: 420-234-602-607
DENMARK
OMRON ELECTRONICS A/S
Lykkebaekvej 2, DK-4600 Koege DENMARK
Tel: 45-43-44-0011/45-43-44-0211
FINLAND
OMRON ELECTRONICS OY
Metsnpojankuja 5, FIN-02130 Espoo FINLAND
Tel: 358-9-5495-800/Fax: 358-9-5495-8150
FRANCE
OMRON ELECTRONICS S.a.r.l.
14, Rue de Lisbonne 93110 Rosny Sous Bois
FRANCE
Tel: 33-1-4974-7000/Fax: 33-1-4876-0930
OMRON ELECTRONIC COMPONENTS EUROPE
B.V. (*)
14, Rue de Lisbonne 93110 Rosny Sous Bois
FRANCE
Tel: 33-1-4974-7050/Fax: 33-1-4876-2795
GERMANY
OMRON ELECTRONICS G.m.b.H.
Elisabeth-Selbert-Strasse 17, 40764 Langenfeld
GERMANY
Tel: 49-2173-6800-0/Fax: 49-2173-6800-400
OMRON ELECTRONIC COMPONENTS EUROPE
B.V. (*)
Gruber Strasse 60d, 85586 Poing GERMANY
Tel: 49-8121-77240/Fax: 49-8121-772440
HUNGARY
OMRON ELECTRONICS Kft.
H-1046 Budapest Kiss Erno u. 1-3 HUNGARY
Tel: 36-1-399-3050/Fax: 36-1-399-3060
ITALY
OMRON ELECTRONICS S.p.A.
Viale Certosa, 49 20149 Milano ITALY
Tel: 39-02-32681/Fax: 39-02-325154
OMRON ELECTRONIC COMPONENTS EUROPE
B.V. (*)
Viale Certosa, 49 20149 Milano ITALY
Tel: 39-02-3268-850/Fax: 39-02-3268-851
THE NETHERLANDS
OMRON ELECTRONICS B.V.
Wegalaan 61, 2132 JD Hoofddorp, Postbus 582
2130 AN Hoofddorp THE NETHERLANDS
Tel: 31-23-568-1100/Fax: 31-23-568-1188
OMRON ELECTRONIC COMPONENTS EUROPE
B.V. (*)
Wegalaan 57, 2132 JD Hoofddorp
THE NETHERLANDS
Tel: 31-23-568-1200/Fax: 31-23-568-1212
NORWAY
OMRON ELECTRONICS NORWAY AS
Ole Deviksvei 4, P. O. Box 109, Bryn, N-0611 Oslo
NORWAY
Tel: 47-2265-7500/Fax: 47-2265-8300
POLAND
OMRON ELECTRONICS SP.Z.O.O
ul. Jana Sengera "Cichego" 1, 02-790 Warsaw
POLAND
Tel: 48-22- 645-7860/Fax: 48-22-645-7863
PORTUGAL
OMRON ELECTRONICS LDA.
Rua de S. Tom, Lote 131 2689-510 Prior-Velho
PORTUGAL
Tel: 351-21-942-9400/Fax: 351-21-941-7899
SPAIN
OMRON ELECTRONICS S.A.
c/Arturo Soria 95, E-28027 Madrid SPAIN
Tel: 34-91-377-7900/Fax: 34-91-377-7956
OMRON ELECTRONIC COMPONENTS EUROPE
B.V. (*)
c/Arturo Soria 95, E-28027 Madrid SPAIN
Tel: 34-91-377-7900/Fax: 34-91-377-7987
SWEDEN
OMRON ELECTRONICS AB
Norgegatan 1, P. O. Box 1275, SE-164 29 Kista
SWEDEN
Tel: 46-8-632-3500/Fax: 46-8-632-3510
OMRON ELECTRONIC COMPONENTS EUROPE
B.V. (*)
Norgegatan 1, S-164 32 Kista SWEDEN
Tel: 46-8-632-3500/Fax: 46-8-632-3535
SWITZERLAND
OMRON ELECTRONICS AG
Sennweidstrasse 44 CH-6312 Steinhausen
SWITZERLAND
Tel: 41-41-748-1313/Fax: 41-41-748-1345
TURKEY
OMRON ELECTRONICS LTD.
Altunizade, Kisikli Cad. No: 2 A-Blok K. 2 TR-34662
Uskudar - Istanbul TURKEY
Tel: 90-216-474-00-40/Fax: 90-216-474-00-47
UNITED KINGDOM
OMRON ELECTRONICS LTD.
Opal Drive, Fox Milne, Milton Keynes MK15 ODG
UNITED KINGDOM
Tel: 44-1908-258-258/Fax: 44-1908-258-158
OMRON ELECTRONIC COMPONENTS EUROPE
B.V. (*)
1 Bishop Square, Hatfield Business Park, Hatfield,
Hertfordshire AL10 9NE United Kingdom
Tel: 44-870-750-5661/Fax: 44-870-750-5662
NOTE:
1.
2.
3.
4.
(*)
LIMITATIONS OF LIABILITY
OMRON SHALL NOT BE RESPONSIBLE FOR SPECIAL, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, LOSS OF
PROFITS, OR COMMERCIAL LOSS IN ANY WAY CONNECTED WITH THE PRODUCTS, WHETHER SUCH CLAIM IS
BASED ON CONTRACT, WARRANTY, NEGLIGENCE, OR STRICT LIABILITY.
In no event shall the responsibility of OMRON for any act exceed the individual price of the product on which liability is
asserted.
IN NO EVENT SHALL OMRON BE RESPONSIBLE FOR WARRANTY, REPAIR, OR OTHER CLAIMS REGARDING THE
PRODUCTS UNLESS OMRON'S ANALYSIS CONFIRMS THAT THE PRODUCTS WERE PROPERLY HANDLED,
STORED, INSTALLED, AND MAINTAINED AND NOT SUBJECT TO CONTAMINATION, ABUSE, MISUSE, OR
INAPPROPRIATE MODIFICATION OR REPAIR.
Application Considerations
Application Considerations
SUITABILITY FOR USE
OMRON shall not be responsible for conformity with any standards, codes, or regulations that apply to the combination
of products in the customer's application or use of the products.
At the customer's request, OMRON will provide applicable third party certification documents identifying ratings and
limitations of use that apply to the products. This information by itself is not sufficient for a complete determination of the
suitability of the products in combination with the end product, machine, system, or other application or use.
The following are some examples of applications for which particular attention must be given. This is not intended to be
an exhaustive list of all possible uses of the products, nor is it intended to imply that the uses listed may be suitable for
the products.
Outdoor use, uses involving potential chemical contamination or electrical interference, or conditions or uses not
described in this catalog.
Nuclear energy control systems, combustion systems, railroad systems, aviation systems, medical equipment, amusement machines, vehicles, safety equipment, and installations subject to separate industry or government regulations.
Systems, machines, and equipment that could present a risk to life or property.
Please know and observe all prohibitions of use applicable to the products.
NEVER USE THE PRODUCTS FOR AN APPLICATION INVOLVING SERIOUS RISK TO LIFE OR PROPERTY
WITHOUT ENSURING THAT THE SYSTEM AS A WHOLE HAS BEEN DESIGNED TO ADDRESS THE RISKS, AND
THAT THE OMRON PRODUCTS ARE PROPERLY RATED AND INSTALLED FOR THE INTENDED USE WITHIN THE
OVERALL EQUIPMENT OR SYSTEM.
Disclaimers
Disclaimers
PERFORMANCE DATA
Performance data given in this catalog is provided as a guide for the user in determining suitability and does not constitute
a warranty. It may represent the result of OMRON's test conditions, and the users must correlate it to actual application
requirements. Actual performance is subject to the OMRON Warranty and Limitations of Liability.
CHANGE IN SPECIFICATIONS
Product specifications and accessories may be changed at any time based on improvements and other reasons.
It is our practice to change model numbers when published ratings or features are changed, or when significant
construction changes are made. However, some specifications of the products may be changed without any notice. When
in doubt, special model numbers may be assigned to fix or establish key specifications for your application on your request.
Please consult with your OMRON representative at any time to confirm actual specifications of purchased products.
Basic Switches
CONTENTS
Selection Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Basic Switches
General-purpose Basic Switches
Z . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
X . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
DZ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
TZ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Z/A/X/DZ Common Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Miniature Basic Switches
D3V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
VX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
D2MV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
K . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
D2RV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
D3V/V/VX/D2MV/K/D2RV Common Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . 152
D2MC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Subminiature Basic Switches
D3M . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
SS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
SS-P . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
SSG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
D2S . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Ultra Subminiature Basic Switches
D2F . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
J . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
D2MQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
Sealed Basic Switches
D2VW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
D2SW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
D2SW-P . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
D2HW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
D2JW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
D2FW-G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Detection Switches
D2A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
D3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
D2X . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
D3K . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
Door Switches
D3D . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
D2D . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
D2T . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
Connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
4
Selection Guide
Selection Guide
Selection by Functions
Classifications
Model
Appearance
24.2
49.2
Z-15H2
Features
Z-15H
Z-15G
Z-15E
Z-01H
Contact
Z-10FY
Z-15ER
Split-contact
model
Maintained
contact
model
Contact
specification
Rivet
Single
crossbar
Rivet
Contact material
Silver
Gold alloy
Silver
Rating
g
( i ti load)
(resistive
l d)
15 A at 250 VAC
0.1 A at
125 VAC
10 A at
250 VAC
(series
connection)
15 A at
250 VAC
(160 mA at
5 VDC)
4.46 to
7.26 N
(160 mA at
5 VDC)
1.96 to
2.50 N
Max. operating
current (A)
0.5 A at
125 VDC
0.75 A at
125 VDC
20
15
10
8
5
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.1
Min.
permissible
load (mA)
100
10
1
0.1
0.01
(1 mA at
5 VDC)
(160 mA at 5 VDC)
6.12 to
7.85 N
2.45 N
Drip-proof:
3.43 N
20 x 106 min.
300 x 103
min.
10 x 106
min.
500 x 103
min.
300 x 103
min.
100 x 103
min.
500 x 103
min.
100 x 103
min.
100 x 103
min.
1.96 to 2.75 N
Durability
(see note)
o e)
Mechanical
Electrical
2.45 to 3.43 N
Drip-proof:
2.45 to 4.22 N
Mounting pitch
25.4 mm
Actuators
Pin plunger
Pin plunger
Hinge lever
Panel mount
plunger
Roller leaf
spring
Panel mount
roller plunger
Hinge roller
lever
Leaf spring
Fixible rod
25C to 80C
(Drip-proof: 15C to 80C)
Pin plunger
Pin plunger
Panel mount
plunger
Pin plunger
Panel mount
plunger
Panel mount
roller plunger
Panel mount
plunger
Panel mount
roller plunger
Roller leaf
spring
Hinge lever
Roller leaf
spring
Pin plunger
Hinge lever
Hinge roller
lever
Terminals
Solder
Screw
Page
32
Note:
Screw
Solder
Selection Guide
Selection Guide
Classifications
Model
DZ
TZ
Appearance
Approx. 17
24.2
49.2
22.7
24.2
30
49.2
Features
Contact
49.2
17.45
High-capacity load
switching
Direct current
switching.
Contact specification
Rivet
Built-in permanent
magnet for
extinguishing arc.
Cylinder+flat surface
Contact material
Silver alloy
Silver alloy
Rating
(resistive load)
20 A at 250 VAC
10 A at 125 VDC
Max. operating
current (A)
49.2
17.45
17.45
Stable operation at
400C.
Rivet
Rivet
Silver alloy
Platinum
10 A at 250 VAC
1 A at 250 VAC
20
15
10
8
5
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.1
Min.
permissible
load (mA)
100
10
1
0.1
0.01
Durability
y
(
(see
note)
t )
Mechanical
Electrical
(160 mA at 5 VDC)
(160 mA at 5 VDC)
(160 mA at 5 VDC)
(20 mA at 5 VDC)
3.92 to 6.13 N
5.00 N
5.59 N
4.90 N
1 x 106 min.
1 x 106 min.
1 x 106 min.
1 x 105 min.
500 x
103
min.
100 x
103
min.
500 x
103
min.
50 x 103 min.
25C to 80C
25C to 80C
25C to 80C
65C to 400C
Mounting pitch
25.4 mm
25.4 mm
25.4 mm
25.4 mm
Actuators
Pin plunger
Pin plunger
Panel mount
plunger
Panel mount
plunger
Panel mount
roller plunger
Panel mount
roller plunger
Hinge lever
Leaf spring
Hinge roller
lever
Hinge lever
Hinge roller
lever
Pin plunger
Pin plunger
Hinge lever
Hinge lever
Hinge roller
lever
Hinge roller
lever
Terminals
Solder
Screw
Solder
Screw
Solder
Screw
Screw
Page
63
70
78
83
Note:
Selection Guide
Selection Guide
Classifications
Model
D3V
Appearance
27.8
10.3
27.8
10.3
15.9
15.9
V-21
Features
V-11
V-10
Contact specification
Rivet
Rivet
Contact material
Silver alloy
Silver alloy
Rating
(resistive load)
16 A at 250 VAC
21 A at
250 VAC
Max. operating
current (A)
V-15
Contact
V-16
Silver
16 A at
250 VAC
15 A at
250 VAC
11 A at
250 VAC
10 A at
250 VAC
0.98 N
{100 gf}
0.98, 1.96 N
{100, 200 gf}
20
15
10
8
5
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.1
Min.
permissible
load (mA)
100
10
1
0.1
0.01
(160 mA at 5 VDC)
(160 mA at 5 VDC)
1.96 N
{200 gf}
3.92 N
{400 gf}
Durability
y
(
t )
(see
note)
Mechanical
10 x 106 min.
50 x 106 min.
Electrical
25C to 105C
Mounting pitch
10.3 x 22.2 mm
10.3 x 22.2 mm
Actuators
Pin plunger
Pin plunger
Hinge lever
Hinge lever
Simulated roller
lever
Simulated roller
lever
Hinge roller
lever
Hinge roller
lever
Terminals
Solder,
Quick-connect (#187),
Quick-connect (#250)
Quick-connect (#250)
Page
92
110
Note:
Selection Guide
Selection Guide
Classifications
Model
VX
D2MV
Appearance
27.8
10.3
10.3
10.3
15.9
15.9
43.3
15.9
31.8
VX-5
VX-01
Features
Contact
D2MV-1
D2MV-01
Contact specification
Rivet
Crossbar
Needle
Crossbar
Rivet
Contact material
Silver alloy
Gold alloy
Silver
Gold alloy
Silver
Rating
(resistive load)
5 A at
250 VAC
0.1 A at
30 VDC
1 A at
125 VAC
0.1 A at
30 VDC
3 A at 250 VAC
Max. operating
current (A)
20
15
10
8
5
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.1
Min.
permissible
load (mA)
100
10
1
0.1
0.01
(160 mA
at 5 VDC)
0.25, 0.49 N
{25, 50 gf}
(1 mA at
5 VDC)
0.25 N
{25 gf}
10 x 106 min.
20 x 106 min.
(160 mA at 5 VDC)
Mechanical
50 x 106 min.
Electrical
25C to 80C
25C to 80C
25C to 80C
Mounting pitch
10.3 x 22.2 mm
10.3 x 22.2 mm
10.3 x 22.2 mm
Durability
(see note)
10 x 106 min.
(30 mA at
(1 mA at
5 VDC)
5 VDC)
0.10, 0.25, 0.49 N
{10, 25, 50 gf}
1 x 106 min.
Actuators
Pin plunger
Pin plunger
Pin plunger
Hinge lever
Hinge lever
Hinge lever
Simulated roller
lever
Simulated roller
lever
Hinge roller
lever
Simulated roller
lever
Hinge roller
lever
Hinge roller
lever
Terminals
Solder
Solder
Page
126
133
140
Note:
Selection Guide
Selection Guide
Classifications
Model
D2RV
D2MC
Appearance
31
27.8
10.3
17.5
15.9
14.4
D2MC-5
Features
D2MC-01
Contact
Contact specification
Reed switch
Contact material
Rating
(resistive load)
Max. operating
current (A)
0.1 A at 30 VDC
20
15
10
8
5
Rivet
Crossbar
Silver alloy
Gold alloy
5 A at 250 VAC
0.5 A at 30 VDC
Ratings
Switching voltage: 100 VDC max.
Switching current: 0.25 ADC max.
Contact capacity: 10 W DC max.
Min. applicable load: 0.1 mA at 5 VDC
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.1
Min.
permissible
load (mA)
100
10
1
0.1
0.01
(1 mA at 5 VDC)
(160 mA at 5 VDC)
Durability
(see note)
Mechanical
10 x 106 min.
10 x 106 min.
Electrical
3 x 106 min.
10C to 60C
25C to 80C
Mounting pitch
10.3 x 22.2 mm
8.7 x 23.8 mm
Actuators
Pin plunger
Hinge lever
Rotary action
Simulated roller
lever
Hinge roller
lever
Terminals
Solder
Quick-connect (#205)
Page
145
156
Note:
Selection Guide
Selection Guide
Classifications
Model
D3M
SS
Appearance
SS-P
19.8
6.4
11
29.2
10
10.2
9.5
19.8
6.4
SS-10
Quick-connect terminals
and horizontal terminal
layout ensure easy
wiring and save
mounting space.
Features
SS-5
SS-01
SS-01P
Contact
SS-3P
Contact specification
Crossbar
Rivet
Crossbar
Rivet
Crossbar
Contact material
Gold alloy
Silver alloy
Silver
Gold alloy
Silver alloy
Gold alloy
Rating
(resistive load)
0.1 A at 30 VDC
10.1 A at
250 VAC
3 A at
250 VAC
0.1 A at 30
VDC
3 A at 125
VAC
0.1 A at 30
VDC
(160 mA at 5 VDC)
(1 mA at
5 VDC)
Max. operating
current (A)
20
15
10
8
5
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.1
Min.
permissible
load (mA)
100
10
1
0.1
0.01
(1 mA at 5 VDC)
(160 mA
at 5 VDC)
1.50 N
{153 gf}
1.47 N
{150 gf}
0.49, 1.47
N {50, 150
gf}
Durability
(see note)
o e)
Mechanical
10 x 106
min.
30 x 106 min.
1 x 106 min.
Electrical
50 x 103
min.
70 x 103 min.
25C to 85C
25C to 85C
25C to 85C
Mounting pitch
9.5 mm
9.5 mm
9.5 mm
(1 mA at
5 VDC)
200 x 103
min.
Actuators
Pin plunger
Pin plunger
Hinge lever
Hinge lever
Pin plunger
Simulated roller
lever
Simulated roller
lever
Hinge lever
Hinge roller
lever
Hinge roller
lever
Simulated roller
lever
Terminals
XA Connector (JST)
Page
161
168
176
Note:
10
Selection Guide
Selection Guide
Classifications
Model
SSG
D2S
Appearance
6.4
6.4
19.8
19.8
9.7
9.9
9.0
9.1
SSG-5
Features
SSG-01
D2S-10
D2S-5
D2S-01
Flux-resistant structure.
Available with self-clinching PCB or solder terminals.
Contact
Contact specification
Rivet
Crossbar
Rivet
Contact material
Silver alloy
PGS alloy
Silver alloy
Silver
Gold alloy
Rating
(resistive load)
3 A at
250 VAC
10.1 A at
250 VAC
3 A at 250 VAC
0.1 A at 30 VDC
Max. operating
current (A)
Crossbar
20
15
10
8
5
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.1
Min.
permissible
load (mA)
100
10
1
0.1
0.01
(160 mA
at 5 VDC)
0.50, 1.50 N
{51, 153 gf}
(1 mA at 5 VDC)
(160 mA at 5 VDC)
1.47 N
{150 gf}
0.49, 1.47 N
{50, 150 gf}
Mechanical
10 x 106 min.
10 x 106 min.
30 x 106 min.
Electrical
50 x 103 min.
25C to 125C
25C to 85C
Mounting pitch
9.5 mm
9.5 mm
Durability
y
((see note)
t )
(1 mA at 5 VDC)
Actuators
Pin plunger
Pin plunger
Hinge lever
Hinge lever
Simulated roller
lever
Simulated roller
lever
Hinge roller
lever
Hinge roller
lever
Terminals
Solder,
Quick-connect (#110), PCB
Page
182
190
Note:
11
Selection Guide
Selection Guide
Classifications
Model
D2F
Appearance
D2MQ
12.7
5.7
6.5
5.1
8.9
6.5
2.7
8.2
Low force
Micro load
D2F (-*)
D2F-F*
D2F-01*
12.7
Silver
plated
l t d
Gold p
plated
Ultra subminiature
model capable of
switching
large-capacity loads
(7 A, 250 VAC).
Contact specification
Crossbar
Contact material
Silver alloy
Rating
(resistive load)
3 A at
125 VAC
Features
Contact
Standard
Flux-resistant structure.
Max. operating
current (A)
1 A at
125 VAC
Rivet
Rivet
Gold alloy
Silver plated
Gold plated
0.1 A at
30 VDC
7 A at 250 VAC
0.5 A at
30 VDC
50 mA at
30 VDC
20
15
10
8
5
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.1
Min.
permissible
load (mA)
100
10
1
0.1
0.01
1.37 N
{140 gf}
(50 mA at
5 VDC)
1.18 N
{120 gf}
1 x 106 min.
10 x 106 min.
30 x 103 min.
103
103
10 x 103 min.
(100 mA at 5 VDC)
1.47 N
{150 gf}
Durability
y
(
(see
note)
t )
Mechanical
Electrical
30 x
0.74 N
{75 gf}
(1 mA at
5 VDC)
0.74, 1.47 N
{75, 150 gf}
min.
(30 mA at 5 VDC)
50 x
min.
(5 mA at
5 VDC)
25C to 65C
10C to 80C
15C to 70C
Mounting pitch
6.5 mm
4.8 mm
4.0 mm
Actuators
Pin plunger
Hinge lever
Simulated roller
lever
Roller leaf spring
Pin plunger
Leaf spring
(available separately)
Pin plunger
Hinge lever
Leaf lever
Terminals
Turret
Page
197
203
209
Note:
12
Selection Guide
Selection Guide
Classifications
Model
D2VW
D2SW
D2SW-P
Appearance
33
10.3
19.8
6.4
11
10.6
15.9
10.1
19.8
D2VW-5
Features
D2VW-01
Contact
D2SW-3
D2SW-01
D2SW-P2
6.4
D2SW-P01
Contact specification
Rivet
Crossbar
Rivet
Crossbar
Rivet
Crossbar
Contact material
Silver alloy
Gold alloy
Silver
Gold alloy
Silver
Gold alloy
Rating
(resistive load)
5 A at
250 VAC
0.1 A at
30 VDC
3 A at 125
VAC
0.1 A at 30
VDC
2 A at 250
VAC
0.1 A at 30
VDC
Max. operating
current (A)
20
15
10
8
5
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.1
Min.
permissible
load (mA)
100
10
1
0.1
0.01
(160 mA at
5 VDC)
(1 mA at
5 VDC)
1.96 N
{200 gf}
Mechanical
10 x 106 min.
Electrical
100 x 103
min.
1 x 106 min.
(160 mA at
5 VDC)
1.77 N
{180 gf}
(1 mA at
5 VDC)
(1 mA at
5 VDC)
(160 mA at
5 VDC)
1.80 N
{183 gf}
5 x 106 min.
1 x 106 min.
50 x 103 min.
40C to 85C
40C to 85C
20C to 70C
Mounting pitch
10.3 x 22.2 mm
9.5 mm
9.5 mm
200 x 103
min.
Actuators
Pin plunger
Pin plunger
Pin plunger
Hinge lever
Hinge lever
Hinge lever
Simulated roller
lever
Simulated roller
lever
Simulated roller
lever
Hinge roller
lever
Hinge roller
lever
Hinge roller
lever
Terminals
Page
214
220
227
Note:
13
Selection Guide
Selection Guide
Classifications
Model
D2HW
D2JW
D2FW-G
Appearance
5.3
13.3
Features
Contact
12.7
23.5
9.4
6.5
13.5
5.3
Contact specification
Crossbar
Crossbar
Crossbar
Contact material
Gold alloy
Gold alloy
Silver alloy
Gold alloy
Rating
(resistive load)
2 A at 12 VDC
0.1 A at 30 VDC
1 A at 30 VDC
0.1 A at
30 VDC
(100 mA at 5 VDC)
(1 mA at 5 VDC)
Max. operating
current (A)
20
15
10
8
5
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.1
Min.
permissible
load (mA)
100
10
1
0.1
0.01
(1 mA at 5 VDC)
(1 mA at 5 VDC)
0.75 N
{76 gf}
2.45 N
{250 gf}
2.45 N
{250 gf}
(Leaf lever)
Durability
y
(
t )
(see
note)
1 x 106 min.
1 x 106 min.
3 x 105 min.
Mechanical
Electrical
100 x
103
min.
100 x
103
min.
30 x 103 min.
40C to 85C
40C to 85C
40C to 85C
Mounting pitch
---
4.8 mm
---
Actuators
Pin plunger
Hinge lever
Pin plunger
Simulated roller
lever
Hinge lever
Leaf lever
Simulated roller
lever
Simulated leaf
lever
Hinge roller
lever
Leaf lever
Long leaf lever
Hinge roller
lever
Terminals
Page
233
241
246
Note:
14
Selection Guide
Selection Guide
Classifications
Detection Switches
Model
D2A
D3C
D2X
Appearance
D3K
4.2
6
23
(Distance
from hole)
(External
length)
Standard models
Features
Models
with
low operating
f
Standard
models
13.7
(Distance
from hole)
Models with
low operating
f
5.3
Shorting and
non-shorting models
available.
Contact
(External
length)
6.7
8
Operation possible
from either side.
18.9
Ultra-low operating force
(0.03 N).
Snap-fit attachment for
easy installation.
Clip-on wiring with
crimp-type connectors.
Long stroke of 45.
Contact specification
Slide
Slide
Slide
Slide
Contact material
Silver plated
Silver plated
Gold plated
Silver plated
Rating
(resistive load)
0.1 A at 30 VDC
0.1 A at 30 VDC
0.1 A at 30 VDC
10 mA at 12 VDC
(1 mA at 5 VDC)
(1 mA at 5 VDC)
Max. operating
current (A)
20
15
10
8
5
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.1
Min.
permissible
load (mA)
100
10
1
0.1
0.01
(1 mA at 5 VDC)
(1 mA at 5 VDC)
0.49 N
{50 gf}
0.03 N
{3 gf}
Durability
y
(
t )
(see
note)
50 x 103 min.
50 x 103 min.
1 x 106 min.
2 x 106 min.
103
103
103
2 x 106 min.
Mechanical
Electrical
50 x
min.
50 x
min.
50 x
min.
10C to 70C
20C to 80C
10C to 70C
10C to 70C
Mounting pitch
---
---
---
---
Actuators
Rotary lever
Pin plunger
Rotary lever
Rotary lever
Terminals
PCB
PCB
CT connector
(AMP)
CT connector
(AMP)
Page
250
254
258
262
Note:
15
Selection Guide
Selection Guide
Classifications
Door Switches
Model
D3D
D2D
Appearance
D2T
15
17
15.35
33 6
33.6
30
36.4
Features
30.9
12.5
13
Quick-connection terminals
for easier wiring.
Contact
Contact specification
Crossbar
Rivet
Rivet
Contact material
Gold alloy
Silver
Silver
Rating
(resistive load)
1 A at 125 VAC
16 A at 250 VAC
5 A at 250 VAC
Max. operating
current (A)
0.1 A at
30 VDC
20
15
10
8
5
3
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.1
Min.
permissible
load (mA)
100
10
1
0.1
0.01
Durability
y
(
(see
note
t 1)
Mechanical
Electrical
2.0 N
{204 gf}
(160 mA at
5 VDC)
3.24 N
{330 gf}
10 x 106 min.
(1 mA at 5 VDC)
100 x
103
min.
(160 mA at 5 VDC)
100 x
103
min.
30C to 60C
25C to 85C
25C to 85C
Mounting pitch
---
22 mm
26.4 mm
Actuators
(1 mA at
5 VDC)
Pin plunger
Plunger
Pin plunger
Hinge lever
Lever
Terminals
HL connector (J.S.T)
Quick-connect (#250)
Page
266
270
278
Note:
16
General Information
General Information
List of Standards
Certification body/Standard
UL
CSA
EN/IEC
-15H/G/E
F (TV approval)
-01H
F (TV approval)
-10FY
-15ER
-15G55
F (TV approval)
-01H55
F (TV approval)
DZ
CE mark
TV
Page
Model
Z-size
(General
(Generalpurpose)
Z-55
V-size
(Miniature)
S-size
(Subminia
(Subminiature)
J-size (Ul(
tra SubSub
miniature)
63
78
F (VDE approval)
92
F (VDE approval)
110
-15/10
F (TV approval)
VX
F (VDE approval)
D2MV
D2RV
145
D2MC
156
Detection
Switches
F (TV approval)
161
F (VDE approval)
168
-01
SS-P
F (UL approval)
F (VDE approval)
176
SSG
F (TV approval)
182
D2S
190
D2F
197
203
209
-3
-01
D2VW
D2SW
F (VDE approval)
Note:
214
220
D2SW-P
F (UL approval)
F (VDE approval)
227
D2HW
f (UL approval)
233
D2JW
241
D2FW-G
246
D2A
250
D3C
254
D2X
258
D3K
Door
Switches
140
-10/5
D3M
SS
126
133
F (VDE approval)
D2MQ
Sealed Basic
Switches
70
-21/16/11
D3V
V
32
262
D3D
F (cUL approval)
F (VDE approval)
266
D2D
F (VDE approval,
TV approval)
270
D2T
F (VDE approval)
278
17
General Information
General Information
18
Type
Pretravel
(PT)
Overtravel
(OT)
Operating
force (OF)
Precision
Vibration
/shock
Description
Pin
plunger
Small
Small
Small
KKK
KKKK
Spring
pin
plunger
Small
Medium
Large
KK
KKK
Spring
short pin
plunger
Small
Medium
Large
KK
KK
Panel
mount pin
plunger
Small
Large
Large
KK
KK
Panel
mounted
(cross)
roller pin
plunger
Small
Large
Large
KK
Leaf
spring
Medium
Medium
Medium
KK
KK
Roller
leaf
spring
Medium
Medium
Medium
KK
KK
Leaf lever
Large
Large
Medium
Simulated Large
roller leaf
lever
Large
Medium
Hinge
lever
Large
Medium
Small
Simulated Large
roller
lever
Medium
Small
Hinge
roller
lever
Large
Medium
Small
Reverse
operation
hinge
lever
Large
Small
Medium
KK
General Information
General Information
Type
Pretravel
(PT)
Overtravel
(OT)
Operating
force (OF)
Precision
Vibration
/shock
Reverse
operation
hinge
roller
lever
Medium
Medium
Medium
KK
Rotating
operation
Large
Large
Small
KK
Flexible
rod
Large
Large
Small
Appearance
Note:
Description
Indications for precision and vibration/shock are as follows: K: Possible, KK: Good, KKK: Excellent, KKKK: Superior
Actuators related only to Z-series Switches are not listed above.
Basic Switches
Dust
and
powder
Gas
Water
drops
Degree of
protection
IP00
Model
Environmental resistance
IP40
f
(excluding
the terminals)
IP67
(excluding
the
terminals)
IP67
Note:
f:
n:
X:
Description of sealing
Actuator section
Terminal section
Applicable
Applicable depending on the model. Consult your OMRON sales representative.
Not applicable
19
General Information
General Information
0.15 W
0.8 W
3W
D2MQ (silver-plated)
SS-1
D2MQ (gold-plated)
D2MC-01
Z-01H
D3V-01, VX-01, D2MV-01, D3M, SS-01, SSG-01, D2S-01,
D2F-01, D2VW-01, D2SW-01, D2JW, D2A, D3C, D2X
Voltage (VDC)
D2HW
30
3W
10
5
5 mW
0.1
0.16
0.15 W
5
10
20 26.6
50
0.8 W
100
160
500
Current (mA)
20
General Information
General Information
Glossary
General Terms
Basic Switch
Insulation Resistance
The resistance between discontinuous terminals, between terminals and non-current-carrying metal parts, and between terminals
and ground.
Contact Form
The structure of the electrical I/O circuits of contacts used according
to the type of application. (Refer to Contact Form table later in this
section.)
Ratings
Value generally used as a reference for ensuring the characteristics
and performance of switches, such as the rated current and rated
voltage. Ratings are given assuming specific conditions (such as
the type of load, current, voltage, and frequency).
Dielectric Strength
The threshold value up to which insulation will not be destroyed
when a high voltage is applied for 1 minute to a predetermined measurement location.
Contact Resistance
The electrical resistance of the contact point of contacts. Generally,
the contact resistance includes the conductive resistance of the
spring or terminal section.
Vibration Resistance
Malfunction: The range of vibration for which closed contacts will not
open for longer than a specific time when vibration is applied to a
switch currently in operation.
Shock Resistance
Destruction: The range of shock for which the components of the
switch will not be damaged and for which operating characteristics
are maintained when mechanical shock is applied to a switch during
transportation or installation.
Malfunction: The range of shock for which closed contacts will not
open for longer than a specific time when shock is applied to a
switch currently in operation.
Operating Body
A part of a machine or equipment, such as a
cam or dog, which operates the actuator of the
switch.
Actuator
A part of the switch and is a mechanism incorporating the pushbutton and lever. External force
imposed on the actuator is relayed to the internal
spring mechanism, thus operating the moving
contact to turn the switch ON or OFF.
Switch Case
Also called the housing. Protects the switch
mechanism.
Contact Gap
A distance between the fixed contact and moving
contact when they are separated from each other,
thus enabling switching operation.
Mounting Hole
Moving Contact
Also called a moving spring. A part of a mechanism for touching or separating from the fixed
contact.
Terminals
Section where electrical wires are connected for input
and output of the switch.
21
General Information
General Information
Contact Shape and Type
Shape
Type
Main
material
Processing
method
Crossbar
contact
Gold alloy
Silver alloy
Needle
Silver
Rivet
Silver
Silver plated
Silver alloy
Gold plated
Welding or
riveting
Main application
Crossbar contacts are used for ensuring high contact reliability for
switching micro loads.
The moving contact and fixed contact come in contact with each
other at a right angle. Crossbar contacts are made with materials
that environment-resistant, such as gold alloy.
In order to ensure excellent contact reliability, bifurcated crossbar
contacts may be used.
Contact Gap
The contact gap is either 0.25, 0.5, 1.0, or 1.8 mm. The contact gap
is a design goal. Check the contact gap of the switch to be used if a
minimum contact gap is required. The standard contact gap is
0.5 mm. Even for the same switch configuration, the smaller the
contact gap of a switch mechanism is, the less the movement differential (MD) is and the more sensitivity and longer durability the
switch has. Such a switch cannot ensure, however, excellent
switching performance, vibration resistance, or shock resistance.
Character
displayed
Contact gap
DC
switching
MD
Accuracy and
durability
Vibration and
shock resistance
Feature
0.25 mm
Inferior
Minimal
Excellent
Inferior
0.50 mm
Ordinary
Short
Good
Ordinary
General-purpose
1.00 mm
Good
Medium
Ordinary
Good
Performance level
between G and E
1.80 mm
Excellent
Long
Inferior
Excellent
22
General Information
General Information
Terms Related to Operating Characteristics
Definitions of Operating Characteristics
Classification
Force
Operating
g
position
Releasing position
Free
position
Travel
Total travel
position
Position
V
Term
Abbreviation
Unit
Dispersion
Definition
Operating
Force
OF
N
{gf, kgf}
Max.
Releasing
Force
RF
N
{gf, kgf}
Min.
Total Travel
Force
TTF
N
{gf, kgf}
---
Pretravel
PT
mm or
degrees
Max.
Overtravel
OT
mm or
degrees
Min.
Movement
Differential
MD
mm or
degrees
Max.
Total Travel
TT
mm or
degrees
---
Free Position
FP
mm or
degrees
Max.
Operating
Position
OP
mm or
degrees
Releasing
Position
RP
mm or
degrees
---
Total Travel
Position
TTP
mm or
degrees
---
Example of Fluctuation:
V-21-1j6 with max. operating force of 3.92 N
The above means that each switch sample operates with a maximum operating force (OF) of 3.92 N when increasing the OF imposed on the
actuator from 0. Refer to page 28, Operating Stroke Setting.
Terminal symbol
COM
Common terminal
NC
NO
Symbol
Name
SPDT
SPST-NC
SPST-NO
Terminal Types
Type
Contact Form
Shape
Split contacts
Z-10FY-B
Solder terminal
Quick-connect terminal (#110, #187, and #250)
Screw terminal
Maintained
contacts
Z-15ER
PCB terminal
Angle terminal
Note:
DPDT
DZ
23
General Information
General Information
Terms Related to EN61058-1 Standards
Electric Shock Protective Class: Indicates the electric shock preventive level. The following classes are provided.
Class 0: Electric shocks are prevented by basic insulation only.
Class I: Electric shocks are prevented by basic insulation and
grounding.
Class II: Electric shocks are prevented by double insulation or enforced insulation with no grounding required.
Class III: No countermeasures against electric shocks are required because the electric circuits in use operate in a
low-enough voltage range (50 VAC max. or 70 VDC
max.)
Proof Tracking Index (PTI): Indicates the index of tracking resistance, that is, the maximum dielectric strength with no short-circuiting between two electrodes attached to the switch sample while 50
drops of 0.1% ammonium chloride solution are dropped between
the electrodes drop by drop. Five levels are provided. The following
table indicates the relationship between these PTI levels and CTI
values according to the UL Plastics Recognized Directory.
PTI
CTI Classified by UL
500
375
300
250
175
Number of Operations: Indicates the operation number of durability test provided by the standard. They are classified into the following levels and the switch must bear the corresponding symbol. A
switch with high switching frequency must withstand 50,000 switching operations and that with low switching frequency must withstand
10,000 operations to satisfy IEC standards.
Number of operations
Symbol
100,000
1E5
50,000
5E4
25,000
25E3
10,000
No symbol required
6,000
6E3
3,000
3E3
1,000
1E3
300
3E2
T85
25T85
Temperature range
0C to 85C
25C to 85C
24
General Information
General Information
Cautions
Note:
Mounting
Before mounting, dismounting, wiring, or inspecting a switch, be
sure to turn OFF the power supply to the switch, otherwise an electric shock may be received or the switch may burn.
Wiring
Do not perform wiring when power is being supplied to a switch.
Also, do not touch any of the charged terminals when power is being
supplied. Otherwise, electric shock may be received.
Follow the instructions provided in Correct Use for all wiring and soldering work. Using a switch with improper wiring or soldering may
result in abnormal heating when power is supplied, possibly resulting in burning.
Contact Load
Select suitable switch ratings after confirming contact load. If the
contact load is excessive for the contacts, the contacts may weld or
shift, possibly resulting in short-circuits or burning when power is
supplied.
Load Types
Some types of load have a large difference between steady-state
current and inrush current, as shown in the following diagram.
Select a switch with ratings suitable for the type of load. The higher
the inrush current in the closed circuit is, the more the contact abrasion or shift there will be. Consequently, contact welding or shifting
may occur, possibly resulting in short-circuits or burning.
Types of Load vs. Inrush Current
I
(A)
Solenoid
( 10 to 20)
Incandescent lamp
( 10 to 15)
Motor
( 5 to 10)
Relay
( 4 to 5)
Operating Atmosphere
Do not use switches in atmospheres containing combustible or
explosive gases. Arc or heat generated by switching may cause
fires or explosions.
Durability
The durability of a switch greatly varies with switching conditions.
Before using a switch, be sure to test the switch under actual conditions in the actual application and to use the switch within the switching operations causing no problem. If a deteriorated switch is used
continuously, insulation failures, contact welding, contact failures,
switch damage, or switch burnout may result.
25
General Information
General Information
Correct Use
No.
Area
No.
Item
Using Switches
Electrical
C diti
Conditions
Mechanical
C diti
Conditions
Mounting
g
Operation
p
and
d St
Storage
Environment
Load
Application of Switch to
Electronic Circuits
Contact Protective
Circuit
27
28
Operating Condition
Operating Method
Securing
Terminal Connections
Soldering Precautions
Handling
Operating Environment
Storage Environment
29
30
31
Using Switches
Electrical Conditions
Page
26
Load
The switching capacity of a switch significantly differs depending on
whether the switch is used to break an alternating current or a direct
current. Be sure to check both the AC and DC ratings of a switch.
The control capacity will drop drastically if it is a DC load. This is because a DC load, unlike an AC load, has no current zero cross point.
Therefore, if an arc is generated, it may continue for a comparatively
long time. Furthermore, the current direction is always the same,
which results in contact relocation phenomena, and the contacts
hold each other with ease and will not separate if the surfaces of the
contacts are uneven.
If the load is inductive, counter-electromotive voltage will be generated. The higher the voltage is, the higher the generated energy is,
which increase the abrasion of the contacts and contact relocation
phenomena. Make sure to use a switch within the rated conditions.
If a switch is used for switching both micro and high-capacity loads,
be sure to connect relays suitable to the loads.
The rated loads of a switch are according to the following conditions:
Inductive Load: A load having a minimum power factor of 0.4 (AC) or
a maximum time constant of 7 ms (DC).
Lamp Load: A load having an inrush current ten times the
steady-state current.
Motor Load: A load having an inrush current six times the steadystate current.
Note: It is important to know the time constant (L/R) of an inductive load in a DC circuit.
Inrush Current
I
(A)
Use the Selection Guide to select a suitable switch for the rated
current, operating load, actuator type, and operating environment.
i (Inrush current)
io (Steadystate current)
26
General Information
General Information
Contact Protective Circuit
When a switch is used under high humidity, arcs resulting from certain types of load (e.g., inductive loads) will generate nitrious oxides
and, with mater the nitrious oxides will become nitric acid, which will
corrode internal metal parts and may cause malfunctions. Always
use a contact protective circuit according to information provided in
the following table when using a switch under circuit conditions of
frequent switching and arcing.
The use of a contact protective circuit may delay the response time
of the load.
Apply a contact protective circuit (surge killer) to extend contact durability, prevent noise, and suppress the generation of carbide or nitric acid due to arc. Be sure to apply the contact protective circuit
properly, otherwise an adverse effect may result. Some typical
examples of contact protective circuit are described in the following
table.
Circuit example
CR
circuit
Power supply
Power
supply
DC
Yes
Power supply
Inductive
load
No
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Inductive
load
Varistor
method
Yes
Inductive
load
Power supply
Element selection
Yes
Inductive
load
Power supply
Note:
Inductive
load
Diode
method
Diode
and
Zener
diode
method
AC
See
note.
Feature
Load
Incorrect
Load
Power
supply
27
General Information
General Information
Mechanical Conditions
Operating Stroke Setting
Contact force
Operating force
The switching frequency and speed of a switch have a great influence on the performance of the switch. Pay attention to the following.
Stroke
FP
Release
Stroke
Release
TTP
Make sure that the operating body is set so that the actuator should
return to the free position when the operating body has moved if a
switch is used to form a normally closed (NC) circuit. If a switch is
used to form a normally open (NO) circuit, the operating body must
move the switch actuator to the distance of 70% to 100% of the rated
overtravel (OT) of the switch.
Operating
body
PT (Pretravel)
Install a stopper.
Operating Condition
Do not leave a switch with the actuator depressed for a long time,
otherwise the parts of the switch may soon deteriorate and the
changes of its characteristics operating may result.
Operating Method
The operating method has a great influence on the performance of a
switch. Consider the following before operating a switch.
Design the operating body (i.e., cam or dog) so that it will operate
the actuator smoothly. If the actuator snaps backwards quickly or
receives shock due to the shape of the operating body, its
durability may be deteriorated.
FP (Free position)
OP (Operating position)
Incorrect
OT (Overtravel)
Snap-back
Shock operation
TTP
(Total travel position)
Correct
If stroke is set in the vicinity of the operating position (OP) or the releasing position (RP), contact force may become unstable. As a result, the switch cannot ensure high reliability. Furthermore, the
switch may malfunction due to vibration or shock.
If stroke is set exceeding the total travel position (TTP), the moment
of inertia of the operating body may damage the actuator or the
switch itself, and the stress applied to the moving spring inside the
switch will increase and then, the durability of the switch may be deteriorated.
Incorrect
28
Correct
General Information
General Information
Incorrect
Snap-back
Shock operation
Mounting
Correct
Securing
Roller
Correct
Screw
Correct
Flat washer
Spring washer
Resin
Dog
Do not modify the switch in any way, for example, by widening the
mounting holes.
Operating
body
Operating
body
: Correct
: Incorrect
Correct
Locking Agent
If glue or locking agent is applied, make sure that it does not stick to
the moving parts or intrude into the inside of the switch, otherwise
the switch may have operating failure or contact failure. Some types
of glue or locking agent may generate gas that has a bad influence
on the switch. Pay the utmost attention when selecting glue or locking agent.
Wiring
Make sure that the lead wires are connected with no inappropriate
pulling force.
Mounting Location
Be sure not to mount a switch in locations where the switch may be
actuated by mistake.
Maintenance and Inspection
Make sure that a switch is mounted in locations that allow easy
inspection or replacement of the switch.
Mounting Direction
When using a switch with a low operating force mounted with a long
lever, make sure that the switch is mounted in the direction where
the weight of the lever is not applied to the pushbutton directly,
otherwise the switch may have releasing failures.
Terminal Connections
Set the angle of the cam or dog () for roller levers and similar
actuators to the range between 30_ and 45_. If the angle is too
large, an abnormally large horizontal stress will be applied to the
lever.
Solder Terminals
When soldering lead wires to a switch, make sure that the temperature of the iron tip is 380C maximum. Improper soldering may
cause abnormal heat radiation from the switch and the switch may
burn.
Complete soldering within 5 seconds at 350C or within 3 seconds
at 380C. If heat is applied for longer period of time, switch characteristics will be deteriorated, e.g., the case will melt and lead wire
insulation will scorch.
Soldering conditions are even more strict for ultra subminiature
switches. Refer to the Precautions for individual models for details.
Quick-Connect Terminals
Use the specified receptacles to connect to quick-connect terminals. Do not apply excessive force horizontally or vertically to the
29
General Information
General Information
terminals, otherwise the terminal may be deformed or the housing
may be damaged.
Wiring Work
When wiring a switch, check the insulation distance between the
switch and the mounting plate. If the insulation distance is insufficient, use an insulation guard or separator. Be particularly careful
when mounting a switch to metal.
Use wire sizes suitable for the applied voltage and carrying current.
Do not wire a switch while power is being supplied.
Using Separators
If providing sufficient insulation distance is a problem or there are
metal components or copper wire near a switch, use a switch with
an insulation guard or use a separator (order separately) to provide
sufficient insulation distance.
Separator for Vj
Separator
Separator
Separator for Zj
Separator
Soldering Precautions
When soldering by hand, place the terminal horizontal to the
ground, use a soldering iron with a suitable heat capacity and a suitable amount of solder, and complete soldering quickly. Prevent flux
from entering a switch by exhausting flux gas with an exhaust fan
and by avoiding the contact of the tip of the soldering iron and the
switch body. Flux gas inside a switch may cause contact failure. Do
not apply any force to the terminal or wire immediately after soldering.
Tip of soldering
iron
Incorrect
Correct
30
Operating Environment
A general switch is not water-resistant. Protect the switch appropriately when using the switch in places with water or oil spray.
Do not use a switch under the condition where vibration or shock is
continuously applied to the switch. If continuous vibration or shock
is applied to a switch, contact failure, malfunction, or decrease in durability may be caused by abrasive powder generated from the internal parts. If excessive vibration or shock is applied to a switch, the
contacts may malfunction, stick, or be damaged.
Mount a switch in the location where vibration and shock is not applied to the switch and in the direction where they do not resonate.
Do not use a switch in the atmosphere of corrosive gas, such as
sulfuric gas (H2S or SO2), ammonium gas (NH3), nitric gas (HNO3),
or chlorine gas (Cl2), or in the atmosphere of high temperature and
humidity. Otherwise, contact failure or corrosion damage may result.
If a switch is used in the atmosphere of silicon gas, arc energy may
attract silicon dioxide (SiO2) to the contacts and contact failure may
result. If there is silicon oil, silicon sealant, a wire covered with silicon, or any other silicon-based product near the switch, attach a
contact protective circuit to suppress the arcing of the switch or eliminate the source of silicon gas generation. Even for a sealed switch,
it may not be possible to prevent all of the gas from penetrating the
seal rubber, and contact failure may result.
Be sure to use a switch at a temperature and humidity within the
specified ranges. If a switch is exposed to radical temperature changes or intense heat, the characteristics of the switch may change.
Separate the switch as far as possible from sources of heat to eliminate the influence.
Storage Environment
When storing a switch, consider countermeasures (e.g., storing in a
plastic bag) to prevent discoloration resulting from sulfidization of
terminals (silver-plated). Make sure that the location is free of corrosive gas or dust with no high temperature or humidity. It is recommended that a switch be inspected before use if it is stored for three
months or more after the production, depending on the location.
General Information
General Information
Location
of failure
Contact
Failure
Contact
f il
failure
Possible cause
Dust and dirt on the contacts.
Water or other liquid has penetrated into a
switch.
Chemical substances have been generated
on the contact surface due to the
atmosphere containing chemical corrosive
gas.
Corrective action
Remove the cause of the p
problem,, p
place
th switch
the
it h in
i a box,
b
or use a sealed
l d
switch.
Use a switch having contacts with high
environmental resistivity (such as gold or
alloy contacts).
Malfunction
Contact
welding
Insulation
degradation
deg
ada o
(b i )
(burning)
Actuator
Mounting
section
sec
o
Terminal
Operating
failure
Low
d bilit
durability
Damage
Deformation or drop-out
Actuator was subjected to an excessive
force and force from an inappropriate
direction.
Damage
Damage
31
Z
Best-selling Basic Switch Boasting High
Precision and Wide Variety
A large switching capacity of 15 A with high repeat accuracy.
A wide range of variations in contact form for your selection: basic, split-contact, maintained-contact, and adjustable contact gap types.
A series of standard models for micro loads is available.
A series of molded terminal-type models incorporating
safety terminal protective cover is available.
General-purpose
Basic models
Drip-proof
Split-contact models
General-purpose
Maintained-contact models
General-purpose
Basic Models
Split-contact Models
General-purpose
Drip-proof Models
These Switches use a rubber boot on the actuator and adhesive
fill between the case and cover to increase resistance to drips.
Models with drip-proof terminal protective covers and molded terminals with resin filling are also available.
32
Maintained-contact Models
The maintained-contact type has a reset button at the bottom of
the switch case, in addition to the pushbutton (plunger) located on
the opposite side of the reset button. Use these buttons alternately.
Since the Switch has greater pretravel than overtravel, it is suitable for use in reversible control circuits, manual reset circuits,
safety limit circuits, and other circuits which are not preferable for
automatic resetting. (For further details, refer to individual
datasheets.)
1. Ratings
01: 0.1 A (for micro load)
15: 15 A
2. Contact Gap
H2: 0.15 (extra-high-sensitivity)
H:
0.25 mm (high-sensitivity, micro load)
G:
0.5 mm (standard)
E:
1.8 mm (high-capacity)
3. Actuator
None: Pin plunger
S:
Slim spring plunger
D:
Short spring plunger
K:
Spring plunger (medium OP)
K3:
Spring plunger (high OP)
Q3:
Panel mount plunger (low OP)
Q:
Panel mount plunger (medium OP)
Q8:
Panel mount plunger (high OP)
Q22:
Panel mount roller plunger
Q21:
Panel mount cross roller plunger
L:
Leaf spring (high OF)
L2:
Roller leaf spring
W21:
Short hinge lever
W:
Hinge lever (low OF)
W3:
Hinge lever (medium OF)
W32:
Hinge lever (high OF)
W4:
Low-force hinge lever
W44:
Long hinge lever
W78:
Low-force wire hinge lever (low OF)
W52:
Low-force wire hinge lever (high OF)
W22:
Short hinge roller lever
W2:
Hinge roller lever
W25:
Hinge roller lever (large roller)
W49:
Short hinge cross roller lever
W54:
Hinge cross roller lever
W2277: Unidirectional short hinge roller lever (Low OF)
M:
Reverse hinge lever
M22:
Reverse short hinge roller lever
M2:
Reverse hinge roller lever
NJ:
Flexible rod (high OF)
NJS:
Flexible rod (low OF)
4. Degree of Protection
None: General-purpose
55: Drip-proof
A55: Drip-proof (including the terminals)
5. Terminals
None: Solder terminal
B:
Screw terminal (with toothed washer)
B5V: Screw terminal with terminal cover (for Z-15G@A55 only)
Note: For combinations of models, refer to the following pages.
2 3 4
1. Drip-proof Type
2. Lead Outlets
None: VSF
19: VCT
3. Directions of Lead Outlets (See following diagrams.)
L:
Left
R:
Right
D:
Descending
D Type
L Type
R Type
Split-contact Models
Z-10F@Y-B
1 2 3 4
1. Ratings
10: 10 A
2. Contact Gap
F:
1 mm (high-capacity)
3. Actuator
None: Pin plunger
S:
Slim spring plunger
D:
Short spring plunger
Q:
Panel mount plunger
Q22: Panel mount roller plunger
W:
Hinge lever
W22: Short hinge roller lever
W2: Hinge roller lever
M22: Reverse short hinge roller lever
4. Construction
Y:
Split-contact models
5. Terminals
None: Solder terminal
B:
Screw terminal (with toothed washer)
Maintained-contact Models
Z-15-E@R
1
2 3 4
1. Ratings
15: 15 A
2. Contact Gap
E:
1.8 mm (High capacity)
3. Actuator
None: Pin plunger
S:
Slim spring plunger
W:
Hinge lever
4. Structure
R:
Maintained-contact models
33
Ordering Information
List of Models
Basic Models (General-purpose)
Actuator
Standard
High-sensitivity
G (0.5 mm)
Solder terminal Z-15G
Pin plunger
Slim spring plunger
Short spring
plunger
Low OP
Panel mount
plunger
High-capacity
H (0.25 mm)
Z-15H
E (1.8 mm)
Z-15E
Micro load
H (0.25 mm)
Z-01H
Extra-highsensitivity
H2 (0.15 mm)
Z-15H2
Z-15H-B
Z-15E-B
Z-01H-B
Z-15H2-B
Z-15HS
---
Z-01HS
---
Z-15HS-B
---
Z-01HS-B
---
Z-15HD
Z-15ED
Z-01HD
---
Z-15HD-B
Z-15ED-B
Z-01HD-B
---
---
---
---
---
Z-15HQ
Z-15EQ
Z-01HQ
---
Z-15HQ-B
Z-15EQ-B
Z-01HQ-B
---
High OP
---
---
---
-----
Z-15HQ22
Z-15EQ22
---
Z-15HQ22-B
Z-15EQ22-B
---
---
Z-15HQ21
Z-15EQ21
---
---
Z-15HQ21-B
Z-15EQ21-B
Leaf spring
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
Z-15HW
---
---
---
Z-15HW-B
---
---
---
Medium
OF
---
---
---
---
High OF
---
---
---
---
Z-15HW24
---
---
Z-15HW24-B
---
Z-15HW78
---
Screw terminal
Z-15HW78-B
---
Z-15HW52
---
Screw terminal
Z-15HW52-B
---
Z-15HW22
Z-15EW22
Z-01HW22
---
Z-15HW22-B
Z-15EW22-B
Z-01HW22-B
---
---
---
---
---
Z-15HW2
---
---
---
Z-15HW2-B
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
Hinge lever
Low OF
High OF
Standard
---
---
---
---
-----
34
-----
Actuator
Standard
High-sensitivity
G (0.5 mm)
Hinge cross
roller lever
Unidirectional short
hinge roller lever
High-capacity
H (0.25 mm)
E (1.8 mm)
Micro load
H (0.25 mm)
Extra-highsensitivity
H2 (0.15 mm)
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
Note: The pin plungers of reverse-type models are continuously pressed by the actuator levers with compression coil springs and the pin
plungers are freed by operating the levers. Reverse-type models are highly vibration- and shock-resistive because the pin plungers
are normally pressed.
Standard
High-sensitivity
G (0.5 mm)
H (0.25 mm)
Z-15GD-B
---
Z-15GQ
Z-15GQ-B
Z-15GQ8-B
---
Z-15GQ22
Z-15GQ22-B
---
Z-15GQ21-B
---
Z-15GW21-B
---
Hinge lever
Z-15GW
Z-15GW-B
---
Z-15GW4-B
Z-15HW24-B
---
Z-15HW78-B
Z-15GW22
Z-15GW22-B
---
Z-15GW2
Z-15GW2-B
---
Z-15GM22-B
---
Z-15GM2-B
---
Split-contact Models
Actuator
F (1.0 mm)
Solder terminal ---
Pin plunger
Medium OP
35
Actuator
F (1.0 mm)
Solder terminal ---
Hinge lever
Reverse short
hinge roller lever
Note: The pin plungers of reverse-type models are continuously pressed by the actuator levers with compression coil springs and the pin
plungers are freed by operating the levers. Reverse-type models are highly vibration- and shock-resistive because the pin plungers
are normally pressed.
Maintained-contact Models
Actuator
Maintained-contact model
Pin plunger
Z-15ER
Z-15ESR
Hinge lever
Z-15EWR
Micro load
G (0.5 mm)
H (0.25 mm)
Without drip-proof
terminal protective cover
Pin plunger
Short spring plunger
With drip-proof
terminal protective
cover
---
Z-01H55
Z-15GA55-B5V
Z-01H55-B
---
Spring plunger
Without drip-proof
terminal protective cover
Z-01HD55
Z-01HD55-B
---
---
---
---
Z-15GK3A55-B5V
Panel mount
plunger
---
---
Z-15GQA55-B5V
Panel mount
roller plunger
---
Z-15GQ22A55-B5V
---
Z-15GQ21A55-B5V
Leaf spring
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
Z-15GW44A55-B5V
-----
36
---
Z-15GWA55-B5V
---
Z-01HW2255
Z-15GW22A55-B5V
Z-01HW2255-B
---
Actuator
Micro load
G (0.5 mm)
H (0.25 mm)
Without drip-proof
terminal protective cover
Without drip-proof
terminal protective cover
---
Z-15GW2A55-B5V
Unidirectional short
hinge roller lever
---
Z-15GW2277A55-B5V
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
Parallel
With drip-proof
terminal protective
cover
---
---
Note: 1. The pin plungers of reverse-type models are continuously pressed by the actuator levers with compression coil springs and the
pin plungers are freed by operating the levers.
2. The tip is made of resin.
Standard
High-sensitivity
G (0.5 mm)
H (0.25 mm)
Z-15GD55-B
---
---
Spring plunger
Z-15GK55-B
---
---
Hinge lever
Z-15GW4455-B
Z-15GW55
Z-15GW55-B
---
---
Z-15GW2255
Z-15GW2255-B
---
---
Z-15GW255-B
---
---
Z-15GNJ55-B
---
---
---
---
Z-15HNJS55-B
High-sensitivity
H (0.25 mm)
37
Specifications
Approved Standards
Agency
Standard
UL
File No.
UL508
E41515
CSA
LR21642
TV Rheinland
EN61058-1
R9451585
Z-15
Z-10F
TV (EN61058-1)
Rated voltage
Z-01H
125 VAC
15 A 1/8 HP
6 A 1/10 HP
0.1 A
250 VAC
15 A 1/4 HP
6 A 1/8 HP
---
480 VAC
15 A
6A
---
30 VDC
---
---
0.1 A
125 VDC
0.5 A
0.6 A
---
250 VDC
0.25 A
0.3 A
---
Z-15H@-B
Z-15G@-B
Z-01H@-B
250 VAC
15 A
15 A
---
125 VAC
---
---
0.1 A
30 VDC
---
---
0.1 A
Ratings
Z-15 (Except Micro Load and Flexible Rod Models)
Item
Non-inductive load
Resistive load
Model
Rated voltage
NC
Inductive load
Lamp load
NO
NC
Inductive load
NO
NC
Motor load
NO
NC
NO
G, H, E
125 VAC
250 VAC
500 VAC
3A
2.5 A
1.5 A
1.5 A
1.25 A
0.75 A
5A
3A
1.5 A
2.5 A
1.5 A
0.75 A
8 VDC
14 VDC
30 VDC
125 VDC
250 VDC
15 A
15 A
6A
0.5 A
0.25 A
3A
3A
3A
0.5 A
0.25 A
1.5 A
1.5 A
1.5 A
0.5 A
0.25 A
15 A
10 A
5A
0.05 A
0.03 A
5A
5A
5A
0.05 A
0.03 A
2.5 A
2.5 A
2.5 A
0.05 A
0.03 A
8 VDC
14 VDC
30 VDC
125 VDC
250 VDC
15 A
15 A
2A
0.4 A
0.2 A
3A
3A
2A
0.4 A
0.2 A
1.5 A
1.5 A
1.4 A
0.4 A
0.2 A
15 A
10 A
1A
0.03 A
0.02 A
5A
5A
1A
0.03 A
0.02 A
2.5 A
2.5 A
1A
0.03 A
0.02 A
8 VDC
14 VDC
30 VDC
125 VDC
250 VDC
15 A
15 A
15 A
0.75 A
0.3 A
3A
3A
3A
0.75 A
0.3 A
1.5 A
1.5 A
1.5 A
0.75 A
0.3 A
15 A
15 A
10 A
0.4 A
0.2 A
5A
5A
5A
0.4 A
0.2 A
2.5 A
2.5 A
2.5 A
0.4 A
0.2 A
Note: Figures in parentheses are for the Z-15HW52 and Z-15HW78(-B) models, the AC ratings of these models are 125 and 250 V only.
Non-inductive load
Resistive load
NC
Inductive load
Lamp load
NO
NC
Inductive load
NO
NC
NO
Motor load
NC
NO
125 VAC
250 VAC
15 A
2A
1A
1A
0.5 A
7A
5A
2.5 A
1.5 A
2A
1A
8 VDC
14 VDC
30 VDC
125 VDC
250 VDC
15 A
15 A
2A
0.4 A
0.2 A
2A
2A
2A
0.4 A
0.2 A
1A
1A
1A
0.4 A
0.2 A
7A
7A
1A
0.03 A
0.02 A
3A
3A
1A
0.03 A
0.02 A
1.5 A
1.5 A
0.5 A
0.03 A
0.02 A
38
Z-15H2
Rated voltage
Non-inductive load
Resistive load
NC
Inductive load
Lamp load
NO
NC
Inductive load
NO
NC
Motor load
NO
NC
NO
125 VAC
250 VAC
10 A
3A
2.5 A
1.5 A
1.25 A
10 A
5A
3A
2.5 A
1.5 A
8 VDC
14 VDC
30 VDC
125 VDC
250 VDC
15 A
15 A
2A
0.4 A
0.2 A
3A
3A
2A
0.4 A
0.2 A
1.5 A
1.5 A
1.4 A
0.4 A
0.2 A
15 A
10 A
1A
0.03 A
0.02 A
5A
5A
1A
0.03 A
0.02 A
2.5 A
2.5 A
1A
0.03 A
0.02 A
Z-01H
Rated voltage
Resistive load
NC
125 VAC
0.1 A
8 VDC
14 VDC
30 VDC
0.1 A
0.1 A
0.1 A
NO
Z-10F
Model
Rated voltage
Non-inductive load
Resistive load
NC
Series
connection
Parallel
connection
Note: 1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
NO
Inductive load
Lamp load
NC
Inductive load
NO
NC
Motor load
NO
NC
NO
125 VAC
250 VAC
10 A
10 A
4A
2.5 A
2A
1.5 A
6A
5A
3A
2.5 A
1.5 A
30 VDC
125 VDC
250 VDC
10 A
1A
0.6 A
4A
1A
0.6 A
2A
1A
0.6 A
6A
0.1 A
0.05 A
6A
0.1 A
0.05 A
3A
0.1 A
0.05 A
125 VAC
250 VAC
6A
6A
3A
2.5 A
1.5 A
1.25 A
4A
4A
4A
2A
2A
1A
30 VDC
125 VDC
250 VDC
6A
0.6 A
0.3 A
4A
0.6 A
0.3 A
2A
0.6 A
0.3 A
4A
0.1 A
0.05 A
6A
0.1 A
0.05 A
3A
0.1 A
0.05 A
The above current ratings are the values of the steady-state current.
Inductive load has a power factor of 0.4 min. (AC) and a time constant of 7 ms max. (DC).
Lamp load has an inrush current of 10 times the steady-state current.
Motor load has an inrush current of 6 times the steady-state current.
The normally closed and normally open ratings of reverse hinge lever models are opposite to each other.
The AC ratings of molded terminals are 125 and 250 V only.
The ratings values apply under the following test conditions:
Ambient temperature: 202C
Ambient humidity: 655%
Operating frequency: 20 operations/min
39
Characteristics
Item
Basic
(except micro
load and flexible
rod)/ maintained
contact
Z-15
Basic
(micro load)
Z-01H
Basic
(flexible rod)
Z-15
Split-contact
Z-10F
Operating speed
(see note)
1 mm to 1 m/s
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
Contact resistance
Dielectric strength
Vibration resistance
Shock resistance
Durability
Mechanical:
Mechanical: 1,000,000 operations min.
Contact gap G, H, H2: 20,000,000 operations min.
Electrical:
100,000 operations
(see note 4)
min.
Contact gap E:
300,000 operations
Electrical:
Contact gap G, H, H2: 500,000 operations min.
Contact gap E:
100,000 operations min.
Degree of protection
General-purpose: IP00
Drip-proof:
Equivalent to IP62
Degree of protection
Class I
against electric shock
Proof tracking index
(PTI)
175
Switch category
D (IEC335-1)
Ambient temperature
Operating:
General-purpose: 25C to 80C (with no icing)
Drip-proof:
15C to 80C (with no icing)
Ambient humidity
Operating:
General-purpose: 35% to 85%
Drip-proof:
35% to 95%
Weight
Approx. 22 to 58 g
Approx. 42 to 48 g
Approx. 34 to 61 g
Note: 1. The values are for the plunger models. (For the lever models, the values are at the plunger section.) (Consult your OMRON representative for other models.)
2. The values are for the Z-15G pin plunger.
3. The values are for the Z-10FY-B.
4. The values are for the pin plunger. The durability for models other than the pin plunger is 10,000,000 min.
5. Malfunction: 1 ms max.
40
Contacts Specification
Item
Z-15
Rivet
Z-01H
Z-10F
Contacts
Shape
Single crossbar
Rivet
Material
Silver alloy
Gold alloy
Silver alloy
Inrush current
NC
30 A max.
0.1 A max.
40 A max.
NO
15 A max.
0.1 A max.
20 A max.
Contact Form
Basic Models
Split-contact Models
General-purpose
NC
NO
COM
COM
NC
NO
NC
NO
Note: The NO and NC terminal arrangement is reversed for Models with reverse operation (Z-10FM).
Connection Example
Series Connection
Parallel Connection
L
L
L
L
Maintained-contact Models
Contact Form (Maintained-contact)
COM
NC
NO
41
Engineering Data
Mechanical Durability
Z-15G
Ambient temperature: 202C
Ambient humidity: 655%
Without load
Operating frequency: 240 operations/min
30
20
10
7
5
3
Z-15G
100
70
50
Electrical Durability
10
1
0.5
2
1
0.1 0.2
0.3 0.4
Overtravel (mm)
Drip-proof Construction
Without Terminal Protective Cover
Fixed contact (b)
Movable spring
Glued surface
(adhesive is
filled between
case and cover)
Movable contact
Spring pivot
42
10
12
Nomenclature
Rubber boot
14
16
Dimensions
Note: 1. Unless otherwise indicated, all units are in millimeters.
2. Unless otherwise specified, a tolerance of 0.4 mm applies to all dimensions.
Pin Plunger
2.3 dia.
23.30.25 4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
PT
Z-15G-B, Z-15E-B
Z-15H-B, Z-15H2-B
Z-01H-B, Z-10FY-B
OP
24.2
9.2
4.2+0.075
0.025
+0.1
4.360.05
dia.
17.450.2
25.40.1
49.2
Z-15G-B
OF
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
2.45 to 3.43 N
1.12 N
0.4 mm
0.13 mm
0.05 mm
OP
15.90.4 mm
Z-15H-B
Z-15H2-B
1.96 to 2.75 N
1.12 N
0.3 mm
0.13 mm
0.025 mm
11.9
Z-15E-B
1.96 to 2.5 N
1.12 N
0.3 mm
0.1 mm
0.005 to 0.008 mm
(see
note)
Z-15GS-B, Z-15HS-B,
Z-01HS-B, Z-10FSY-B
2.45 N max.
0.78 N
0.5 mm
0.13 mm
0.04 mm
Z-10FY-B
4.46 to 7.26 N
1.12 N
0.8 mm
0.13 mm
0.1 mm
5.2 dia.
23.30.25
PT
Z-01H-B
6.12 to 7.85 N
1.12 N
0.8 mm
0.13 mm
0.13 mm
4 dia.
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia.
hole
OP
9 dia.
24.2
9.2
4.2+0.075
0.025
+0.1
4.360.05
dia.
17.450.2
25.40.1
49.2
11.9
Z-15GS-B
OF
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
2.45 to 3.43 N
1.12 N
0.4 mm
1.6 mm
0.05 mm
OP
28.20.5 mm
Z-15HS-B
1.96 to 2.79 N
1.12 N
0.3 mm
1.6 mm
0.025 mm
PT
Z-10FSY-B
4.46 to 7.26 N
1.12 N
0.8 mm
1.6 mm
0.1 mm
12.3 dia.
10 dia.
23.30.25
12SR
(see
note)
Z-01HS
2.45 N max.
0.78 N
0.5 mm
1.6 mm
0.05 mm
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia.
hole
7.15 dia.
OP
24.2
4.2+0.075
0.025
9.2
+0.1
dia.
4.360.05
17.450.2
25.40.1 11.9
49.2
Z-15GD-B
OF
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
2.45 to 3.43 N
1.12 N
0.4 mm
1.6 mm
0.05 mm
OP
21.50.5 mm
Z-15HD-B
1.96 to 2.79 N
1.12 N
0.3 mm
1.6 mm
0.025 mm
Z-15ED-B
6.13 to 7.85 N
1.12 N
0.8 mm
1.6 mm
0.13 mm
Z-01HD-B
2.45 N max.
0.78 N
0.5 mm
1.6 mm
0.05 mm
Z-10FDY-B
4.46 to 7.26 N
1.12 N
0.8 mm
1.6 mm
0.1 mm
43
23.30.25
8.35 dia.
11.9SR
(see
note 1)
PT
Z-15GQ-B, Z-01HQ-B
Z-15HQ-B, Z-10FQY-B
Z-15EQ-B
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
OP
13.1
(See
16.3 note 2)
16 dia.
4.2+0.075
0.025
9.2
+0.1
4.360.05
dia.
17.450.2
25.40.1
11.9
49.2
Z-15GQ3-B
23.30.25
8.35 dia.
11.9SR
(see
note 1)
PT
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
OP
13.1
M12 1
mounting screw
(See
16.3 note 2)
16 dia.
4.2+0.075
0.025
9.2
+0.1
dia.
4.360.05
25.40.1
17.450.2
11.9
49.2
Z-15GQ8-B
23.30.25
8SR
(see
note
1)
PT
OP
(See
note 2)
16 dia.
4.2+0.075
0.025
+0.1
4.360.05
M3 10 (depth)
M12 1
mounting screw
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
13.1
16.3
8.35 dia.
9.2
dia.
Note: 1. Plated brass plunger
2. Imperfect screw part with a maximum length of 1.5 mm.
17.450.2
25.40.1 11.9
49.2
Z-15GQ-B
OF
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
2.45 to 3.43 N
1.12 N
0.4 mm
5.5 mm
0.05 mm
OP
21.80.8 mm
Z-15HQ-B
1.96 to 2.79 N
1.12 N
0.3 mm
5.5 mm
0.025 mm
Z-15EQ-B
6.13 to 7.85 N
1.12 N
0.8 mm
5.5 mm
0.13 mm
Z-01HQ-B
2.45 N max.
0.78 N
0.5 mm
5.5 mm
0.05 mm
Z-10FQY-B
Z-15GQ3-B
Z-15GQ8-B
4.46 to 7.26 N
1.12 N
0.8 mm
5.5 mm
0.1 mm
2.45 to 3.43 N
1.12 N
4.2 mm
2.5 mm
2.2 mm
2.45 to 3.43 N
1.12 N
0.5 mm
5.5 mm
0.05 mm
18.80.8 mm
32.51 mm
Note: 1. Do not use the M12 mounting screw and the case mounting hole at the same time, or excessive pulling force will be imposed on
the Switch and the case and cover may be damaged.
2. On the model Z-15GQ3-B, PT can be set to a value larger than that for the Z-15GQ.
3. On the model Z-15GQ8-B, operating position can be adjusted by providing a screw in the plunger section.
The M3 hole with a depth of 10 mm is a through hole. Take precautions so that no water or screw lock agent penetrates into the
hole.
44
23.30.25
PT
OP
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
15.5
(See
16.3 note)
16 dia.
9.2
4.2+0.075
0.025
+0.1
dia.
4.360.05
17.450.2
25.40.1 11.9
49.2
Z-15GQ22-B
OF
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
2.45 to 3.43 N
1.12 N
0.4 mm
3.58 mm
0.05 mm
OP
33.41.2 mm
Z-15HQ22-B
1.96 to 2.79 N
1.12 N
0.3 mm
3.58 mm
0.025 mm
Z-15EQ22-B
6.13 to 7.85 N
1.12 N
0.8 mm
3.58 mm
0.13 mm
Z-10FQ22Y-B
4.46 to 7.26 N
1.12 N
1 mm
3.55 mm
0.1 mm
Note: Do not use the M12 mounting screw and the case mounting hole at the same time, or the case may be damaged.
23.30.25
PT
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
OP
15.5
(See
16.3 note)
16 dia.
9.2
4.2+0.075
0.025
+0.1
4.360.05
dia.
25.40.1
49.2
17.450.2
11.9
Z-15GQ21-B
OF
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
2.45 to 3.43 N
1.12 N
0.4 mm
3.58 mm
0.05 mm
OP
33.41.2 mm
Z-15HQ21-B
1.96 to 2.79 N
1.12 N
0.3 mm
3.58 mm
0.025 mm
Z-15EQ21-B
6.13 to 7.85 N
1.12 N
0.8 mm
3.58 mm
0.13 mm
Note: Do not use the M12 mounting screw and the case mounting hole at the same time, or the case may be damaged.
45
Leaf Spring
Z-15GL-B
4.8
49.60.8
FP
OP
23.9
9.2
4.2+0.075
0.025
+0.1
4.360.05
4.2+0.075
0.025
dia. hole
dia.
Z-15GL2-B
FP
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
OP
23.9
20.6 mm
17.40.8 mm
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
1.38 N
0.14 N
1.6 mm (see note)
1.3 mm
FP max.
OP
31.8 mm
28.60.8 mm
9.2
4.2+0.075
0.025
+0.1
4.360.05
FP max.
OP
17.450.2
460.8
t = 0.3
(see note)
1.38 N
0.14 N
1.6 mm (see note)
1.3 mm
25.40.1 11.9
49.2
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
dia.
17.450.2
25.40.1
11.9
49.2
26.2
Z-15GW21-B
t = 1 (stainless-steel lever)
4.9
28.2R
OP
13.9
20.2 16.9
FP
9.2
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
4.2+0.075
0.025
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
1.57 N
0.27 N
2 mm
1 mm
FP max.
OP
24.8 mm
190.8 mm
+0.1
4.360.05
dia.
17.450.2
25.40.1 11.9
49.2
Hinge Lever
t = 1 (stainless-steel lever)
Z-15GW-B, Z-15GW32-B
Z-15HW-B, Z-10FWY-B
Z-15GW3-B (Lever Length: 56R)
(see note)
26.2
20.2
4.9
63.5R
16.9
13.9
OP
FP
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
4.2+0.075
0.025
+0.1
4.360.05
dia.
9.2
17.450.2
25.40.1
11.9
49.2
Z-15HW-B
Z-15GW32-B
Z-10FWY-B
Z-15GW3-B
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
0.69 N
0.14 N
5.6 mm
1.27 mm
0.66 N
0.14 N
5.6 mm
0.63 mm
1.47 to 1.96 N
0.92 N
5.6 mm
1.27 mm
0.88 N
0.14 N
5.6 mm
2.4 mm
0.78 N
0.15 N
4.8 mm
1.12 mm
FP max.
28.2 mm
27.4 mm
28.2 mm
29.8 mm
27.2 mm
OP
190.8 mm
46
t = 1 (stainless-steel lever)
Z-15GW4-B
4.9
63.5R
26.2
PT
20.2
16.9
OP
13.9
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
4.2+0.075
0.025
9.2
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
274 mN
34.3 mN
10 mm
5.6 mm
1.27 mm
OP
190.8 mm
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
58.8 mN
4.90 mN
19.8 mm
10 mm
2 mm
OP
19.81.6 mm
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
58.8 mN
4.90 mN
8.3 mm
5.6 mm
0.65 mm
OP
191 mm
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
39.2 mN
2.94 mN
10 mm
6 mm
3 mm
OP
201 mm
+0.1
4.360.05
dia.
17.450.2
25.40.1
49.2
11.9
Z-15HW24-B
26.2
PT
20.2
16.9
13.9
4.2+0.075
0.025
+0.1
4.360.05
OP
9.2
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
dia.
25.40.1
49.2
17.450.2
11.9
Z-15HW52-B
3 max.
63.5R
26.2
PT
20.2
16.9
OP
13.9
4.2+0.075
0.025
9.2
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
+0.1
4.360.05
dia.
17.450.2
25.40.1
49.2
11.9
Z-15HW78-B
26.2
110R
PT
OP
20.2 16.9
9.2
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
dia.
25.40.1 11.9
49.2
17.450.2
47
9.5 dia. 4
(plastic roller)
26.6R
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
+0.1
4.360.05
dia.
1.57 N
0.41 N
2.4 mm
0.5 mm
FP max.
OP
32.5 mm
30.20.4 mm
1.47 N
0.41 N
2.4 mm
0.45 mm
Z-01HW22-B
Z-10FW22Y-B
Z-15GW2-B
1.57 N
0.27 N
2.4 mm
0.5 mm
2.45 N
0.34 N
2.4 mm
1 mm
0.98 N
0.22 N
4 mm
1.02 mm
35.1 mm
30.20.4 mm
32.5 mm
30.20.4 mm
34.8 mm
30.20.4 mm
36.5 mm
30.20.8 mm
9.5 dia. 4
(plastic roller)
27.1R
Z-15HW2-B
0.84 N
0.22 N
4 mm
0.6 mm
1.94 N
0.41 N
2.4 mm
1.3 mm
Model
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
Z-10FW2Y-B
1.27 N
0.22 N
4 mm
2 mm
37.4 mm
30.20.8 mm
Z-15GW49-B Z-15GW54-B
1.67 N
0.41 N
2.4 mm
0.51 mm
0.98 N
0.22 N
4 mm
1 mm
FP max. 33.3 mm
37.3 mm
OP
310.4 mm 310.8 mm
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
+0.1
4.360.05
dia.
Z-15GW25-B
2R
26.2
t=1
(stainlesssteel lever)
20 dia. 4
(plastic roller)
50R
FP
OP
20.2
16.9
13.9
9.2
4.2+0.075
0.025
4.2+0.075
0.025
+0.1
4.360.05
dia.
dia. hole
17.450.2
25.40.1 11.9
49.2
48
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
0.98 N
0.21 N
4 mm
1.6 mm
FP max.
OP
47.5 mm
41.20.8 mm
9.5 dia. 4
(plastic roller)
Operating direction
t=1
(stainlesssteel lever)
26.2
31.9R
34.1 max.
11.1R
FP
OP
20.2
16.9
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
1.67 N
0.41 N
2.4 mm
0.51 mm
FP max.
OP
43.6 mm
41.30.8 mm
13.9
9.2
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
4.2+0.075
0.025
+0.1
4.360.05
dia.
17.450.2
25.40.1 11.9
49.2
Z-15GM-B
t = 1 (stainless-steel lever)
18.65
20.2
4.9
56R
FP
17.4
OP
13.9
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
1.67 N
0.27 N
5.6 mm
0.89 mm
FP max.
OP
23.8 mm
190.8 mm
9.2
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
4.2+0.075
0.025
+0.1
4.360.05
dia.
17.450.2
25.40.1 11.9
49.2
Z-15GM22-B,
Z-10FM22Y-B
9.5 dia. 4
(plastic roller)
t = 1 (stainless-steel lever)
18.5R
20.2
OP
17.4
FP
13.9
9.2
+0.1
4.360.05
dia.
Z-10FM22Y-B
5.28 N
1.67 N
2 mm
0.28 mm
6.37 N
1.67 N
2 mm
0.56 mm
FP max.
OP
31.8 mm
29.40.4
mm
33 mm
29.40.4 mm
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
4.2+0.075
0.025
Z-15GM22-B
Model
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
17.450.2
25.40.1 11.9
49.2
Z-15GM2-B
18.65
9.5 dia. 4
(plastic roller)
40.6R
FP
OP
20.2 17.4
13.9
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
2.35 N
0.55 N
4 mm
0.64 mm
FP max.
OP
35 mm
30.20.8 mm
9.2
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
4.2+0.075
0.025
+0.1
4.360.05
dia.
17.450.2
25.40.1 11.9
49.2
49
Pin Plunger
6SR
(see note)
Z-15G55-B
Z-01H55-B
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
3.9 dia.
Z-15G55-B
OF
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
2.45 to 4.22 N
1.12 N
2.2 mm
0.13 mm
0.06 mm
OP
15.90.4 mm
Z-01H55-B
3.43 N max.
0.78 N
2.2 mm
0.13 mm
0.06 mm
+0.1
15 dia.
Z-15GD55-B
Z-01HD55-B
11.9SR
(see note)
4.36
+0.1
0.05
4.2+0.075
0.025
7.15 dia.
dia. hole
Model
Z-15GD55-B
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
5.30 N
1.12 N
1.8 mm
1.6 mm
0.06 mm
OP
21.50.5 mm
Z-01HD55-B
3.63 N
0.78 N
1.9 mm
1.6 mm
0.06 mm
dia.
Spring Plunger
17 dia.
7.15 dia.
Z-15GK55-B
11.9SR
(see note)
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
5.30 N
1.12 N
2.3 mm
1.6 mm
0.06 mm
OP
28.20.5 mm
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
5.30 N
1.12 N
2.4 mm
3.5 mm
0.06 mm
OP
37.81.2 mm
+0.1
Z-15GK355-B
17 dia.
8.35 dia.
11.9SR
(see note)
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
+0.1
50
8.35 dia.
Z-15GQ55-B
11.9SR
(see note 1)
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
(see
note 2)
16 dia.
M12 1
Mounting screw
Two hexagonal nuts
(2 t 14 width across flats)
Two lock nuts
(2 t 15.6 width
across flats)
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
5.30 N
1.12 N
1.8 mm
5.5 mm
0.06 mm
OP
21.80.8 mm
+0.1
Note: Do not use the M12 mounting screw and the case mounting hole at the same time, or the case may be damaged.
Z-15GQ2255-B
(see note)
M12 1
mounting screw
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
5.30 N
1.12 N
1.8 mm
3.58 mm
0.06 mm
OP
33.41.2 mm
16 dia.
+0.1
Note: Do not use the M12 mounting screw and the case mounting hole at the same time, or the case may be damaged.
Z-15GQ2155-B
M12 1
mounting screw
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
5.30 N
1.12 N
1.8 mm
3.58 mm
0.06 mm
OP
33.41.2 mm
16 dia.
+0.1
Note: Do not use the M12 mounting screw and the case mounting hole at the same time, or the case may be damaged.
51
Leaf Spring
t = 0.3 (stainless-steel spring lever)
Z-15GL55-B
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
1.96 N
0.14 N
1.6 mm
1.3 mm
FP max.
OP
20.6 mm
17.50.8 mm
+0.1
Z-15GL255-B
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
1.96 N
0.14 N
1.6 mm
1.3 mm
FP max.
OP
31.8 mm
28.60.8 mm
t = 1 (stainless-steel lever)
28.2R
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
1.86 N
0.27 N
2 mm
1 mm
FP max.
OP
25 mm
190.8 mm
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
+0.1
Z-15GW4455-B
100R
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
0.88 N
0.14 N
5.6 mm
3.5 mm
FP max.
OP
33 mm
191.2 mm
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
+0.1
Hinge Lever
Z-15GW55-B
t = 1 (stainless-steel lever)
63.5R
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
+0.1
52
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
0.98 N
0.14 N
5.6 mm
2 mm
FP max.
OP
28.2 mm
190.8 mm
Model
t = 1 (stainless-steel lever)
9.5 dia. 4 (plastic roller)
26.6R
Z-15GW2255-B
Z-01HW2255-B
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
1.96 N
0.41 N
2.4 mm
0.8 mm
1.96 N
0.27 N
2.4 mm
0.8 mm
FP max.
OP
32.9 mm
30.20.4 mm
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
+0.1
48.5R
Z-15GW255-B
t = 1 (see note)
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
1.27 N
0.21 N
4 mm
1.6 mm
FP max.
OP
36.5 mm
30.20.8 mm
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
+0.1
Operating direction
t=1
(stainlesssteel lever)
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
1.77 N
0.49 N
2.4 mm
0.8 mm
FP max.
OP
43.6 mm
41.30.8 mm
11.1R
34.1 max.
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
+0.1
Z-15GM55-B
4 max.
FP
OP
5.6
9.2
20.2
17.4
56R
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
1.96 N
0.27 N
5.6 mm
0.89 mm
FP max.
OP
23.8 mm
190.8 mm
9.2
4.2+0.075
0.025
+0.1
25.40.1
49.2
11.9
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia.
17.450.2
53
Z-15GM2255-B
18.65
18.5R
5.6
FP
9.2
20.2
17.4
OP
4 max.
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
5.69 N
1.67 N
2 mm
0.28 mm
FP max.
OP
31.8 mm
29.40.4 mm
9.2
4.2+0.075
0.025
4.36
+0.1
0.05
dia.
25.40.1
49.2
11.9
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia.
17.450.2
Z-15GM255-B
18.65
5.6
9.2
FP
OP
40.6R
20.2
17.4
4 max.
9.2
4.2+0.075
0.025
4.36
+0.1
0.05
dia.
25.40.1
49.2
54
4.2+0.075
0.025
11.9
dia.
17.450.2
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
2.65 N
0.55 N
4 mm
0.64 mm
FP max.
OP
35 mm
30.20.8 mm
(see note 1)
6.1 dia.
3.2 dia.
OF max.
PT max.
0.49 N
(20 mm)
OT
42 to 60 mm
Nylon rod
30 Operating range (see note 2)
12 dia.
Rubber cap
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
4.36+0.1
0.05 dia.
Note: 1. Operation is possible in any direction other than the axial direction (indicated by the arrow ).
2. Use only the area within the top 30 mm of the rod as the operating part. (Do not use the area that falls within 80 mm from the
mounting hole as the operating part. Using this area may cause damage to the nylon rod.
)
OF max.
PT max.
0.15 N
(25 mm)
(see note 1)
1-dia. stainless steel
wire (see note 3)
Operating range
(see note 2)
12 dia.
Rubber cap
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
+0.1
Note: 1. Operation is possible in any direction other than the axial direction (indicated by the arrow ).
2. Use only the area within the top 30 mm of the rod as the operating part. (Do not use the area that falls within 100 mm from the
mounting hole as the operating part. Using this area may cause damage to the steel wire.)
3. The steel wire can be replaced if damaged. (Model: Lever for HNJS55)
55
Z-15GA55-B5V
4.36+0.1
0.05 dia.
3.9 dia.
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
2.45 to 4.22 N
1.12 N
2.2 mm
0.13 mm
0.06 mm
OP
15.90.4 mm
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
5.30 N
1.12 N
2.4 mm
3.5 mm
0.06 mm
OP
37.81.2 mm
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
Z-15GK3A55-B5V
17 dia.
8.35 dia.
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
4.36
+0.1
0.05
dia.
Z-15GQA55-B5V
16 dia.
4.36+0.1
0.05 dia.
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
5.30 N
1.12 N
1.8 mm
5.5 mm
0.06 mm
OP
21.80.8 mm
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
Note: Do not use the M12 mounting screw and the case mounting hole at the same time, or the case may be damaged.
Z-15GQ22A55-B5V
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
5.30 N
1.12 N
1.8 mm
3.58 mm
0.06 mm
OP
33.41.2 mm
16 dia.
4.36+0.1
0.05 dia.
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
Note: Do not use the M12 mounting screw and the case mounting hole at the same time, or the case may be damaged.
56
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
5.30 N
1.12 N
1.8 mm
3.58 mm
0.06 mm
OP
33.41.2 mm
16 dia.
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
4.36+0.1
0.05 dia.
Note: Do not use the M12 mounting screw and the case mounting hole at the same time, or the case may be damaged.
t = 1 (stainless-steel lever)
Z-15GW44A55-B5V
100R
4.36+0.1
0.05 dia.
Hinge Lever
63.5R
4.36+0.1
0.05 dia.
4.36+0.1
0.05 dia.
FP max.
OP
33 mm
191.2 mm
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
0.98 N
0.14 N
5.6 mm
2 mm
FP max.
OP
28.2 mm
190.8 mm
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
1.96 N
0.41 N
2.4 mm
0.8 mm
FP max.
OP
32.9 mm
30.20.4 mm
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
1.27 N
0.21 N
4 mm
1.6 mm
FP max.
OP
36.5 mm
30.20.8 mm
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
t = 1 (stainless-steel lever)
Z-15GW22A55-B5V
0.88 N
0.14 N
5.6 mm
3.5 mm
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
t = 1 (stainless-steel lever)
Z-15GWA55-B5V
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
48.5R
(see note)
4.36+0.1
0.05 dia.
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
Note: t = 1 (stainless-steel lever)
57
t = 1 (stainless-steel lever)
31.9R
11.1R
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
1.77 N
0.49 N
2.4 mm
0.8 mm
FP max.
OP
43.6 mm
41.30.8 mm
34.1 max.
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
4.36+0.1
0.05 dia.
Maintained-contact Models
Pin Plunger
Plunger
Z-15ER
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
2.3 dia.
2.3SR (stainless steel plunger)
Reset position
7.1 min.
4.36
+0.1
0.05
dia.
Reset button
(plastic plunger)
(See note.)
5.2 dia.
4 dia.
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
Reset position
7.1 min.
9 dia.
Reset button
(plastic plunger)
4.36+0.1
0.05 dia.
OF max.
PT max.
OT min.
1.96 to 2.50 N
0.4 mm
0.13 mm
OP
15.90.4 mm
Reset Button
OF max.
OT min.
0.55 to 2.79 N
0.4 mm
Plunger
OF max.
PT max.
OT min.
2.65 N
0.4 mm
1.6 mm
OP
28.20.5 mm
Reset Button
OF max.
OT min.
2.79 N
0.4 mm
Hinge Lever
t=1 (stainless steel lever)
Z-15EWR
Lever Tip
63.5R
Reset position
7.1 min.
4.36+0.1
0.05 dia.
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
Reset button
(plastic button)
58
OF max.
OT min.
0.54 N
5.6 mm
FP max.
OP
28.2 mm
190.8 mm
Reset Button
6.4 dia. Reset free position
9.5 max.
OF max.
OT min.
2.94 N
0.4 mm
Terminals
Basic Models (General-purpose) & Split-contact Models
Basic (General-purpose) Models
Split-contact Models
Solder Terminal
5.6
6.4
9.2
20
20
49.2
11.9
25.40.1 11.9
17.450.2
23
17.450.2
Three,
M4 5.5
Terminal
screws (with
toothed
washer)
49.2
17.1
17.450.2
Five,
M3.5 5.5
terminal
screws (with
toothed
washer)
9.2
20
20
17.450.2
Three, M4 5.5
Terminal screws
(with toothed
washer)
49.2
Note: With reverse action models (Z-15GM), the positions of NO and NC terminals are reversed.
Mounting
Use M4 screws with plane washers and spring washers to mount the Switch. Tighten each mounting screw securely to a torque of 1.18 to
1.47 Nm.
25.40.1
25.40.1
59
NC (Red)
NO (White)
Dimensions
L/R Type
D Type
Lead wire
VSF
12
13
VCT
19
11
20
Lead wire
VSF
12
12
VCT
19
11
16
Note: No models with molded terminals are approved by UL, CSA, or TV.
60
Connection to
terminal
Black: COM
White: NO
Red: NC
Length (m)
1, 3
Precautions
Refer to pages 25 to 30 of General Information for details.
Correct Use
Panel Mount Switch (Z-15@Q@, Z-01@Q@)
4.3 dia.
8
20 max.
A cable 8.5 to 10.5 mm in diameter can be applicable to the sealing rubber of the lead outlet of the Switch. A two-core or threecore VCT cable having a cross-sectional area of 1.25 mm2 is
especially suitable for this.
Use M4 small screws with spring toothed washer are used as the
terminal screws.
Wiring
To attach the Protective Cover to the case, hold the cover in
almost parallel to the case and then push it to the case. If the
cover is pushed diagonally, the rubber packing may slip off,
degrading the sealability of the Switch.
Incorrect
Terminal with
toothed washer
Rubber packing
Correct
61
DC voltage (V)
Item
Z-01H
Z-15@, Z-10FY
160 mA at 5 VDC
Others
Do not apply an excessive force to the mounting bracket with a
screwdriver or a similar object when attaching or detaching the
protective cover; otherwise, the cover will be deformed.
Screwdriver
0.8 W
26 mA 100 mA
Operating range
for micro load
models Z-01H
Operating
range for
generalload models
Z-15H, H2
Z-15G
Z-15E
Z-10FY
Z-15ER
1 mA
100 mA 160 mA
Current (mA)
62
In the interest of product improvement, specifications are subject to change without notice.
A
High-capacity Switch Capable of
Handling 20 A Loads with Large Inrush
Currents
Same shape as OMRON Z Basic Switches except in pin
plunger position, yet endures inrush currents as large as
75 A.
2 3
1. Ratings
20: 20 A (250 VAC)
2. Contact Gap
G:
0.5 mm
3. Actuator
None: Pin plunger
D:
Short spring plunger
Q:
Panel mount plunger
Q21: Panel mount cross roller plunger
Q22: Panel mount roller plunger
V:
Hinge lever
V2: Hinge roller lever
V21: Short hinge lever
V22: Short hinge roller lever
4. Terminals
None: Solder terminal
B:
Screw terminal (with toothed washer)
63
Ordering Information
List of Models
Actuator
Solder terminal
Pin plunger
A-20G
A-20GD
A-20GD-B
A-20GQ
A-20GQ-B
A-20GQ22
A-20GQ22-B
---
A-20GQ21-B
A-20GV21
A-20GV21-B
Hinge lever
A-20GV
A-20GV-B
A-20GV22
A-20GV22-B
A-20GV2
A-20GV2-B
Specifications
Approved Standards
Agency
Standard
File No.
UL
UL508
E41515
CSA
LR21642
A-20G
1 HP 10 A L
250 VAC
2 HP
480 VAC
20 A
125 VDC
0.5 A
250 VDC
0.25 A
64
A-20G-B
Ratings
Rated voltage
Non-inductive load
Resistive load
NC
NO
NC
125 VAC
250 VAC
500 VAC
20 A
20 A
15 A
7.5 A
7.5 A
4A
8 VDC
14 VDC
30 VDC
125 VDC
250 VDC
20 A
20 A
6A
0.5 A
0.25 A
3A
3A
3A
Note: 1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Inductive load
Lamp load
Inductive load
NO
1.5 A
1.5 A
1.5 A
0.5 A
0.25 A
NC
NO
Motor load
NC
20 A
20 A
10 A
12.5 A
8.3 A
2A
20 A
15 A
5A
0.05 A
0.03 A
12.5 A
12.5 A
5A
0.05 A
0.03 A
NO
Characteristics
Operating speed
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
Contact resistance
Dielectric strength
1,000 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between terminals of the same polarity
2,000 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between the current-carrying metal parts and the ground, and between each
terminal and non-current-carrying metal parts
Vibration resistance
Shock resistance
Durability
Degree of protection
IP00
Degree of protection
against electric shock
Class I
175
Switch category
D (IEC335-1)
Ambient temperature
Ambient humidity
Weight
Approx. 23 to 58 g
Note: 1. The value is for the pin plunger. (Contact your OMRON representative for other models.)
2. Malfunction: 1 ms max.
NC
NO
65
Contact Specification
Item
Contacts
A-20
Shape
Rivet
Material
Silver alloy
0.5 mm
Inrush current NC
75 A max.
NO
75 A max.
Engineering Data
Mechanical Durability
Electrical Durability
A-20G
10
7
5
3
2
1
0.7
0.5
10
0.7
0.5
0.2
0.1
0.3
0.4
0.5
0.6
250 VAC,
cos = 1
0.2
0.2
125 VAC,
cos = 0.4
0.3
0.1
0.3
7
5
A-20G
0.1
0
0.7 0.8
Overtravel (mm)
10
15
20
25
Dimensions
Note: 1. All units are in millimeters unless otherwise indicated.
2. Unless otherwise specified, a tolerance of 0.4 mm applies to all dimensions.
Pin Plunger
19.050.25
PT
A-20G-B
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
2.3 dia.
OP
24.2
4.2+0.075
0.025
9.2
4.36+0.1
0.05 dia.
25.40.1
49.2
OP
16.30.4 mm
OF
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
3.92 to 6.13 N
2.79 N
1.3 mm
3 mm
0.2 mm
OP
26.20.5 mm
17.45+0.2
15 dia.
19.050.25
PT
OP
11.2
dia.
7.15
dia.
7.5
24.2
66
3.92 to 6.13 N
2.79 N
1.3 mm
0.25 mm
0.2 mm
11.9
OF
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
19.050.25
8.35 dia.
PT
OP
13.1
16 dia.
16.3
OF
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
3.92 to 6.13 N
2.79 N
1.3 mm
5.6 mm
0.2 mm
OP
21.80.8 mm
OF
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
6.18 N max.
2.75 N
1.3 mm
3.58 mm
0.35 mm
OP
33.41.2 mm
OF
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
6.18 N max.
2.75 N
1.3 mm
3.58 mm
0.35 mm
OP
33.41.2 mm
OF
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
1.57 N max.
0.41 N
6.5 mm
1.2 mm
1.2 mm
OP
190.8 mm
OF
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
0.69 N max.
0.14 N
15.9 mm
4 mm
2.4 mm
OP
190.8 mm
Note: 1. Do not use both M12 mounting screw and mounting holes at the same time.
2. Imperfect screw part with a maximum length of 1.5 mm.
PT
19.050.25
OP
15.5 note 2)
16.3
Note: 1. Do not use both M12 mounting screw and mounting holes at the same time.
2. Imperfect screw part with a maximum length of 1.5 mm.
PT
OP
19.050.25
(See
15.5 note 2)
M12 1 mounting
screw (see note 1)
16 dia.
16.3
Note: 1. Do not use both M12 mounting screw and mounting holes at the same time.
2. Imperfect screw part with a maximum length of 1.5 mm.
24.560.25
A-20GV21-B
t=1
(stainlesssteel lever)
4.9
28.3R
PT
20.2
14.7 OP
17.9
Hinge Lever
A-20GV-B
24.560.25
63.5R
t = 1 (stainless-steel lever)
4.9
20.2
17.9
14.7
67
24.560.25
t=1
(stainlesssteel lever)
PT
26.2R
OP
20.2
17.9
24.560.25
t=1
(stainlesssteel lever)
PT
48.4R
OP
20.2
1.57 N
0.41 N
6.3 mm
1.2 mm
1.2 mm
OP
29.80.8 mm
OF
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
0.88 N
0.14 N
12 mm
2.4 mm
2.2 mm
OP
30.20.8 mm
14.7
OF
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
17.9
14.7
Terminals
Solder Terminal
6.4
9.2
20
25.40.1 11.9
20
17.450.2
17.450.2
49.2
Three, M4 5.5
Terminal screws
(with toothed
washer)
49.2
Mounting
Use M4 mounting screws with plane washers or spring washers
to securely mount the Switch. Tighten the screws to a torque of
1.18 to 1.47 Nm.
The Switch can be panel mounted, provided that the hexagonal
nut of the actuator is tightened to a torque of 2.94 to 4.9 Nm.
Mounting Holes
Two, 4.2 dia. mounting holes or M4
25.4+0.1
68
12.5+0.2
0
dia.
Precautions
Refer to pages 25 to 30 of General Information for details.
Correct Use
Panel-mounting (A-20GQ@)
If a Switch is side-mounted with screws, remove the hexagonal
nut of the actuator.
If a Switch is side-mounted and secured with screws, make sure
that the angle or speed of the actuating object is not excessively
large or too high, otherwise the Switch may be damaged.
If a Switch is panel-mounted, pay utmost attention to make sure
that the actuating speed or OT distance is not excessively high or
large. Not doing so may damage the Switch.
Accessories (Order
Separately)
Refer to Z/A/X/DZ Common Accessories for details about Terminal Covers, Separators, and Actuators.
In the interest of product improvement, specifications are subject to change without notice.
69
X
Direct Current Switch with Built-in
Magnetic Blowout
Incorporates a small permanent magnet in the contact
mechanism to deflect the arc to effectively extinguish it.
Same shape and mounting procedures as the Z Basic
Switches.
1. Ratings
10: 10 A (125 VDC)
2. Contact Gap
G:
0.9 mm
3. Actuator
None: Pin plunger
D:
Short spring plunger
S:
Slim spring plunger
Q:
Panel mount plunger
Q21: Panel mount cross roller plunger
Q22: Panel mount roller plunger
L:
Leaf spring
W:
Hinge lever
W2: Hinge roller lever
W21: Short hinge lever
W22: Short hinge roller lever
W4: Low-force hinge lever
M:
Reverse hinge lever
M2: Reverse hinge roller lever
M22: Reverse short hinge roller lever
70
4. Terminals
None: Solder terminal
B:
Screw terminal (with toothed washer)
Ordering Information
List of Models
Actuator
Solder
Screw
Pin plunger
X-10G
X-10G-B
Slim spring
plunger
X-10GS
X-10GS-B
Short spring
plunger
X-10GD
X-10GD-B
Panel mount
plunger
X-10GQ
X-10GQ-B
Panel mount
roller plunger
X-10GQ22
X-10GQ22-B
X-10GQ21
Leaf spring
X-10GL
X-10GL-B
X-10GW21
X-10GW21-B
X-10GQ21-B
Actuator
Solder
Screw
Hinge lever
X-10GW
X-10GW-B
Low-force hinge
lever
X-10GW4
X-10GW4-B
X-10GW22
X-10GW22-B
X-10GW2
X-10GW2-B
Reverse hinge
lever
X-10GM
X-10GM-B
Reverse short
hinge roller lever
X-10GM22
X-10GM22-B
Reverse hinge
roller lever
X-10GM2
X-10GM2-B
Note: The plungers of reverse-type models are continuously pressed by the compression coil springs and the plungers are freed by operating the levers.
Specifications
Approved Standards
Agency
Standard
File No.
UL
UL508
E41515
CSA
LR21642
X-10G
125 VDC
10 A
250 VDC
3A
71
Ratings
Rated voltage
Non-inductive load
Resistive load
Inductive load
Lamp load
NC
8 VDC
14 VDC
30 VDC
125 VDC
250 VDC
Note: 1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
10 A
10 A
10 A
10 A
3A
3A
3A
3A
3A
1.5 A
NO
1.5 A
1.5 A
1.5 A
1.5 A
0.75 A
Inductive load
NC
10 A
10 A
10 A
7.5 A
2A
Motor load
NO
10 A
10 A
10 A
6A
1.5 A
NC
5A
5A
5A
5A
2A
NO
2.5 A
2.5 A
2.5 A
2.5 A
1.5 A
Characteristics
Operating speed
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
Contact resistance
Dielectric strength
1,500 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between terminals of the same polarity, between current-carrying metal parts
and the ground, and between each terminal and non-current-carrying metal parts
Vibration resistance
Shock resistance
Durability
Degree of protection
IP00
Degree of protection
against electric shock
Class I
175
Switch category
D (IEC335-1)
Ambient temperature
Ambient humidity
Weight
Approx. 27 to 63 g
Note: 1. The values are for the pin plunger models. (Contact your OMRON representative for other models.)
2. Malfunction: 1 ms max.
Contact Specification
Item
X-10
Contacts
Material
Silver alloy
0.9 mm
Inrush current
NC
30 A max.
NO
15 A max.
NC
NO
72
Engineering Data
Mechanical Durability
(Pin Plunger)
Electrical Durability
(Pin Plunger)
50,000
5,000
10,000
7,000
5,000
3,000
2,000
1,000
700
500
1,000
700
500
300
200
125 VDC
L/R = 7 ms
100
70
50
30
20
300
200
100
3,000
2,000
30,000
10
Overtravel (mm)
10
12
14
Dimensions
Note: 1. All units are in millimeters unless otherwise indicated.
2. Unless otherwise specified, a tolerance of 0.4 mm applies to all dimensions.
Pin Plunger
X-10G-B
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia.
PT
23.30.25
2.3 dia.
OP
24.2
9.2
4.2+0.075
0.025
+0.1
4.360.05
dia.
11.9
X-10GS-B
OP
15.90.4 mm
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
5.00 N
1.12 N
0.9 mm
1.6 mm
0.18 mm
OP
28.20.5 mm
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
5.00 N
1.12 N
0.9 mm
1.6 mm
0.18 mm
OP
21.20.5 mm
5.00 N
1.12 N
0.9 mm
0.13 mm
0.18 mm
17.450.2
25.40.1
49.2
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
23.30.25
See
note 1
5.2 dia.
4 dia.
(see note 2)
OP
9 dia.
24.2
12.3 dia.
10 dia.
7.15 dia.
(see note 2)
OP
24.2
73
23.30.25
PT
8.35 dia.
M12 1 mounting screw
11.9SR
(see
note 1)
See note 3
OP
13.1
16 dia.
16.3
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
5.00 N
1.12 N
0.9 mm
5.5 mm
0.18 mm
OP
21.80.8 mm
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
5.00 N
1.12 N
0.9 mm
3.6 mm
0.18 mm
OP
33.41.2 mm
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
5.00 N
1.12 N
0.9 mm
3.6 mm
0.18 mm
OP
33.41.2 mm
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
1.96 N
0.14 N
1.6 mm (see note)
2.3 mm
FP max.
OP
22.1 mm
17.40.8 mm
23.30.25
PT
OP
See note 3
15.5
(see note 2)
16 dia.
16.3
23.30.25
PT
OP
15.5
See note 3
(see note 2)
16 dia.
16.3
Leaf Spring
X-10GL-B
4.8
49.60.8
(see note 2)
FP OP
26.2
28.2 R
X-10GW21-B
t = 1 (see note 1)
20.2 17.4
14.4
4.9
OP FP
9.2
4.2+0.075
0.025
+0.1
4.360.05
(see note 2)
dia.
25.40.1
49.2
11.9
17.450.2
+0.075
4.20.025
dia. holes
Note: 1. Stainless-steel lever
2. Three vent holes
74
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
2.45 N
0.31 N
2.1 mm
1.7 mm
FP max.
OP
25.5 mm
20.70.8 mm
Hinge Lever
X-10GW-B
t = 1 (see note 1)
4.9
63.5R
26.2
(see note 2)
20.2 17.4
14.4
OP
FP
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
1.08 N
0.14 N
4.8 mm
3.9 mm
FP max.
OP
34.6 mm
21.10.8 mm
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
0.25 N
0.05 N
14.3 mm
4.8 mm
3.9 mm
OP
21.10.8 mm
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
2.16 N
0.34 N
2.4 mm
1.7 mm
FP max.
OP
37.1 mm
32.20.8 mm
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
1.42 N
0.21 N
4 mm
3 mm
FP max.
OP
40.5 mm
32.20.8 mm
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
2.16 N
0.25 N
5.5 mm
2.1 mm
FP max.
OP
26.8 mm
21.10.8 mm
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
6.86 N
1.52 N
2 mm
0.75 mm
FP max.
OP
36.1 mm
32.20.8 mm
t= 1 (see note 1)
X-10GW4-B
4.9
63.5R
26.2
(see note 2)
PT
20.2 17.4
14.4
OP
26.2
X-10GW22-B
(see note 2)
26.6R
20.2
OP FP
17.4
14.4
t = 1 (see note 3)
X-10GW2-B
26.2
(see note 2)
48.5R
OP
20.2 17.4
FP
14.4
X-10GM-B
4.9
18.65
(see note 2)
56R
20.2 17.4
14.4
OP
FP
t = 1 (see note 3)
9.5 dia. 4 (see note 1)
18.65
(see note 2)
18.5R
20.2 17.4
OP FP
14.4
75
X-10GM2-B
18.65
40.6R
(see note 2)
OP
20.2 17.4
FP
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
3.14 N
0.49 N
4 mm
1.5 mm
FP max.
OP
37.4 mm
32.20.8 mm
14.4
Note: 1. Plastic roller
2. Three vent holes
3. Stainless-steel spring lever
Terminals
Screw Terminals (-B)
Solder Terminal
9.2
6.4
9.2
20
20
25.40.1
11.9
17.450.2
17.450.2
49.2
Three, M4 5.5
Terminal screws
(with toothed
washer)
49.2
Mounting
Use M4 mounting screws with plane washers or spring washers
to securely mount the Switch. Tighten the screws to a torque of
1.18 to 1.47 Nm.
The Switch can be panel mounted, provided that the hexagonal
nut of the actuator is tightened to a torque of 2.94 to 4.9 Nm.
Mounting Holes
Two, 4.2-dia. mounting
holes or M4 screw holes
25.40.1
76
12.5+0.2
0
dia.
Precautions
Refer to pages 25 to 30 of General Information for details.
Correct Use
Handling
Too large a dog angle and too fast operating speed may damage
the Switch when the Switch is side-mounted on the panel.
Too fast operating speed and too long overtravel of the roller
plunger Switch may result in damage to the Switch.
Accessories
(Order separately)
Refer to Z/A/X/DZ Common Accessories for details about Terminal Covers, Separators, and Actuators.
In the interest of product improvement, specifications are subject to change without notice.
77
DZ
DPDT Basic Switch for Two Independent
Circuit Control
Incorporates two completely independent built-in switches.
Ideal for switching the circuits operating on two different
voltages, and for controlling two independent circuits.
Interchangeable with OMRON Z Basic Switches, as both
switches are identical in mounting hole dimensions,
mounting pitch and pin plunger position.
1. Ratings
10: 10 A (250 VAC)
2. Contact Gap
G:
0.5 mm
3. Actuator
None: Pin plunger
V:
Hinge lever
V22: Short hinge roller lever
V2: Hinge roller lever
W:
Hinge lever
W22: Short hinge roller lever
W2: Hinge roller lever
Ordering Information
List of Models
Actuator
OT
Solder terminal
Screw terminal
Pin plunger
0.13 mm min.
DZ-10G-1A
DZ-10G-1B
Hinge lever
1.6 mm min.
DZ-10GW-1A
DZ-10GW-1B
0.4 mm min.
DZ-10GV-1A
DZ-10GV-1B
0.9 mm min.
DZ-10GW22-1A
DZ-10GW22-1B
0.13 mm min.
DZ-10GV22-1A
DZ-10GV22-1B
1.2 mm min.
DZ-10GW2-1A
DZ-10GW2-1B
0.26 mm min.
DZ-10GV2-1A
DZ-10GV2-1B
78
Specifications
Approved Standards
Agency
Standard
File No.
UL
UL508
E41515
CSA
LR21642
DZ-10G
125 VAC
10 A 1/3 HP
250 VAC
10 A 1/4 HP
480 VAC
2A
125 VDC
0.5 A
250 VDC
0.25 A
Ratings
Rated voltage
Non-inductive load
Resistive load
NC
Inductive load
Lamp load
NO
NC
Inductive load
NO
NC
Inrush current
Motor load
NO
NC
NO
125 VAC
250 VAC
10 A
10 A
2A
1.5 A
1A
0.7 A
6A
4A
3A
2A
1.5 A
1A
8 VDC
14 VDC
30 VDC
10 A
10 A
10 A
3A
3A
3A
1.5 A
1.5 A
1.5 A
6A
6A
4A
5A
5A
3A
2.5 A
2.5 A
1.5 A
125 VAC
0.5 A
0.5 A
0.05 A
0.05 A
250 VDC
0.25 A
0.25 A
0.03 A
0.03 A
NC
NO
30 A max. 15 A max.
Note: 1. Inductive load has a power factor of 0.4 min. (AC) and a time constant of 7 ms max. (DC).
2. Lamp load has an inrush current of 10 times the steady-state current.
3. Motor load has an inrush current of 6 times the steady-state current.
Characteristics
Operating speed
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
Contact resistance
Dielectric strength
Vibration resistance
Shock resistance
Durability
Ambient temperature
Ambient humidity
Weight
Approx. 30 to 50 g
Note: 1. The values are for pin plunger models. (Contact your OMRON representative for other models.)
2. Malfunction: 1 ms max.
NC1
NO1
COM2
NC2
NO2
DZ
79
Engineering Data
Mechanical Durability
(Pin Plunger)
Without load
Operating frequency:
240 operations/minute
50,000
100,000
70,000
Electrical Durability
(Pin Plunger)
30,000
10,000
7,000
5,000
3,000
10,000
7,000
5,000
Operating frequency:
20 operations/minute
Overtravel: 0.13 mm
cos = 1
3,000
300
2,000
1,000
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5 0.6
0.7
100
0.8
10
15
Overtravel (mm)
Dimensions
Dimensions and Operating Characteristics
Note: 1. All units are in millimeters unless otherwise indicated.
2. Unless otherwise specified, a tolerance of 0.4 mm applies to all dimensions.
3. The solder terminal model has a suffix -1A in its model number and its omitted dimensions are the same as the corresponding
dimensions of the pin plunger model.
Pin Plunger
DZ-10G-1B
PT
23.30.25
OP
14.5
4.2+0.075
0.025
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
5.59 N
0.56 N
1.7 mm
0.13 mm
0.4 mm
OP
15.60.4 mm
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
1.67 N
0.27 N
1.6 mm
4 mm
FP max.
OP
46.3 mm
21.81 mm
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
1.96 N
0.13 N
6 mm
0.4 mm
1.7 mm
OP
18.31 mm
8.2
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
11.9
4.36+0.1
0.05 dia.
25.40.1
49.2
17.450.2
Hinge Lever
DZ-10GW-1B
t = 1 (stainless-steel lever)
28.4
63.5R
4.9
FP
19.7 17.7
14.5 OP
*
8.2
+0.075
4.2 0.025
11.9
+0.1
25.40.1
49.2
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
17.450.2
DZ-10GV-1B
PT
63.5R
t = 1 (stainless-steel lever)
1.1
4.9
17.7 19.7
OP 14.5
8.2
+0.075
4.2 0.025
+0.075
11.9 4.2 0.025 dia. hole
+0.1
80
25.40.1
49.2
17.450.2
t = 1 (stainless-steel lever)
28.4
26.2R
FP
OP
19.7 17.7
DZ-10GV22-1B
25.40.1
49.2
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
PT
30.2R 1.1
OP
14.5
17.7
19.7
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
4.22 N
0.41 N
3 mm
0.13 mm
0.6 mm
OP
29.40.8 mm
8.2
4.2+0.075
0.025
+0.075
+0.1
39.7 mm
30.20.8 mm
17.450.2
t = 1 (Stainless-steel lever)
4.360.05 dia.
FP max.
OP
8.2
11.9
+0.1
3.92 N
0.83 N
0.9 mm
2.4 mm
14.5
4.2+0.075
0.025
4.36 0.05 dia.
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
25.40.1
11.9
17.450.2
49.2
28.4
DZ-10GW2-1B
t = 1 (stainless-steel lever)
48.4R
FP
OP
19.7 17.7
14.5
25.40.1
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
47.6 mm
31.80.8 mm
17.450.2
t = 1 (stainless-steel lever)
PT
1.1
OP
17.7
14.5
19.7
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
2.65 N
0.33 N
4 mm
0.26 mm
1.1 mm
OP
29.40.8 mm
8.2
4.2+0.075
0.025
4.36+0.1
0.05 dia.
FP max.
OP
11.9
49.2
DZ-10GV2-1B
2.09 N
0.41 N
1.2 mm
3.3 mm
8.2
4.2+0.075
0.025
+0.1
4.360.05
dia.
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
4.2+0.075
0.025 dia. hole
17.450.2
25.40.1 11.9
49.2
DZ
81
Terminals
Solder Terminals (-1A)
Mounting
Use M4 mounting screws with plane washers or spring washers
to securely mount the Switch. Tighten the screws to a torque of
1.18 to 1.47 Nm.
Mounting Holes
Two, 4.2 dia. mounting holes or
M4 screw holes
25.4 0.1
Precautions
Refer to pages 25 to 30 of General Information for details.
Cautions
Terminal Connection
When soldering lead wires to the Switch, make sure that the
capacity of the soldering iron is 60 W maximum. Do not take more
than 5 s to solder any part of the Switch. Improper soldering may
cause abnormal heat radiation from the Switch and the Switch
may burn.
The characteristics of the Switch will deteriorate if a soldering iron
with a capacity of more than 60 W is applied to any part of the
Switch for 6 s or more.
Operation
Accessories (Order
separately)
Refer to Z/A/X/DZ Common Accessories for details about Terminal Covers, Separators, and Actuators.
82
In the interest of product improvement, specifications are subject to change without notice.
TZ
Stable Operation at an Ambient
Temperature of 400C
Incorporates a ceramic insulator, cobalt-alloy spring, and
special-alloy contact, thus ensuring high contact reliability
at high ambient temperature.
Smoothly operates at an ambient temperature of 400C.
Ordering Information
List of Model
Actuator
Model
Pin plunger
TZ-1G
Hinge lever
TZ-1GV
TZ-1GV22
TZ-1GV2
TZ
83
Specifications
Ratings
Rated
voltage
Lamp load
NO
NC
Inductive load
NO
NC
Motor load
NO
NC
NO
125 VAC
250 VAC
1
1
0.9
0.45
0.45
0.3
1
1
1.5
0.45
0.75
0.3
8 VDC
14 VDC
30 VDC
125 VDC
1
1
1
0.4
0.9
0.9
0.9
0.05
0.45
0.45
0.45
0.05
1
1
1
0.4
1.5
1.5
1.5
0.05
1.5
1.5
1.5
0.05
Note: 1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
The above current ratings are the values of the steady-state current.
Inductive load has a power factor of 0.4 min. (AC) and a time constant of 7 ms max. (DC).
Lamp load has an inrush current of 10 times the steady-state current.
Motor load has an inrush current of 6 times the steady-state current.
The above ratings are tested under the following conditions.
1. Ambient temperature: 202 C
2. Ambient humidity: 655%
3. Switching frequency: 20 times/min
Characteristics
Operating speed
Operating frequency
Mechanical: 60 operations/min
Electrical:
20 operations/min
Insulation resistance
Contact resistance
Dielectric strength
Vibration resistance
Shock resistance
Durability
Degree of protection
IP00
Class I
Ambient temperature
Operating:
Ambient humidity
Operating:
Weight
Approx. 45 to 54 g
Contact Specifications
Item
Contact
Inrush current
84
Specification
Cross bar
Material
Platinum alloy
0.5 mm
NC
9 A max.
NO
4.5 A max.
Nomenclature
Ceramic
pushbutton
Bracket
Fixed contact
Movable spring
COM
NC
NO
Movable contact
Fixed contact
Dimensions
Dimensions and Operating Characteristics
Note: 1. All units are in millimeters unless otherwise indicated.
2. Each dimension has a tolerance of 0.4 mm unless otherwise specified.
Pin Plunger
TZ-1G
(Ceramic pushbutton)
8.2 dia.
3 dia.
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
4.9 N
1.12 N
0.4 mm
0.13 mm
0.15 mm
OP
15.60.6 mm
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
0.98 N
0.14 N
3.5 mm
4.6 mm
1.3 mm
OP
181.2 mm
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
2.35 N
0.34 N
1.5 mm
1.9 mm
0.6 mm
OP
28.61.2 mm
Three, M3.5
11.4
Hinge Lever
TZ-1GV
(Stainless-steel lever)
63.5R
Two, 3.56-dia.
holes
Three, M3.5
11.4
(Stainless-steel lever)
TZ-1GV22
26.2R
Two, 3.56-dia.
holes
11.4
Three, M3.5
TZ
85
TZ-1GV2
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
1.27 N
0.2 N
2.6 mm
3.5 mm
1 mm
OP
28.61.2 mm
Two, 3.56-dia.
holes
11.4
Three, M3.5
Precautions
Refer to pages 25 to 30 of General Information for details.
Correct Use
Handling
Operation
The Switch has a ceramic casing. Do not drop the Switch from a
height of 30 cm or more. Doing so will break the casing.
Mounting
Be sure to turn OFF the power supply to the Switch before mounting, dismounting, wiring, or working on the Switch for maintenance. Not doing so may result in an electric shock or the Switch
may burn.
Mount the switch with M3.5 stainless-steel screws with plane
washer and spring washers securely.
Use M3.5 stainless-steel mounting screws with plane washers or
spring washers to securely mount the Switch. Tighten the screws
to a torque of 0.69 to 0.98 Nm.
Mounting Holes
Two, 3.56-dia. mounting holes or
M3.5 screw holes
25.4 0.1
Connect nickel-plated solderless terminals to the TZ. Each terminal must be secured on the TZ with M3.5 nut.
Make sure that the ceramic case is free of metal powder or other
impurities.
86
In the interest of product improvement, specifications are subject to change without notice.
Z/A/X/DZ
Ordering Information
List of Models
Terminal Covers (Sold Separately)
Common to Z, A, X, and DZ Models
The Terminal Cover is secured with mounting screws and protects the casing and terminal wires from dust, vibration, or fingers, thus preventing terminal short-circuiting, ground faults, wire disconnection or improper connection, and electric shock accidents.
Terminal Covers made of phenol resin have five or six thin wall sections. These sections can be torn open for providing holes for lead cables
at desired points.
Application Soldering terminal use
Material
Mounting direction
Remarks
Model
Phenol resin
Side mounting
AP-A
AP-B
---
Side mounting
AP1-A
AP1-B
Vinyl chloride
Side mounting
AP-Z
---
Note: Use the screw-terminal use Terminal Cover for DZ-series soldering-terminal models.
Hinge lever
XAA-1
ZAA-2
Short
ZAQ-3
Medium
ZAQ-2
Long
ZAQ-1
ZAQ-22
Z/A/X/DZ
87
Dimensions
Dimensions and Operating Characteristics
Terminal Covers
AP-A
AP-B
2.15R
2.15R
6.5
Note: The Cover has five thin, easy-to-separate portions for easy lead wire connections.
Note: The Cover has six thin, easy-to-separate portions for easy lead wire connections.
AP1-A
AP1-B
2.15R
2.15R
AP-Z
Soldering or Screw Terminal Use
(Vinyl Chloride)
Pressure plate
(t1 steel)
Nut
M3 20 Phillips screw
(with plane washer and
nut)
6 dia.
Note: Each dimension has a tolerance of 0.4 mm unless otherwise specified. (0.8 mm for the AP-Z)
88
B-B' cross-section
Separator
Two, 4.5 dia.
Note: 1. Each dimension has a tolerance of +0.4 mm unless
otherwise specified.
2. The material is EAVTC (Epoxide Alkyd Varnished
Tetron Cloth) and its heat-resisting temperature is
130C.
t = 0.38
Actuators
Note: These Actuators are not provided with Switches.
Hinge Lever
XAA-1
Model
Two, M4 30
Two, M4
Stainless steel
60R
Z-15G-B
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
4.90 N
1.67 N
6 mm
12.7 mm
2.2 mm
FP max.
32.91.6 mm
X-10G-B
4.90 N
1.67 N
6 mm
12.7 mm
3.3 mm
Model
Two, M4 30
Two, M4
ZAA-2
Z-15G-B
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
4.90 N
1.67 N
6 mm
12.7 mm
2.2 mm
FP max.
44.51.6 mm
X-10G-B
4.90 N
1.67 N
6 mm
12.7 mm
3.3 mm
58.5R
Z/A/X/DZ
89
Model
23.3
12SR
M12 1 mounting
screw
(Note 1)
2 t 14 width across
flats
(Note 3)
14.5
dia.
2 t 15.6 width
across flats
Two M4 nuts
Two M4 25 round
head screw
(Note 2)
ZAQ-3
Z-15E-B
7.9 dia.
X-10G-B
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
8.34 N
1.12 N
0.8 mm
4.8 mm
0.15 mm
5.39 N
1.12 N
1 mm
4.5 mm
0.2 mm
OP
27.81.5 mm
Note: This Actuator (pin plunger) can be used with Standard Pin Plungers (Z-15G(-B), Z-15E(-B), X-10G(-B), DZ-10G-1A(-1B)) for the Z,
X, and DZ models.
Model
ZAQ-2
23.3
12SR
M12 1 mounting
screw
2 t 14 width across
flats
(Note 1)
2 t 15.6 width
across flats
(Note 3)
ZAQ-2
Z-15E-B
7.9 dia.
14.5
dia.
Two M4 25
screw
X-10G-B
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
8.34 N
1.12 N
0.8 mm
4.8 mm
0.15 mm
5.39 N
1.12 N
1 mm
4.5 mm
0.2 mm
OP
53.21.5 mm
Two M4 nuts
(Note 2)
Note: This Actuator (pin plunger) can be used with Standard Pin Plungers (Z-15G(-B), Z-15E(-B), X-10G(-B), DZ-10G-1A(-1B)) for the Z,
X, and DZ models.
Model
ZAQ-1
23.3
12SR
(Note 1)
M12 1 mounting
screw
2 t 14 width across
flats
2 t 15.6 width
across flats
(Note 3)
14.5
dia.
Two, M4 25 screws
(Note 2)
ZAQ-1
Z-15E-B
X-10G-B
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
8.34 N
1.12 N
0.8 mm
20.6 mm
0.15 mm
5.39 N
1.12 N
1 mm
20.4 mm
0.2 mm
OP
69.11.5 mm
Two, M4 nuts
Note: This Actuator (pin plunger) can be used with Standard Pin Plungers (Z-15G(-B), Z-15E(-B), X-10G(-B), DZ-10G-1A(-1B)) for the Z,
X, and DZ models.
90
ZAQ-22
48
PT
23.30.25
OP
1.6
(Note 3)
14.5
dia.
20.7
18.9
23.9
(Note 2)
11.9
25.40.2
49.2
Two, M4 25
screws
20.7
ZAQ-22
Z-15E-B
Spring washer
DZ-10G-B
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
8.34 N
1.12 N
2 mm
3.58 mm
0.15 mm
11.1 N
1.12 N
2 mm
1 mm
0.46 mm
OP
370.8 mm 35.41.2 mm
Note: This Actuator (roller plunger) can be used with standard pin plungers (Z-15G(B), Z-15E(-B), and DZ10G-1A(-1B)).
It cannot be used with X
models.
In the interest of product improvement, specifications are subject to change without notice.
Z/A/X/DZ
91
D3V
Ordering Information
D3V-@@@@-@@@-@-@
1 2 3 4
5 6 7
1. Ratings
21:
20 (4) A at 250 VAC
16:
16 (3) A at 250 VAC
11:
11 (3) A at 250 VAC
6:
6 (2) A at 250 VAC
01:
0.1 A at 125 VAC
2. Contact Gap
None: 1 mm (F gap)
G:
0.5 mm (G gap)
3. Actuator
None: Pin plunger
1:
Short hinge lever
2:
Hinge lever
3:
Long hinge lever
4:
Simulated roller lever
5:
Short hinge roller lever
6:
Hinge roller lever
4. Hinge Position
None: Internal/Far from plunger
M:
External/Far from plunger
K:
External/Near plunger
92
5. Contact Form
1:
SPDT
2:
SPST-NC
3:
SPST-NO
6. Terminals
A:
Solder terminals
C2:
Quick-connect terminals (#187)
C:
Quick-connect terminals (#250)
7. Maximum Operating Force
5:
1.96 N {200 gf}
4A:
1.23 N {125 gf}
4:
0.98 N {100 gf}
3:
0.49 N {50 gf}
2:
0.25 N {25 gf}
Note:
D3V
D3V
Available Combinations
Model
D3V-21
D3V-16
D3V-11
D3V-6
21 A
16 A
11 A
6A
Rated current
OF max.
Heat
resistance
Contact
gap
Terminals
Standard
(85C)
#250
Standard
(105C)
High temperature
(125C)
Note:
1.23 N
{125 gf}
G
1.96 N
{200 gf}
F
0.98 N
{100 gf}
F/G
1.96 N
{200 gf}
0.98 N
{100 gf}
0.49 N
{50 gf}
1.96 N
{200 gf}
F/G
0.1 A
0.98 N
{100 gf}
F
D3V-01
0.49 N
{50 gf}
0.49 N
{50 gf}
0.25 N
{25 gf}
#187
#187
#250
#187
#250
1. : Standard
: Semi-standard
2. Consult your OMRON sales representative for specific models with standard approvals.
93
D3V
D3V
List of Models
Hinge position
Contact form
SPDT
SPST-NC
SPST-NO
Pin plunger
---
D3V-21G-1@4A-
D3V-21G-2@4A-
D3V-21G-3@4A-
Internal
D3V-21G1-1@4A-
D3V-21G1-2@4A-
D3V-21G1-3@4A-
D3V-21G1M-1@4A-
D3V-21G1M-2@4A-
D3V-21G1M-3@4A-
Internal
D3V-21G2-1@4A-
D3V-21G2-2@4A-
D3V-21G2-3@4A-
D3V-21G2M-1@4A-
D3V-21G2M-2@4A-
D3V-21G2M-3@4A-
Internal
D3V-21G3-1@4A-
D3V-21G3-2@4A-
D3V-21G3-3@4A-
D3V-21G3M-1@4A-
D3V-21G3M-2@4A-
D3V-21G3M-3@4A-
Internal
D3V-21G4-1@4A-
D3V-21G4-2@4A-
D3V-21G4-3@4A-
D3V-21G4M-1@4A-
D3V-21G4M-2@4A-
D3V-21G4M-3@4A-
Internal
D3V-21G5-1@4A-
D3V-21G5-2@4A-
D3V-21G5-3@4A-
D3V-21G5M-1@4A-
D3V-21G5M-2@4A-
D3V-21G5M-3@4A-
Internal
D3V-21G6-1@4A-
D3V-21G6-2@4A-
D3V-21G6-3@4A-
D3V-21G6M-1@4A-
D3V-21G6M-2@4A-
D3V-21G6M-3@4A-
Hinge lever
Long hinge lever
Simulated roller lever
Short hinge roller lever
Hinge roller lever
Hinge position
Contact form
SPDT
SPST-NC
SPST-NO
D3V-16-1@5-
D3V-16-2@5-
D3V-16-3@5-
Pin plunger
---
Internal
D3V-161-1@5-
D3V-161-2@5-
D3V-161-3@5-
D3V-161M-1@5-
D3V-161M-2@5-
D3V-161M-3@5-
Internal
D3V-162-1@5-
D3V-162-2@5-
D3V-162-3@5-
D3V-162M-1@5-
D3V-162M-2@5-
D3V-162M-3@5-
Internal
D3V-163-1@5-
D3V-163-2@5-
D3V-163-3@5-
D3V-163M-1@5-
D3V-163M-2@5-
D3V-163M-3@5-
Internal
D3V-164-1@5-
D3V-164-2@5-
D3V-164-3@5-
D3V-164M-1@5-
D3V-164M-2@5-
D3V-164M-3@5-
Internal
D3V-165-1@5-
D3V-165-2@5-
D3V-165-3@5-
D3V-165M-1@5-
D3V-165M-2@5-
D3V-165M-3@5-
Internal
D3V-166-1@5-
D3V-166-2@5-
D3V-166-3@5-
D3V-166M-1@5-
D3V-166M-2@5-
D3V-166M-3@5-
Hinge lever
Long hinge lever
Simulated roller lever
Short hinge roller lever
Hinge roller lever
Note:
94
D3V
D3V
Hinge position
Contact form
SPDT
D3V-16-3@4-
Internal
D3V-161-1@4-
D3V-161-2@4-
D3V-161-3@4-
D3V-161M-1@4-
D3V-161M-2@4-
D3V-161M-3@4-
Internal
D3V-162-1@4-
D3V-162-2@4-
D3V-162-3@4-
D3V-162M-1@4-
D3V-162M-2@4-
D3V-162M-3@4-
Internal
D3V-163-1@4-
D3V-163-2@4-
D3V-163-3@4-
D3V-163M-1@4-
D3V-163M-2@4-
D3V-163M-3@4-
Internal
D3V-164-1@4-
D3V-164-2@4-
D3V-164-3@4-
D3V-164M-1@4-
D3V-164M-2@4-
D3V-164M-3@4-
Internal
D3V-165-1@4-
D3V-165-2@4-
D3V-165-3@4-
D3V-165M-1@4-
D3V-165M-2@4-
D3V-165M-3@4-
Internal
D3V-166-1@4-
D3V-166-2@4-
D3V-166-3@4-
D3V-166M-1@4-
D3V-166M-2@4-
D3V-166M-3@4-
SPST-NO
D3V-16-2@4-
---
Hinge lever
SPST-NC
D3V-16-1@4-
Pin plunger
Hinge position
Contact form
SPDT
SPST-NC
SPST-NO
D3V-11-1@5-
D3V-11-2@5-
D3V-11-3@5-
Pin plunger
---
Internal
D3V-111-1@5-
D3V-111-2@5-
D3V-111-3@5-
D3V-111M-1@5-
D3V-111M-2@5-
D3V-111M-3@5-
Internal
D3V-112-1@5-
D3V-112-2@5-
D3V-112-3@5-
D3V-112M-1@5-
D3V-112M-2@5-
D3V-112M-3@5-
Internal
D3V-113-1@5-
D3V-113-2@5-
D3V-113-3@5-
D3V-113M-1@5-
D3V-113M-2@5-
D3V-113M-3@5-
Internal
D3V-114-1@5-
D3V-114-2@5-
D3V-114-3@5-
D3V-114M-1@5-
D3V-114M-2@5-
D3V-114M-3@5-
Internal
D3V-115-1@5-
D3V-115-2@5-
D3V-115-3@5-
D3V-115M-1@5-
D3V-115M-2@5-
D3V-115M-3@5-
Internal
D3V-116-1@5-
D3V-116-2@5-
D3V-116-3@5-
D3V-116M-1@5-
D3V-116M-2@5-
D3V-116M-3@5-
Hinge lever
Long hinge lever
Simulated roller lever
Short hinge roller lever
Hinge roller lever
Note:
95
D3V
D3V
Hinge position
Contact form
SPDT
D3V-11-3@4-
Internal
D3V-111-1@4-
D3V-111-2@4-
D3V-111-3@4-
D3V-111M-1@4-
D3V-111M-2@4-
D3V-111M-3@4-
Internal
D3V-112-1@4-
D3V-112-2@4-
D3V-112-3@4-
D3V-112M-1@4-
D3V-112M-2@4-
D3V-112M-3@4-
Internal
D3V-113-1@4-
D3V-113-2@4-
D3V-113-3@4-
D3V-113M-1@4-
D3V-113M-2@4-
D3V-113M-3@4-
Internal
D3V-114-1@4-
D3V-114-2@4-
D3V-114-3@4-
D3V-114M-1@4-
D3V-114M-2@4-
D3V-114M-3@4-
Internal
D3V-115-1@4-
D3V-115-2@4-
D3V-115-3@4-
D3V-115M-1@4-
D3V-115M-2@4-
D3V-115M-3@4-
Internal
D3V-116-1@4-
D3V-116-2@4-
D3V-116-3@4-
D3V-116M-1@4-
D3V-116M-2@4-
D3V-116M-3@4-
SPST-NO
D3V-11-2@4-
---
Hinge lever
SPST-NC
D3V-11-1@4-
Pin plunger
Hinge position
Contact form
SPDT
SPST-NC
SPST-NO
D3V-11G-1@3-
D3V-11G-2@4-
D3V-11G-3@3-
Pin plunger
---
Internal
D3V-11G1-1@3-
D3V-11G1-2@4-
D3V-11G1-3@3-
D3V-11G1M-1@3-
D3V-11G1M-2@3-
D3V-11G1M-3@3-
Internal
D3V-11G2-1@3-
D3V-11G2-2@3-
D3V-11G2-3@3-
D3V-11G2M-1@3-
D3V-11G2M-2@3-
D3V-11G2M-3@3-
Internal
D3V-11G3-1@3-
D3V-11G3-2@3-
D3V-11G3-3@3-
D3V-11G3M-1@3-
D3V-11G3M-2@3-
D3V-11G3M-3@3-
Internal
D3V-11G4-1@3-
D3V-11G4-2@3-
D3V-11G4-3@3-
D3V-11G4M-1@3-
D3V-11G4M-2@3-
D3V-11G4M-3@3-
Internal
D3V-11G5-1@3-
D3V-11G5-2@3-
D3V-11G5-3@3-
D3V-11G5M-1@3-
D3V-11G5M-2@3-
D3V-11G5M-3@3-
Internal
D3V-11G6-1@3-
D3V-11G6-2@3-
D3V-11G6-3@3-
D3V-11G6M-1@3-
D3V-11G6M-2@3-
D3V-11G6M-3@3-
Hinge lever
Long hinge lever
Simulated roller lever
Short hinge roller lever
Hinge roller lever
Note:
96
D3V
D3V
Hinge position
Contact form
SPDT
D3V-6-3@4-
Internal
D3V-61-1@4-
D3V-61-2@4-
D3V-61-3@4-
D3V-61M-1@4-
D3V-61M-2@4-
D3V-61M-3@4-
Internal
D3V-62-1@4-
D3V-62-2@4
D3V-62-3@4-
D3V-62M-1@4-
D3V-62M-2@4-
D3V-62M-3@4-
Internal
D3V-63-1@4-
D3V-63-2@4-
D3V-63-3@4-
D3V-63M-1@4-
D3V-63M-2@4-
D3V-63M-3@4-
Internal
D3V-64-1@4-
D3V-64-2@4-
D3V-64-3@4-
D3V-64M-1@4-
D3V-64M-2@4-
D3V-64M-3@4-
Internal
D3V-65-1@4-
D3V-65-2@4-
D3V-65-3@4-
D3V-65M-1@4-
D3V-65M-2@4-
D3V-65M-3@4-
Internal
D3V-66-1@4-
D3V-66-2@4-
D3V-66-3@4-
D3V-66M-1@4-
D3V-66M-2@4-
D3V-66M-3@4-
SPST-NO
D3V-6-2@4-
---
Hinge lever
SPST-NC
D3V-6-1@4-
Pin plunger
Hinge position
Contact form
SPDT
SPST-NC
SPST-NO
D3V-6G-1@3-
D3V-6G-2@3-
D3V-6G-3@3-
Pin plunger
---
Internal
D3V-6G1-1@3-
D3V-6G1-2@3-
D3V-6G1-3@3-
D3V-6G1M-1@3-
D3V-6G1M-2@3-
D3V-6G1M-3@3-
Internal
D3V-6G2-1@3-
D3V-6G2-2@3-
D3V-6G2-3@3-
D3V-6G2M-1@3-
D3V-6G2M-2@3-
D3V-6G2M-3@3-
Internal
D3V-6G3-1@3-
D3V-6G3-2@3-
D3V-6G3-3@3-
D3V-6G3M-1@3-
D3V-6G3M-2@3-
D3V-6G3M-3@3-
Internal
D3V-6G4-1@3-
D3V-6G4-2@3-
D3V-6G4-3@3-
D3V-6G4M-1@3-
D3V-6G4M-2@3-
D3V-6G4M-3@3-
Internal
D3V-6G5-1@3-
D3V-6G5-2@3-
D3V-6G5-3@3-
D3V-6G5M-1@3-
D3V-6G5M-2@3-
D3V-6G5M-3@3-
Internal
D3V-6G6-1@3-
D3V-6G6-2@3-
D3V-6G6-3@3-
D3V-6G6M-1@3-
D3V-6G6M-2@3-
D3V-6G6M-3@3-
Hinge lever
Long hinge lever
Simulated roller lever
Short hinge roller lever
Hinge roller lever
Note:
97
D3V
D3V
Hinge position
Contact form
SPDT
D3V-01-3@3-
Internal
D3V-011-1@3-
D3V-011-2@3-
D3V-011-3@3-
D3V-011M-1@3-
D3V-011M-2@3-
D3V-011M-3@3-
Internal
D3V-012-1@3-
D3V-012-2@3-
D3V-012-3@3-
D3V-012M-1@3-
D3V-012M-2@3-
D3V-012M-3@3-
Internal
D3V-013-1@3-
D3V-013-2@3-
D3V-013-3@3-
D3V-013M-1@3-
D3V-013M-2@3-
D3V-013M-3@3-
Internal
D3V-014-1@3-
D3V-014-2@3-
D3V-014-3@3-
D3V-014M-1@3-
D3V-014M-2@3-
D3V-014M-3@3-
Internal
D3V-015-1@3-
D3V-015-2@3-
D3V-015-3@3-
D3V-015M-1@3-
D3V-015M-2@3-
D3V-015M-3@3-
Internal
D3V-016-1@3-
D3V-016-2@3-
D3V-016-3@3-
D3V-016M-1@3-
D3V-016M-2@3-
D3V-016M-3@3-
SPST-NO
D3V-01-2@3-
---
Hinge lever
SPST-NC
D3V-01-1@3-
Pin plunger
Hinge position
Contact form
SPDT
Pin plunger
Note:
98
---
D3V-01-1@2-
SPST-NC
D3V-01-2@2-
SPST-NO
D3V-01-3@2-
D3V
D3V
Specifications
Ratings
Type
Rated voltage
Non-inductive load
Resistive load
NC
D3V-21
D3V-16
D3V-11
D3V-6
D3V-01
Note:
Inductive load
Lamp load
NO
NC
Inductive load
NO
NC
Motor load
NO
NC
250 VAC
21 A
3A
12 A
4A
8 VDC
21 A
5A
12 A
7A
30 VDC
14 A
5A
12 A
5A
125 VDC
0.6 A
0.1 A
0.6 A
0.1 A
250 VDC
0.3 A
0.05 A
0.3 A
0.05 A
250 VAC
16 A
2A
10 A
3A
8 VDC
16 A
4A
10 A
6A
30 VDC
10 A
4A
10 A
4A
125 VDC
0.6 A
0.1 A
0.6 A
0.1 A
250 VDC
0.3 A
0.05 A
0.3 A
0.05 A
250 VAC
11 A
1.5 A
6A
2A
8 VDC
11 A
3A
6A
3A
30 VDC
6A
3A
6A
3A
125 VDC
0.6 A
0.1 A
0.6 A
0.1 A
250 VDC
0.3 A
0.05 A
0.3 A
0.05 A
250 VAC
6A
3A
4A
---
8 VDC
6A
3A
4A
---
30 VDC
6A
3A
4A
125 VDC
0.4 A
0.1 A
0.4 A
250 VDC
0.3 A
125 VAC
0.1 A
0.05 A
---
0.2 A
---
---
8 VDC
0.1 A
---
---
---
30 VDC
0.1 A
NO
1. The above current values are the normal current values of models with a contact gap of 1 mm (gap F), which vary with the normal
current values of models with a contact gap of 0.5 mm (gap G).
2. Inductive load has a power factor of 0.4 min. (AC) and a time constant of 7 ms max. (DC).
3. Lamp load has an inrush current of 10 times the steady-state current.
4. Motor load has an inrush current of 6 times the steady-state current.
5. The ratings values apply under the following test conditions:
Ambient temperature: 202C
Ambient humidity: 655%
Operating frequency: 30 operations/min
99
D3V
D3V
Characteristics
Operating speed
Operating frequency
30 operations/min max.
Insulation resistance
D3V-21: 50 m max.
D3V-16, D3V-11, D3V-6: 30 m max.
D3V-01, 0.49 N {50 gf}:50 m max.
0.25 N {25 gf}:100 m max.
1,000 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between terminals of the same polarity
2,000 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between current-carrying metal parts and ground, and between
each terminal and non-current-carrying metal parts
Degree of protection
IEC IP40
Class I
250
D3V-21, D3V-01:
25C to 85C (with no icing)
D3V-16, D3V-11, D3V-6: 25C to 105C (with no icing)
Weight
Note:
Approved Standards
Consult your OMRON sales representative for specific models with standard approvals.
D3V-21G
D3V-16
D3V-16G
D3V-11
D3V-11G
D3V-6
D3V-6G
D3V-01
---
6 A, 1/4 HP
0.1 A
250 VAC
20.1 A
6 A, 1/4 HP
---
125 VDC
---
0.6 A
0.1 A
0.6 A
0.1 A
---
---
---
250 VDC
---
0.3 A
---
0.3 A
---
---
---
---
D3V-21G
D3V-16
D3V-11
D3V-6
D3V-01
125 VAC
---
---
---
---
0.1 A
250 VAC
20 (4) A
16 (3) A
11 (3) A
6 (2) A
---
Testing conditions: 5E4 (50,000 operations), T85 (0C to 85C) for D3V-21/D3V-01, T105 (0C to 105C) for D3V-16/D3V-11/D3V-6
Rated voltage
250 VAC
D3V-21G
21 (8) A
100
D3V
D3V
Contact Specifications
Item
Contact
D3V-21
Specification
Inrush current
D3V-16
D3V-11
D3V-6
D3V-01
Rivet
Crossbar
Material
Silver alloy
Gap
(standard value)
0.5 mm
1.0 mm
Gold alloy
NC
50 A max.
40 A max.
---
24 A max.
15 A max.
NO
Minimum applicable load (see note)
Note:
160 mA at 5 VDC
1 mA at 5 VDC
For more information on the minimum applicable load, refer to Using Micro Loads on page 109.
Contact Form
SPDT
SPST-NC
SPST-NO
NC
NC
NO
NO
COM
COM
COM
Dimensions
Terminals
Note:
Terminal
type
Solder Terminals(A)
COM
Quick-connect Terminals
(#250) (C)
(5.5)
(5.5)
(4.9)
(6.5)
(6.5)
(7.7)
2.9
3.2
2.9
t = 0.5 (10)
Three, solder terminals
Terminal
dimensions
Quick-connect Terminals
(#187) (C2)
6.35
3.2 (see note)
4.750.1
t = 0.5 (10)
Three, quick-connect
terminals (#187)
(12.0)
t = 0.8
Three, quick-connect
terminals (#250)
8
6.35
3.2
3.95
4.750.1
6.350.1
2.4 dia. 1.6 dia.
Note: Indicates the length to the center of the
1.6-dia. holes
Mounting Holes
Two, 3.1-dia. mounting holes or
M3 screw holes
10.30.1
22.20.1
101
D3V
D3V
Note:
Model
t=0.5
Three, quick-connect
terminals (#187)
D3V-21G-1@4A-
D3V-16-1@5-
D3V-11-1@5-
D3V-11-1@4-
D3V-6-1@4-
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
1.2 mm
1.0 mm
0.3 mm
1.2 mm
1.0 mm
0.4 mm (F gap type) or 0.3 mm (G gap type)
OP
14.70.4 mm
102
D3V-6G-1@3-
0.49 N {50 gf}
0.05 N {5 gf}
D3V-01-1@3-
0.49 N {50 gf}
0.05 N {5 gf}
1.2 mm
1.0 mm
0.4 mm
D3V-01-1@2-
0.25 N {25 gf}
0.03 N {3 gf}
D3V
D3V
Model
D3V-21G1-1@4A-
0.7
22.1
t=0.5
8.1
3.1+0.13
0.03 dia. hole 1.6
D3V-21G1-1@4A-
D3V-161-1@5-
D3V-111-1@5-
D3V-111-1@4-
D3V-61-1@4-
D3V-6G1-1@3-
D3V-011-1@3-
10.30.1
15.9 7.2
2.8
(10)
t=0.5
Three, #187 series tab
D3V-161-1@5-
D3V-111-1@5-
D3V-111-1@4-
D3V-61-1@4-
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
1.6 mm
0.8 mm
0.5 mm
1.6 mm
0.8 mm
0.6 mm (F gap type) or 0.5 mm (G gap type)
OP
15.20.5 mm
4.2
2.8
4
18.7
2.85
PT
OP
3.1+0.13
0.03
10.3
D3V-6G1-1@3-
D3V-011-1@3-
D3V-21G1M-1@4A-
D3V-161M-1@5-
D3V-111M-1@5-
D3V-111M-1@4-
D3V-61M-1@4-
D3V-6G1M-1@3-
D3V-011M-1@3-
t=0.5
Three, quick-connect
terminals (#187)
Model
D3V-21G1M-1@4A-
D3V-161M-1@5-
D3V-111M-1@5-
D3V-111M-1@4-
D3V-61M-1@4-
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
1.6 mm
0.8 mm
0.5 mm
1.6 mm
0.8 mm
0.6 mm (F gap type) or 0.5 mm (G gap type)
OP
15.20.5 mm
D3V-6G1M-1@3-
D3V-011M-1@3-
A
3.1+0.13
0.03 dia. hole
1.6
27.90.8
t=0.5
14.3
8.5
D3V-21G1K-1@4A-
D3V-161K-1@5-
D3V-111K-1@5-
D3V-111K-1@4-
D3V-61K-1@4-
D3V-6G1K-1@3-
D3V-011K-1@3-
PT
2.85
4.5
0.7
2.8
4
18.7
10.30.1
15.9 7.2
OP
+0.13
t=0.5
Three, #187 series tab
Model
D3V-21G1K-1@4A-
D3V-161K-1@5-
D3V-111K-1@5-
2.8
(10)
D3V-111K-1@4-
D3V-61K-1@4-
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
3.5 mm
1.1 mm
1.1 mm
3.5 mm
1.1 mm
1.2 mm (F gap type) or 1.1 mm (G gap type)
OP
15.21.2 mm
3.10.03
10.3
27.8
37.80.8
D3V-6G1K-1@3-
D3V-011K-1@3-
103
D3V
D3V
A
35.60.8
3.1+0.13
0.03 dia. hole 1.6
t=0.5
2.8
4
18.8
D3V-21G2-1@4A-
D3V-162-1@5-
D3V-112-1@5-
2.85 4.2
PT
8.1
0.7
10.30.1
15.9 7.2
2.8
(10)
t=0.5
Three, #187 series tab
Model
D3V-21G2-1@4A-
D3V-162-1@5-
D3V-112-1@5-
D3V-112-1@4-
D3V-62-1@4-
D3V-6G2-1@3-
D3V-012-1@3-
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
4.0 mm
1.6 mm
0.8 mm
4.0 mm
1.6 mm
1.5 mm (F gap type) or 0.8 mm (G gap type)
OP
15.21.2 mm
3.1+0.13
0.03
D3V-112-1@4-
D3V-62-1@4
OP
10.3
D3V-6G2-1@3-
D3V-012-1@3-
D3V-21G2M-1@4A-
D3V-162M-1@5-
D3V-112M-1@5-
D3V-112M-1@4-
D3V-62M-1@4-
D3V-6G2M-1@3-
D3V-012M-1@3-
t=0.5
Three, quick-connect
terminals (#187)
Model
D3V-21G2M-1@4A-
D3V-162M-1@5-
D3V-112M-1@5-
D3V-112M-1@4-
D3V-62M-1@4
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
4.0 mm
1.6 mm
0.8 mm
4.0 mm
1.6 mm
1.5 mm (F gap type) or 0.8 mm (G gap type)
OP
15.21.2 mm
D3V-6G2M-1@3-
D3V-012M-1@3-
D3V-21G2K-1@4A-
D3V-162K-1@5-
D3V-112K-1@5-
D3V-112K-1@4-
D3V-62K-1@4-
D3V-6G2K-1@3-
D3V-012K-1@3-
3.1 +0.13
0.03 dia. hole
0.7
D3V-21G2K-1@4A-
t=0.5
18.7
D3V-162K-1@5-
D3V-112K-1@5-
2.8
(10)
D3V-112K-1@4-
D3V-62K-1@4
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
6.0 mm
2.5 mm
1.3 mm
6.0 mm
2.5 mm
2.0 mm (F gap type) or 1.3 mm (G gap type)
OP
15.22.0 mm
PT
2.85
4.5
2.8
10.30.1 OP
OF max.
RF min.
104
41.40
14.3
8.5
15.9 7.2
t=0.5
Three, #187 series tab
Model
1.6
3.1+0.13
0.03
10.3
27.8
37.80.8
D3V-6G2K-1@3-
D3V-012K-1@3-
D3V
D3V
D3V-21G3-1@4A-
D3V-163-1@5-
D3V-113-1@5-
D3V-113-1@4-
D3V-63-1@4-
D3V-6G3-1@3-
D3V-013-1@3-
59.40.8
t=0.5
1.6
8.1
0.7
PT
2.85 4.2
2.8
4
15.9 7.2
18.7
10.30.1
OP
+0.13
2.8
(10)
t=0.5
Three, #187 series tab
3.10.03
10.3
37.80.8
Model
D3V-21G3-1@4A-
D3V-163-1@5-
D3V-113-1@5-
D3V-113-1@4-
D3V-63-1@4-
D3V-6G3-1@3-
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
9.0 mm
2.0 mm
2.0 mm
9.0 mm
2.0 mm
2.8 mm (F gap type) or 2.0 mm (G gap type)
9.0 mm
3.2 mm
2.8 mm (F gap type) or 2.0 mm (G gap type)
OP
+2.6
15.2 3.2 mm
D3V-013-1@3-
15.22.6 mm
D3V-21G3M-1@4A-
D3V-163M-1@5-
D3V-113M-1@5-
D3V-113M-1@4-
D3V-63M-1@4-
D3V-6G3M-1@3-
D3V-013M-1@3-
t=0.5
Three, quick-connect
terminals (#187)
Model
D3V-21G3M-1@4A-
D3V-163M-1@5-
D3V-113M-1@5-
D3V-113M-1@4-
D3V-63M-1@4-
D3V-6G3M-1@3-
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
9.0 mm
2.0 mm
2.0 mm
9.0 mm
2.0 mm
2.8 mm (F gap type) or 2.0 mm (G gap type)
9.0 mm
3.2 mm
2.8 mm (F gap type) or 2.0 mm (G gap type)
OP
+2.6
15.2 3.2 mm
D3V-013M-1@3-
15.22.6 mm
D3V-21G3K-1@4A-
D3V-163K-1@5-
D3V-113K-1@5-
D3V-113K-1@4-
D3V-63K-1@4-
D3V-6G3K-1@3-
D3V-013K-1@3-
3.1+0.13
0.03 dia. hole 1.6
14.3
8.5
65.20.8
t=0.5
PT
2.85 4.5
0.7
2.8
OP
10.30.1
4
15.9 7.2
18.7
2.8
t=0.5
Three, #187 series tab
(10)
3.1+0.13
0.03
10.3
27.8
37.80.8
Model
D3V-21G3K-1@4A-
D3V-163K-1@5-
D3V-113K-1@5-
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
15.0 mm
4.0 mm
3.0 mm
15.0 mm
4.0 mm
3.8 mm (F gap type) or 3.0 mm (G gap type)
OP
15.23.0 mm
D3V-113K-1@4-
D3V-63K-1@4-
0.20 N {20 gf}
---
D3V-6G3K-1@3-
D3V-013K-1@3-
105
D3V
D3V
A
1.6
PT
2.8
4
18.8
D3V-21G4-1@4A-
D3V-164-1@5-
D3V-114-1@5-
2.8
(10)
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
4.0 mm
1.6 mm
1.4 mm
4.0 mm
1.6 mm
1.5 mm (F gap type) or 0.8 mm (G gap type)
OP
18.71.2 mm
3.1+0.13
0.03
10.3
22.20.1
27.8
37.80.8
D3V-114-1@4-
D3V-64-1@4-
OP
10.30.1
15.9 7.2
OF max.
RF min.
2.85 4.2
t=0.5
8.1
0.7
t=0.5
Three, #187 series tab
Model
32.50.8
+0.13
D3V-6G4-1@3-
D3V-014-1@3-
D3V-21G4M-1@4A-
D3V-164M-1@5-
D3V-114M-1@5-
D3V-114M-1@4-
D3V-64M-1@4-
D3V-6G4M-1@3-
D3V-014M-1@3-
t=0.5
Three, quick-connect
terminals (#187)
Model
D3V-21G4M-1@4A-
D3V-164M-1@5-
D3V-114M-1@5-
D3V-114M-1@4-
D3V-64M-1@4-
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
4.0 mm
1.6 mm
1.4 mm
4.0 mm
1.6 mm
1.5 mm (F gap type) or 0.8 mm (G gap type)
OP
18.71.2 mm
1.6
0.7
38.40.8
14.3
8.5
+0.13
PT
18.7
15.9
D3V-164K-1@5-
D3V-114K-1@5-
2.8
2.8
(10)
D3V-114K-1@4-
D3V-64K-1@4-
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
8.0 mm
1.5 mm
3.0 mm
8.0 mm
1.5 mm
3.5 mm (F gap type) or 3.0 mm (G gap type)
OP
18.71.2 mm
OP
10.30.1
7.2
2.85 4.5
t=0.5
OF max.
RF min.
106
4.0 mm
1.6 mm
1.5 mm
t=0.5
Three, #187 series tab
D3V-21G4K-1@4A-
D3V-014M-1@3-
D3V-21G4K-1@4A-
D3V-164K-1@5-
D3V-114K-1@5-
D3V-114K-1@4-
D3V-64K-1@4-
D3V-6G4K-1@3-
D3V-014K-1@3-
Model
D3V-6G4M-1@3-
+0.13
3.10.03
D3V-6G4K-1@3-
10.3
D3V-014K-1@3-
D3V
D3V
A
20.10.8
+0.13
0.7
D3V-21G5-1@4A-
4.8
t=0.5
2.8
OP
10.30.1
4
15.9 7.2
18.8
2.8
(10)
t=0.5
Three, #187 series tab
Model
8.1
D3V-165-1@5-
D3V-115-1@5-
D3V-115-1@4-
D3V-65-1@4-
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
1.6 mm
0.8 mm
0.5 mm
1.6 mm
0.8 mm
0.6 mm (F gap type) or 0.5 mm (G gap type)
OP
20.70.6 mm
3.1+0.13
0.03
10.3
D3V-6G5-1@3-
1.6 mm
0.8 mm
0.6 mm
t=0.5
Three, quick-connect
terminals (#187)
D3V-21G5M-1@4A-
D3V-015-1@3-
D3V-21G5M-1@4A-
D3V-165M-1@5-
D3V-115M-1@5-
D3V-115M-1@4-
D3V-65M-1@4-
D3V-6G5M-1@3-
D3V-015M-1@3-
Model
5.1
PT
D3V-165M-1@5-
D3V-115M-1@5-
D3V-115M-1@4-
D3V-65M-1@4-
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
1.6 mm
0.8 mm
0.5 mm
1.6 mm
0.8 mm
0.6 mm (F gap type) or 0.5 mm (G gap type)
OP
20.70.6 mm
D3V-6G5M-1@3-
D3V-015M-1@3-
D3V-21G5K-1@4A-
D3V-165K-1@5-
D3V-115K-1@5-
D3V-115K-1@4-
D3V-65K-1@4-
D3V-6G5K-1@3-
D3V-015K-1@3-
+0.13
25.90.8
14.3
t=0.5
8.5
PT
5.1
0.7
2.8 OP
4
18.8
10.30.1
15.9 7.2
+0.13
t=0.5
Three, #187 series tab
Model
D3V-21G5K-1@4A-
D3V-165K-1@5-
D3V-115K-1@5-
2.8
(10)
D3V-115K-1@4-
D3V-65K-1@4-
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
2.6 mm
1.0 mm
0.8 mm
2.6 mm
1.0 mm
0.9 mm (F gap type) or 0.8 mm (G gap type)
OP
20.71.0 mm
3.10.03
D3V-6G5K-1@3-
10.3
D3V-015K-1@3-
107
D3V
D3V
D3V-21G6-1@4A-
D3V-166-1@5-
D3V-116-1@5-
D3V-116-1@4-
D3V-66-1@4-
D3V-6G6-1@3-
D3V-016-1@3-
33.00.8
+0.13
1.6
8.1
5.1
PT
4.8
t=0.5
0.7
2.8
OP
10.30.1
4
15.9 7.2
18.7
+0.13
2.8
(10)
t=0.5
Three, #187 series tab
Model
D3V-21G6-1@4A-
D3V-166-1@5-
D3V-116-1@5-
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
4.0 mm
1.6 mm
0.8 mm
4.0 mm
1.6 mm
1.5 mm (F gap type) or 0.8 mm (G gap type)
OP
20.71.2 mm
10.3
22.20.1
27.8
37.80.8
D3V-116-1@4-
D3V-66-1@4-
OF max.
RF min.
3.10.03
D3V-6G6-1@3-
D3V-016-1@3-
D3V-21G6M-1@4A-
D3V-166M-1@5-
D3V-116M-1@5-
D3V-116M-1@4-
D3V-66M-1@4-
D3V-6G6M-1@3-
D3V-016M-1@3-
t=0.5
Three, quick-connect
terminals (#187)
Model
D3V-21G6M-1@4A-
D3V-166M-1@5-
D3V-116M-1@5-
D3V-116M-1@4-
D3V-66M-1@4-
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
4.0 mm
1.6 mm
0.8 mm
4.0 mm
1.6 mm
1.5 mm (F gap type) or 0.8 mm (G gap type)
OP
20.71.2 mm
D3V-6G6M-1@3-
D3V-016M-1@3-
D3V-21G6K-1@4A-
D3V-166K-1@5-
D3V-116K-1@5-
D3V-116K-1@4-
D3V-66K-1@4-
D3V-6G6K-1@3-
D3V-016K-1@3-
39.80.8
+0.13
1.6
14.3
8.5
PT
5.1
t=0.5
0.7
2.8
10.30.1
15.9 7.2
18.8
OP
+0.13
t=0.5
Three, #187 series tab
Model
D3V-21G6K-1@4A-
D3V-166K-1@5-
D3V-116K-1@5-
D3V-116K-1@4-
D3V-66K-1@4-
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
7.2 mm
2.0 mm
2.0 mm
7.2 mm
2.0 mm
2.7 mm (F gap type) or 2.0 mm (G gap type)
OP
20.72.2 mm
108
2.8
(10)
3.10.03
D3V-6G6K-1@3-
10.3
D3V-016K-1@3-
D3V
D3V
Precautions
Cautions
Handling
Be careful not to drop the switch. Doing so may cause damage to
the switchs internal components because it is designed for a
small load.
Correct Use
Mounting
Insulation Distance
According to EN61058-1, the minimum insulation thickness for
this switch should be 1.1 mm and minimum clearance distance
between the terminal and mounting plate should be 1.9 mm. If the
insulation distance cannot be provided in the product incorporating the switch, either use a switch with insulation barrier or use a
Separator to ensure sufficient insulation distance.
Voltage (V)
Mounting Direction
Operating range
for micro load
models D3V-01
Operating
range for
generalload models
Inoperable
range
Current (mA)
109
RCEW
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend
V-jjj-jjjj-j
1
1.
Ratings
21: 21 A at 250 VAC
16: 16 A at 250 VAC
15: 15 A at 250 VAC
11: 11 A at 250 VAC
10: 10 A at 250 VAC
2.
Contact Gap
None: 1 mm (F gap)
G:
0.5 mm (G gap) (for remodelling)
3.
Actuator
None: Pin plunger
1:
Short hinge lever
2:
Hinge lever
3:
Long hinge lever
4:
Simulated roller lever
5:
Short hinge roller lever
6:
Hinge roller lever
4.
110
Contact Form
1: SPDT (COM bottom terminal, double-throw)
2: SPST-NC (COM bottom terminal, normally closed)
3: SPST-NO (COM bottom terminal, normally open)
4: SPDT (COM side terminal, double-throw)
5: SPST-NC (COM side terminal, normally closed)
6: SPST-NO (COM side terminal, normally open)
5.
Terminals
A: Solder terminals
C2: Quick-connect terminals (#187)
C: Quick-connect terminals (#250)
B: Screw terminals
6.
7.
V
Available Combinations
Thermoplastic case
Terminal
Insulation
barrier
Heat
resistance
Bottom
No
Standard
(80_C)
Heat
i t t
resistant
(150_C)
Yes
Side
Note:
V-21
V-16
V-11
V-15
V-10
Rated current
21 A
16 A
11 A
15 A
10 A
OF
COM
terminal
position
Standard
(80_C)
No
Standard
(80_C)
Thermosetting case
Model
Terminal symbol
3.92 N
{400 gf}
3.92 N
{400 gf}
1.96 N
{200 gf}
0.98 N
{100 gf}
3.92 N
{400 gf}
1.96 N
{200 gf}
1.96 N
{200 gf}
0.98 N
{100 gf}
---
Quick-connect terminals
(#187) (C2)
---
Quick-connect terminals
(#250) (C)
---
---
---
f
(1.96 N)
---
---
---
---
Quick-connect terminals
(#187) (C2)
---
---
---
---
Quick-connect terminals
(#250) (C)
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
Quick-connect terminals
(#187) (C2)
---
---
---
---
---
---
Quick-connect terminals
(#250) (C)
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
Quick-connect terminals
(#187) (C2)
---
---
---
---
Quick-connect terminals
(#250) (C)
---
---
---
---
---
---
---
1. F: Standard
f: Semi-standard
2. Consult your OMRON sales representative for spacific models with standard approvals.
List of Models
General-purpose Models
(Only combinations with standard terminals are shown.)
Thermoplastic Case
Actuator
Pin plunger
COM
tterminal
i l
position
Bottom
Contact
f
form
Right-hand barrier
Left-hand barrier
V-21-1C6
V-21-1CR6
V-21-1CL6
SPST-NC
V-21-2C6
V-21-2CR6
V-21-2CL6
SPST-NO
V-21-3C6
V-21-3CR6
V-21-3CL6
SPDT
V-211-1C6
V-211-1CR6
V-211-1CL6
Hinge lever
V-212-1C6
V-212-1CR6
V-212-1CL6
V-213-1C6
V-213-1CR6
V-213-1CL6
V-214-1C6
V-214-1CR6
V-214-1CL6
Short hinge
roller lever
V-215-1C6
V-215-1CR6
V-215-1CL6
V-216-1C6
V-216-1CR6
V-216-1CL6
Note:
C:
SPDT
Terminals
((see note)
t )
111
V
Actuator
Pin plunger
COM
tterminal
i l
position
Bottom
Contact
f
form
SPDT
SPST-NC
SPST-NO
Short hinge
g lever
SPDT
Hinge
g lever
Short hinge
g
roller lever
Note:
112
A: Solder terminals
C2: Quick-connect terminals (#187)
C: Quick-connect terminals (#250)
Terminals
((see note)
t )
Right-hand barrier
Left-hand barrier
V-16-1A5
V-16-1AR5
V-16-1AL5
C2
V-16-1C25
V-16-1C2R5
V-16-1C2L5
V-16-1C5
---
---
V-16-2A5
V-16-2AR5
V-16-2AL5
C2
V-16-2C25
V-16-2C2R5
V-16-2C2L5
V-16-2C5
---
---
V-16-3A5
V-16-3AR5
V-16-3AL5
C2
V-16-3C25
V-16-3C2R5
V-16-3C2L5
V-16-3C5
---
---
V-161-1A5
V-161-1AR5
V-161-1AL5
C2
V-161-1C25
V-161-1C2R5
V-161-1C2L5
V-161-1C5
---
---
V-162-1A5
V-162-1AR5
V-162-1AL5
C2
V-162-1C25
V-162-1C2R5
V-162-1C2L5
V-162-1C5
---
---
V-163-1A5
V-163-1AR5
V-163-1AL5
C2
V-163-1C25
V-163-1C2R5
V-163-1C2L5
V-163-1C5
---
---
V-164-1A5
V-164-1AR5
V-164-1AL5
C2
V-164-1C25
V-164-1C2R5
V-164-1C2L5
V-164-1C5
---
---
V-165-1A5
V-165-1AR5
V-165-1AL5
C2
V-165-1C25
V-165-1C2R5
V-165-1C2L5
V-165-1C5
---
---
V-166-1A5
V-166-1AR5
V-166-1AL5
C2
V-166-1C25
V-166-1C2R5
V-166-1C2L5
V-166-1C5
---
---
V
Actuator
Pin plunger
COM terminal
position
iti
Contact form
Bottom
SPDT
Short hinge
g lever
Hinge
g lever
Short hinge
g roller lever
Hinge
g roller lever
Note:
Terminals (see
(
note))
V-11-1A4
C2
V-11-1C24
V-11-1C4
V-111-1A4
C2
V-111-1C24
V-111-1C4
V-112-1A4
C2
V-112-1C24
V-112-1C4
V-113-1A4
C2
V-113-1C24
V-113-1C4
V-114-1A4
C2
V-114-1C24
V-114-1C4
V-115-1A4
C2
V-115-1C24
V-115-1C4
V-116-1A4
C2
V-116-1C24
V-116-1C4
A: Solder terminals
C2: Quick-connect terminals (#187)
C: Quick-connect terminals (#250)
113
V
Thermosetting Case
Actuator
Pin plunger
COM
terminal
position
Bottom
Contact
form
SPDT
Bottom
V-10-1A5
V-10-1A4
V-15-1C25
V-10-1C25
V-10-1C24
V-15-1B5
V-10-1B5
V-10-1B4
V-15-2A5
V-10-2A5
V-10-2A4
C2
V-15-2C25
V-10-2C25
V-10-2C24
V-15-2B5
V-10-2B5
V-10-2B4
V-15-3A5
V-10-3A5
V-10-3A4
C2
V-15-3C25
V-10-3C25
V-10-3C24
V-15-3B5
V-10-3B5
V-10-3B4
V-15-4A5
V-10-4A5
V-10-4A4
SPST-NC
V-15-5A5
V-10-5A5
V-10-5A4
SPST-NO
V-15-6A5
V-10-6A5
V-10-6A4
V-151-1A5
V-101-1A5
V-101-1A4
C2
V-151-1C25
V-101-1C25
V-101-1C24
V-151-1B5
V-101-1B5
V-101-1B4
V-152-1A5
V-102-1A5
V-102-1A4
C2
V-152-1C25
V-102-1C25
V-102-1C24
V-152-1B5
V-102-1B5
V-102-1B4
V-153-1A5
V-103-1A5
V-103-1A4
C2
V-153-1C25
V-103-1C25
V-103-1C24
V-153-1B5
V-103-1B5
V-103-1B4
V-154-1A5
V-104-1A5
V-104-1A4
C2
V-154-1C25
V-104-1C25
V-104-1C24
V-154-1B5
V-104-1B5
V-104-1B4
V-155-1A5
V-105-1A5
V-105-1A4
C2
V-155-1C25
V-105-1C25
V-105-1C24
V-155-1B5
V-105-1B5
V-105-1B4
V-156-1A5
V-106-1A5
V-106-1A4
C2
V-156-1C25
V-106-1C25
V-106-1C24
V-156-1B5
V-106-1B5
V-106-1B4
SPDT
SPDT
Short hinge
roller lever
1. A: Solder terminals
C2: Quick-connect terminals (#187)
B: Screw terminals
2. OF values shown in the table are for the pin plunger models.
114
V-15-1A5
Hinge
g lever
Note:
10 A
C2
SPST-NO
Short hinge
g lever
15 A
SPST-NC
Side
Terminals
(see note
1)
V
Heat Resistant Models (Up to 150C)
15 A
10 A
V-15-1A5-T
V-10-1A4-T
V-151-1A5-T
V-101-1A4-T
Hinge lever
V-152-1A5-T
V-102-1A4-T
V-153-1A5-T
V-103-1A4-T
V-154-1A5-T
V-104-1A4-T
V-155-1A5-T
V-105-1A4-T
V-156-1A5-T
V-106-1A4-T
Actuator
COM
terminal
position
Bottom
Pin plunger
Contact form
SPDT
Terminals
Left-hand Barrier
Specifications
Ratings
Item
Model
V-21
V-16
V-15
V-11
V-10
Note:
Resistive load
Rated voltage
250 VAC
21 A
125 VDC
250 VDC
0.6 A
0.3 A
250 VAC
16 A
125 VDC
250 VDC
0.6 A
0.3 A
250 VAC
15 A
125 VDC
250 VDC
0.6 A
0.3 A
250 VAC
11 A
125 VDC
250 VDC
0.6 A
0.3 A
250 VAC
10 A
125 VDC
250 VDC
0.6 A
0.3 A
115
V
Switching Capacity per Load (Reference Values)
Model
Voltage
Non-inductive load
Resistive load
NC
V-21
V-16
V-15
V-11
V-10
Note:
Inductive load
Lamp load
NO
NC
Inductive load
NO
NC
NC
250 VAC
21 A
3A
12 A
4A
8 VDC
21 A
5A
12 A
7A
30 VDC
14 A
5A
12 A
5A
125 VDC
0.6 A
0.1 A
0.6 A
0.1 A
250 VDC
0.3 A
0.05 A
0.3 A
0.05 A
250 VAC
16 A
2A
10 A
3A
8 VDC
16 A
4A
10 A
6A
30 VDC
10 A
4A
10 A
4A
125 VDC
0.6 A
0.1 A
0.6 A
0.1 A
250 VDC
0.3 A
0.05 A
0.3 A
0.05 A
250 VAC
15 A
2A
10 A
3A
8 VDC
15 A
4A
10 A
6A
30 VDC
10 A
4A
10 A
4A
125 VDC
0.6 A
0.1 A
0.6 A
0.1 A
250 VDC
0.3 A
0.05 A
0.3 A
0.05 A
250 VAC
11 A
1.5 A
6A
2A
8 VDC
11 A
3A
6A
3A
30 VDC
6A
3A
6A
3A
125 VDC
0.6 A
0.1 A
0.6 A
0.1 A
250 VDC
0.3 A
0.05 A
0.3 A
0.05 A
250 VAC
10 A
1.5 A
6A
2A
8 VDC
10 A
3A
6A
3A
30 VDC
6A
3A
6A
3A
125 VDC
0.6 A
0.1 A
0.6 A
0.1 A
250 VDC
0.3 A
0.05 A
0.3 A
0.05 A
NO
1. The above current values are the normal current values of models with a contact gap of 1 mm (gap F), which vary with the normal
current values of models with a contact gap of 0.5 mm (gap G).
2. Inductive load has a power factor of 0.4 min. (AC) and a time constant of 7 ms max. (DC).
3. Lamp load has an inrush current of 10 times the steady-state current.
4. Motor load has an inrush current of 6 times the steady-state current.
116
Motor load
NO
V
Characteristics
Operating speed
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
Contact resistance
(initial value)
15 m max.
Dielectric strength
g
(
t 2)
(see
note
1,000 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between terminals of the same polarity
V-21, V-16, and V-11 models: 2,000 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between current-carrying metal parts
and ground, and between each terminal and non-current-carrying metal parts
V-15 and V-10 models: 1,500 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between current-carrying metal parts and
ground, and between each terminal and non-current-carrying metal parts
Vibration resistance
(see note 3)
Shock resistance
(see note 3)
Durability
(see note 4)
Degree of protection
IEC IP40
Class I
175
Ambient operating
temperature
Weight
Note:
Approved Standards
Consult your OMRON sales representative for specific models with standard approvals.
V-21
V-16
V-15
V-11
V-10
21 A, 1/2 HP
16 A, 1/2 HP
15 A, 1/2 HP
11 A, 1/3 HP
10 A, 1/3 HP
125 VDC
0.6 A
0.6 A
0.6 A
0.6 A
0.6 A
250 VDC
0.3 A
0.3 A
0.3 A
0.3 A
0.3 A
125 VAC
250 VAC
V-21
V-16
V-11
20 (4) A
16 (4) A
11 (3) A
V-15
V-10
250 VAC
15 A
10 A
250 VDC
0.3 A
0.3 A
117
V
Contact Specifications
Item
Contact
Inrush current
V-21
V-16
V-15
Specification
Rivet
Material
Silver alloy
Gap
(standard value)
NC
50 A max.
V-11
V-10
Silver
40 A max.
36 A max.
24 A max.
NO
Minimum applicable load
160 mA at 5 VDC
Contact Form
SPDT
SPST-NC
SPST-NO
V-21/-16/-15
100
50
V-10 (1.96 N
{200 gf})
V-15
V-16
V-21
10
0.01
0.2 0.4
Full stroke
OT rated value
OT (mm)
118
V-11/-10
Number of operations (x10 )
200
Electrical Durability
(Pin Plunger Models)
Mechanical Durability
(Pin Plunger Models)
2
1
0.5
V-21
0.3
V-15
V-16
0.1
12
16
20
24
28
5
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.1
V-10
V-11
0.5 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
Dimensions
Terminals
Note:
Terminal
type
COM
bottom
position
Quick-connect
Terminals (#187) (C2)
(5.5)
(5.5)
(4.9)
(6.5)
(6.5)
(7.7)
2.9
3.2
2.9
3.1
(10)
(10)
t = 0.5
Three, solder terminals
COM side
position
Quick-connect
Terminals (#250) (C)
t = 0.8 (12.0)
Three, quick-connect
terminals (#250)
t = 0.5
Three, quick-connect
terminals (#187)
t = 0.8
(5.5)
(5.5)
(4.9)
(6.5)
(6.5)
(7.7)
2.4
2.4
3.6
(7)
---
(10)
Terminal
dimensions
Note:
(12.0)
(10)
6.35
3.2 (see note)
6.35
3.2
4.750.1
4.750.1
8.1
3.95
6.350.1
---
Mounting Holes
Two, 3.1-dia. mounting holes or
M3 screw holes
10.3 0.1
22.2 0.1
119
V
Dimensions and Operating Characteristics
Note:
20.20.25
1.6
PT
+0.13
4.2
0.6
2.8
2.8
2.8
2.8
OP
8.4
10.30.1
Model
15.9 19.1
+0.13
3.1 0.03
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1 2.8 (12.0)
27.8
t=0.8
Three, quick-connect
terminals (#250)
10.3
39.80.8
PT
20.20.25
V-21-1j6
V-16-1j5
OF max.
3.92 N {{400 g
gf}}
1.96 N {{200 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
1.2 mm
OT min.
1.0 mm
MD max.
0.4 mm
OP
14.70.4 mm
+0.13
2.8
4.2
1.6
0.6
2.8
2.8
2.8
OP
8.4
10.30.1
15.9
19.1
21.9
+0.13
3.1 0.03
0.6
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1 2.8
27.8
t=0.8
Three, quick-connect
(12.0)
terminals (#250)
10.3
39.80.8
40.2
Model
V-21-1jL6
V-16-1jL5
4.2
2.8
A
2.8
0.6
2.8
PT
2.8
19.1
21.9
20.20.25
8.4
15.9
10.30.1
OP
+0.13
3.1 0.03
t=0.8
Three, quick-connect
terminals (#250)
0.6
10.3
3.40.15 dia.
(12.0) 2.8 22.20.1
27.8
39.80.8
40.2
120
V-11-1j4
V-11-1j5
OF max.
0.98 N {{100 g
gf}}
1.96 N {{200 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
1.2 mm
OT min.
1.0 mm
MD max.
0.4 mm
OP
14.70.4 mm
V
Short Hinge Lever Models
V-211-1j6
V-161-1j5
V-111-1j4
22.1
A
PT
2.8
t = 0.5
(see
note)
8.1
4.3
3.1 +0.13
0.03 dia. holes
1.6
0.6
2.8
2.8
OP
10.30.1
8.4
15.9
19.1
+0.13
3.1 0.03
3.40.15 dia.
t=0.8
Three, quick-connect
terminals (#250)
t = 0.5
(see note)
8.1
1.6
Note:
4.3
0.6
2.8
2.8
2.8
OP
8.4
10.30.1
15.9
19.1
+0.13
3.1 0.03
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1
(12.0)
2.8
27.8
t=0.8
Three, quick-connect
terminals (#250)
RF min.
PT max.
1.6 mm
OT min.
0.8 mm
MD max.
0.6 mm
OP
15.20.5 mm
Stainless-steel lever
+0.13
V-161-1j5
1.96 N {{200 g
gf}}
Model
35.60.8
PT
V-211-1j6
3.92 N {{400 g
gf}}
10.3
Model
OF max.
1.6
+0.13
4.3
0.6
2.8
OP
8.4 15.9
10.30.1
1.6 mm
OT min.
0.8 mm
MD max.
0.6 mm
OP
15.20.5 mm
Model
V-212-1j6
2.45 N {{250 g
gf}}
1.23 N {{125 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
4.0 mm
OT min.
1.6 mm
MD max.
1.5 mm
OP
15.21.2 mm
Stainless-steel lever
59.40.8
A
PT max.
V-162-1j5
10.3
RF min.
Model
Note:
PT
0.98 N {{100 g
gf}}
OF max.
39.80.8
V-213-1j6
V-163-1j5
V-113-1j4
V-111-1j4
OF max.
2.8
19.1
V-112-1j4
OF max.
0.59 N {{60 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.06 N {6 gf}
PT max.
4.0 mm
OT min.
1.6 mm
MD max.
1.5 mm
OP
15.21.2 mm
Model
V-213-1j6
OF max.
1.27 N {{130 g
gf}}
0.69 N {70
{ gf}
g}
RF min.
0.06 N {6 gf}
PT max.
9.0 mm
OT min.
2.0 mm
MD max.
2.8 mm
OP
15.2 3.2 mm
V-163-1j5
+0.13
3.1 0.03
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1 2.8
27.8
39.80.8
(12.0)
t=0.8
Three, quick-connect
terminals (#250)
+2.6
10.3
Model
Note:
Stainless-steel lever
V-113-1j4
OF max.
0.34 N {{35 g
gf}}
RF min.
---
PT max.
9.0 mm
OT min.
3.2 mm
MD max.
2.8 mm
OP
15.22.6 mm
121
V
Simulated Roller Lever Models
V-214-1j6
V-164-1j5
V-114-1j4
32.60.8
3.5R
PT
OP
t = 0.5
(see note)
8.1
1.6
3.1 +0.13
0.03 dia. holes
4.3
2.8
0.6
2.8
2.8
8.4
15.9
10.30.1
+0.13
22.20.1 2.8
27.8
t=0.8
Three, quick-connect
terminals (#250)
(12.0)
V-214-1j6
2.45 N {{250 g
gf}}
1.23 N {{125 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
4.0 mm
OT min.
1.6 mm
MD max.
1.5 mm
OP
18.71.2 mm
10.3
Model
39.80.8
Note:
Stainless-steel lever
20.1
A t = 0.5
(see 8.1
note 1)
PT
1.6
5.1
0.6
+0.13
2.8
OP
8.4 15.9
10.30.1
V-164-1j5
19.1
3.1 0.03
3.40.15 dia.
Model
OF max.
19.1
V-114-1j4
OF max.
0.59 N {{60 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.06 N {6 gf}
PT max.
4.0 mm
OT min.
1.6 mm
MD max.
1.5 mm
OP
18.71.2 mm
Model
V-215-1j6
OF max.
4.71 N {{480 g
gf}}
2.35 N {{240 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
1.6 mm
OT min.
0.8 mm
MD max.
0.6 mm
OP
20.70.6 mm
V-165-1j5
+0.13
3.1 0.03
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1
27.8
2.8
t=0.8
Three, quick-connect
terminals (#250)
(12.0)
39.80.8
Note:
Model
10.3
1. Stainless-steel lever
2. Oilless polyacetar resin roller
34.00.8
PT
t = 0.5
(see note 1)
8.1
1.6
5.1
0.6
+0.13
OP 2.8
10.30.1
8.4
15.9 19.1
+0.13
3.1 0.03
V-115-1j4
OF max.
1.18 N {{120 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
1.6 mm
OT min.
0.8 mm
MD max.
0.6 mm
OP
20.70.6 mm
Model
V-216-1j6
OF max.
2.45 N {{250 g
gf}}
1.23 N {{125 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
4.0 mm
OT min.
1.6 mm
MD max.
1.5 mm
OP
20.71.2 mm
V-166-1j5
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1
2.8
27.8
39.80.8
122
10.3
t=0.8
(12.0) Three, quick-connect
terminals (#250)
Note:
Model
V-116-1j4
1. Stainless-steel lever
OF max.
0.59 N {{60 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.06 N {6 gf}
PT max.
4.0 mm
OT min.
1.6 mm
MD max.
1.5 mm
OP
20.71.2 mm
V
Thermosetting Case (V-15/-10 Models)
The following illustration and drawing are for solder and quick-connect terminals (#187) (terminals A). V models with a switching current of 15 A
or 10 A incorporate terminals B or C2. These models are different from #187 models in terminal size only.
Refer to Terminals on page 119 for these terminals.
20.20.25
4.2
PT
2.8
2.8
+0.13
2.8
OP
10.30.1
15.9 18.8
Model
V-15-1j5
V-10-1j5
OF max.
1.96 N {{200 g
gf}}
0.98 N {{100 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
1.2 mm
OT min.
1.0 mm
MD max.
0.4 mm
OP
14.70.4 mm
V-10-1j4
+0.13
3.1 0.03
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1
2.8
27.8
10.3
t=0.5
Three, solder
terminals
(10)
37.80.8
22.1
PT
+0.13
3.1 0.03
dia. holes
8.1
2.8
OP
10.30.1
15.9
18.8
+0.13
3.1 0.03
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1
27.8
2.8
V-152-1j5
V-102-1j5
V-102-1j4
10.3
t=0.5
Three, solder terminals
Note:
OF max.
1.96 N {{200 g
gf}}
0.98 N {{100 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
1.6 mm
OT min.
0.8 mm
MD max.
0.6 mm
OP
15.20.5 mm
V-101-1j4
Stainless-steel lever
PT
V-151-1j5
V-101-1j5
(10)
37.80.8
Model
4.3 2.8
+0.13
4.3
A
8.1
2.8
OP
10.30.1
15.9
18.8
3.1 +0.13
0.03
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1
2.8
10.3
t=0.5
Three, solder terminals
2.8
Model
V-152-1j5
V-102-1j5
OF max.
1.23 N {{125 g
gf}}
0.59 N {60
{ gf}
g}
RF min.
0.06 N {6 gf}
PT max.
4.0 mm
OT min.
1.6 mm
MD max.
1.5 mm
OP
15.21.2 mm
V-102-1j4
27.8
(10)
37.80.8
Note:
Stainless-steel lever
A
PT
OP
2.8
Model
t = 0.5 (see note)
59.40.8
8.1
+0.13
V-153-1j5
V-103-1j5
V-101-1j4
OF max.
0.69 N {{70 g
gf}}
0.34 N {{35 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.06 N {6 gf}
---
PT max.
9.0 mm
9.0 mm
OT min.
2.0 mm
3.2 mm
MD max.
2.8 mm
2.8 mm
4.3
2.8
10.30.1
15.9 18.8
+0.13
3.1 0.03
2.8
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1
27.8
(10)
10.3
t=0.5
Three, solder terminals
OP
+2.6
15.2 3.2
mm
15.22.6 mm
37.80.8
Note:
Stainless-steel lever
123
V
Simulated Roller Lever Models
Model
V-154-1j5
V-104-1j5
OF max.
1.23 N {{125 g
gf}}
0.59 N {60
{ gf}
g}
RF min.
0.06 N {6 gf}
PT max.
4.0 mm
OT min.
1.6 mm
MD max.
1.5 mm
OP
18.71.2 mm
3.5R
V-154-1j5
V-104-1j5
V-104-1j4
PT
4.3
+0.13
32.60.8
2.8
2.8
OP
10.30.1
15.9 18.8
3.1 +0.13
0.03
2.8
10.3
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1
27.8
(10)
V-104-1j4
t=0.5
Three, solder terminals
37.80.8
Note:
Stainless-steel lever
PT
OP
2.8
10.30.1
15.9 18.8
3.1 +0.13
0.03
2.8
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1
27.8
10.3
Model
V-155-1j5
V-105-1j5
OF max.
2.35 N {{240 g
gf}}
1.18 N {{120 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
1.6 mm
OT min.
0.8 mm
MD max.
0.6 mm
OP
20.70.6 mm
V-105-1j4
t=0.5
Three, solder terminals
(10)
37.80.8
Note:
1. Stainless-steel lever
2. Oilless polyacetar resin roller
PT
8.1
OP
3.1 +0.13
0.03 dia. holes
2.8
10.30.1
15.9 18.8
+0.13
3.1 0.03
2.8
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1
27.8
(10)
Model
V-156-1j5
V-106-1j5
OF max.
1.23 N {{125 g
gf}}
0.59 N {60
{ gf}
g}
RF min.
0.06 N {6 gf}
PT max.
4.0 mm
OT min.
1.6 mm
MD max.
1.5 mm
OP
20.71.2 mm
5.1
10.3
t=0.5
Three, solder terminals
37.80.8
Note:
1. Stainless-steel lever
2. Oilless polyacetar resin roller
124
V-106-1j4
Precautions
Refer to pages 26 to 31 for common precautions.
Mounting
According to EN61058-1
Insulation Distance
Correct Use
Model
Solder terminals
Screw terminals
V-10
0.75, 1.25
V-15
1.25, 2.0
1.25
125
VX
RCW
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend
VX-jj-jjj
1
1.
Ratings
5: 5 A at 250 VAC
01: 0.1 A at 30 VDC
2.
Actuator
None: Pin plunger
1: Short hinge lever
2: Hinge lever
3: Long hinge lever
4: Simulated roller lever
5: Short hinge roller lever
6: Hinge roller lever
126
3.
Contact Form
1: SPDT
2: SPST-NC
3: SPST-NO
4.
Terminals
A: Solder terminals
C2: Quick-connect terminals (#187)
5.
VX
VX
List of Models
Actuator
OF max.
Terminals
((see note)
t )
Pin plunger
p g
A
C2
Short hinge
g lever
Model
5A
VX-5-1A2
VX-01-1A2
VX-5-1A3
VX-01-1A3
VX-5-1C22
VX-01-1C22
VX-5-1C23
VX-01-1C23
0.49 N {{50 g
gf}}
VX-51-1A3
VX-011-1A3
VX-51-1C23
VX-011-1C23
VX-52-1A3
VX-012-1A3
VX-52-1C23
VX-012-1C23
VX-53-1A3
VX-013-1A3
VX-53-1C23
VX-013-1C23
VX-54-1A3
VX-014-1A3
VX-54-1C23
VX-014-1C23
VX-55-1A3
VX-015-1A3
VX-55-1C23
VX-015-1C23
VX-56-1A3
VX-016-1A3
VX-56-1C23
VX-016-1C23
C2
Hinge
g Lever
0.29 N {{30 g
gf}}
A
C2
A
C2
0.29 N {{30 g
gf}}
A
C2
A
C2
A
C2
Note:
0.1 A
1. Contact your OMRON sales representative for details on SPST-NO and SPST-NC models.
2. Terminals A:
C2:
Solder terminals
Quick-connect terminals (#187)
Specifications
Ratings
Item
Model
Resistive load
Rated voltage
VX-5
250 VAC
5A
VX-01
125 VAC
0.1 A
30 VDC
0.1 A
Note:
Model
Non-inductive load
Resistive load
NC
VX-5
VX-01
Note:
Inductive load
Lamp load
NO
NC
NO
NC
125 VAC
5A
0.5 A
4A
8 VDC
5A
3A
4A
30 VDC
5A
3A
4A
125 VDC
0.4 A
0.1 A
0.4 A
250 VDC
0.3 A
0.05 A
0.2 A
125 VAC
0.1 A
---
---
8 VDC
0.1 A
---
---
30 VDC
0.1 A
NO
1. Inductive load has a power factor of 0.4 min. (AC) and a time constant of 7 ms max. (DC).
2. Lamp load has an inrush current of 10 times the steady-state current.
127
VX
VX
Characteristics
Item
VX-5
VX-01
Operating speed
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
30 m max.
Degree of protection
IEC IP40
Class I
175
Weight
Note:
50 m max.
Approved Standards
Consult your OMRON sales representative for specific models with
standard approvals.
VX-5
VX-01
125 VAC
5A
0.1 A
250 VAC
5A
---
30 VDC
---
0.1 A
VX-5
VX-01
125 VAC
5A
0.1 A
250 VAC
5A
---
Contact Specifications
Item
Contact
Inrush current
VX-5
Rivet
Crossbar
Material
Silver alloy
Gold alloy
0.5 mm
NC
15 A max.
---
NO
---
---
160 mA at 5 VDC
1 mA at 5 VDC
For more information on the minimum applicable load, refer to Using Micro Loads on page 132.
Contact Form
SPDT
128
VX-01
Specification
SPST-NC
SPST-NO
VX
VX
VX-5
Ambient temperature: 202C
Ambient humidity: 655%
Without load
Operating frequency: 600 operations/min
100
50
Full stroke
Rated value
of OT
10
0.2 0.4
0.6
0.8
1.0
1.2
200
200
100
50
10
Full stroke
Rated value
of OT
Overtravel (mm)
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
1.0
1.2
Overtravel (mm)
2
1
0.5
0.3
0.1
0.5 1
5 6
9 10 11 12
VX-01
5
10
5
0.1
0
0.01 0.02
0.05
0.08
0.1
129
VX
VX
Dimensions
Terminals
Note:
(5.5)
(5.5)
(6.5)
(6.5)
2.9
2.9
t=0.5 (10)
t=0.5 (10)
Three, quick-connect terminals (#187)
Terminal dimensions
6.35
3.2 (see note)
6.35
3.2
4.750.1
2.4 dia.
Note:
4.750.1
1.6 dia.
Mounting Holes
Two, 3.1-dia. mounting holes
or M3 screw holes
10.3 0.1
22.2 0.1
PT
+0.13
20.20.25
4.2
2.8
2.8
2.8
OP
10.30.1
15.9 18.8
+0.13
3.1 0.03
1.6
2.8
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1
27.8
10.3
Three, solder terminals
Model
VX-5-1j2
VX-01-1j2
OF max.
0.25 N {{25 g
gf}}
0.49 N {{50 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.03 N {3 gf}
0.05 N {5 gf}
PT max.
1.2 mm
OT min.
1.0 mm
MD max.
0.3 mm
OP
14.70.4 mm
VX-5-1j3
VX-01-1j3
(10)
37.80.8
+0.13
3.1 0.03
22.1
PT
4.3
dia. holes
2.8
8.1
2.8
OP
10.30.1
15.9 18.8
+0.13
3.1 0.03
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1
27.8
37.80.8
130
1.6
2.8
(10)
10.3
Three, solder terminals
Model
VX-51-1j3
OF max.
0.49 N {{50 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
1.6 mm
OT min.
0.8 mm
MD max.
0.5 mm
OP
15.20.5 mm
Note:
VX-011-1j3
VX
VX
Hinge Lever Models
VX-52-1j3
VX-012-1j3
PT
+0.13
3.1 0.03
4.3
dia. holes
8.1
2.8
2.8
OP
10.30.1
15.9 18.8
Model
VX-52-1j3
OF max.
0.29 N {{30 g
gf}}
RF min.
---
PT max.
4.0 mm
OT min.
1.6 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
OP
15.21.2 mm
VX-012-1j3
+0.13
3.1 0.03
1.6
2.8
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1
27.8
10.3
Three, solder terminals
(10)
37.80.8
+0.13
59.40.8
PT
4.3
8.1
2.8
2.8
OP
10.30.1
15.9 18.8
+0.13
3.1 0.03
1.6
2.8
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1
27.8
Model
VX-53-1j3
OF max.
0.20 N {{20 g
gf}}
RF min.
---
PT max.
9.0 mm
OT min.
3.2 mm
MD max.
2.0 mm
OP
15.22.6 mm
VX-013-1j3
10.3
Three, solder terminals
(10)
37.80.8
3.5R
PT
4.3
32.60.8
Model
VX-54-1j3
OF max.
0.29 N {{30 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.02 N {2 gf}
PT max.
4.0 mm
OT min.
1.6 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
OP
18.71.2 mm
VX-014-1j3
+0.13
8.1
2.8
2.8
OP
10.30.1
15.9 18.8
+0.13
3.1 0.03
1.6
2.8
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1
27.8
10.3
Three, solder terminals
(10)
37.80.8
PT
+0.13
8.1
OP
2.8
10.30.1
15.9 18.8
+0.13
3.1 0.03
Model
VX-55-1j3
OF max.
0.59 N {{60 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
1.6 mm
OT min.
0.8 mm
MD max.
0.5 mm
OP
20.70.6 mm
Note:
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1
27.8
1.6
2.8
(10)
10.3
Three, solder terminals
VX-015-1j3
37.80.8
131
VX
VX
Hinge Roller Lever Models
VX-56-1j3
VX-016-1j3
PT
5.1
+0.13
OP
15.9 18.8
Model
VX-56-1j3
OF max.
0.29 N {{30 g
gf}}
RF min.
---
PT max.
4.0 mm
OT min.
1.6 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
OP
20.71.2 mm
VX-016-1j3
+0.13
3.1 0.03
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1
27.8
1.6
2.8
10.3
Three, solder terminals
(10)
37.80.8
Precautions
Refer to pages 26 to 31 for common precautions.
Cautions
Handling
Be careful not to drop the Switch. Doing so may cause damage to
the Switchs internal components because it is designed for a small
load.
Correct Use
Mounting
Use M3 mounting screws with plane washers or spring washers to
securely mount the Switch. Tighten the screws to a torque of 0.39 to
0.59 N S m {4 to 6 kgf S cm}.
Mounting Direction
For a Switch with an actuator, mount the Switch in a direction where
the actuator weight will not be applied to the Switch.
Since the Switch is designed for a small load, its resetting force is
small. Therefore, resetting failure may occur if unnecessary load is
applied to the Switch.
Operating
range for
generalload models
VX-5
Operating range
for micro load
models VX-01
Inoperable
range
Current (mA)
132
D2MV
RC
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend
D2MV-jj-jjj
1
1.
Ratings
1:
1 A at 125 VAC
01:
0.1 A at 30 VDC
2.
Actuator
None: Pin plunger
L11: Short hinge lever
L:
Hinge lever
L111: Long hinge lever
L13: Simulated roller lever
L22: Short hinge roller lever
L2:
Hinge roller lever
3.
Contact Form
1: SPDT
2: SPST-NC
3: SPST-NO
4.
Terminals
C: Solder terminals
5.
List of Models
Actuator
Pin plunger
p g
OF max.
0.1 A
1A
D2MV-01-1C1
D2MV-1-1C1
D2MV-01-1C2
D2MV-1-1C2
D2MV-01-1C3
D2MV-1-1C3
D2MV-01L11-1C3
D2MV-1L11-1C3
Hinge lever
D2MV-01L-1C3
D2MV-1L-1C3
D2MV-01L111-1C3
D2MV-1L111-1C3
D2MV-01L13-1C3
D2MV-1L13-1C3
D2MV-01L22-1C3
D2MV-1L22-1C3
D2MV-01L2-1C3
D2MV-1L2-1C3
Note:
Consult your OMRON sales representative for details on SPST-NO and SPST-NC models.
133
D2MV
D2MV
Specifications
Ratings
Model
Rated voltage
D2MV-1
Item
D2MV-01
Resistive load
125 VAC
1A
0.1 A
30 VDC
1A
0.1 A
Note:
Non-inductive load
Voltage
g
Resistive load
NC
D2MV-1
(1 A type)
D2MV-01
(0 1 A type)
(0.1
Note:
Inductive load
Lamp load
NO
NC
Inductive load
NO
NC
Motor load
NO
NC
125 VAC
1A
0.1 A
---
---
8 VDC
1A
0.1 A
---
---
14 VDC
1A
0.1 A
30 VDC
1A
0.1 A
125 VAC
0.1 A
---
---
---
8 VDC
0.1 A
---
---
---
14 VDC
0.1 A
30 VDC
0.1 A
Characteristics
Operating speed
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
Shock resistance
(see note 3)
Degree of protection
IEC IP40
Degree of protection
against electric shock
Class I
175
Ambient operating
temperature
Ambient operating
humidity
Weight
134
NO
D2MV
Note:
D2MV
135
D2MV
D2MV
Approved Standards
Contact Form
SPDT
D2MV-1
D2MV-01
125 VAC
1A
0.1 A
30 VDC
1A
0.1 A
Contact Specifications
Item
Contact
Inrush
currentt
D2MV-01 models
D2MV-1 models
Specification
Twin crossbar
Needle
Material
Gold alloy
Silver
Gap
(standard
value)
0.5 mm
NC
0.1 A max.
1 A max.
1 mA at 5 VDC
30 mA at 5 VDC
NO
Minimum applicable
load (see note)
Note:
SPST-NC
SPST-NO
D2MV-01(1)-1C1
D2MV-01(1)-1C2(3)
136
Electrical Durability
(Pin Plunger Models)
Number of operations (x10 6)
Mechanical Durability
(Pin Plunger Models)
D2MV-01
D2MV-1
D2MV
D2MV
Dimensions
Note:
Terminals
Mounting Holes
Two, 3.1-dia. mounting holes or
M3 screw holes
6.5
6.3
10.3 0.1
3.9
7.5
6.3
22.2 0.1
3.2
1.2
4.750.1
2.4 dia. 1.3 dia.
20.20.25
D2MV-01-1Cj
D2MV-1-1Cj
+0.07
PT
2.8
4.2
2.8
2.8
OP 10.30.1
11.6
15.9
19.80.8
3 +0.07
0.05
+0.15
Note:
22.20.1
31.8
Model
2.8
t=0.5
Three, solder terminals
10.3
(7.5)
39.30.8
D2MV-01-1C1
D2MV-1-1C1
D2MV-01-1C2
D2MV-1-1C2
D2MV-01-1C3
D2MV-1-1C3
OF max.
0.10 N {{10 g
gf}}
0.25 N {{25 g
gf}}
0.49 N {{50 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
1.2 mm
OT min.
1.3 mm
MD max.
0.25 mm
OP
14.70.4 mm
Model
t = 0.5 (see note)
D2MV-01L11-1C3
D2MV-1L11-1C3
+0.07
+0.15
D2MV-01L11-1C3
D2MV-1L11-1C3
OF max.
RF min.
i
0.04
0
04 N {4 gf}
f}
(reference value)
PT max.
1.7 mm
OT min.
1.0 mm
MD max.
0.4 mm
OP
15.20.5 mm
Stainless-steel lever
137
D2MV
D2MV
Hinge Lever Models
D2MV-01L-1C3
D2MV-1L-1C3
35.60.8
PT
Model
3 +0.07
0.05 dia. holes
4.3
8.1
2.8
2.8
OP
10.30.1
11.6
15.9
+0.07
3 0.05
22.20.1
31.8
t=0.5
Three, solder terminals
2.8
10.3
(7.5)
39.30.8
Note:
+0.07
t=0.5
Three, solder
terminals
3.3 mm
OT min.
2.1 mm
MD max.
0.7 mm
OP
15.21.2 mm
OF max.
RF min.
i
0.01
0
01 N {1 gf}
f}
(reference value)
PT max.
6.0 mm
OT min.
4.0 mm
MD max.
1.4 mm
OP
15.22.6 mm
Model
3.5R
PT
32.60.8
t = 0.5
(see note)
8.1
3 +0.07
0.05 dia. holes
4.3
2.8
2.8
OP
10.30.1
11.6
15.9
19.80.8
+0.07
3 0.05
3.2 +0.15
0.07 dia.
10.3
22.20.1 2.8
31.8
D2MV-01L111-1C3
D2MV-1L111-1C3
Stainless-steel lever
t=0.5
Three, solder terminals
D2MV-01L13-1C3
D2MV-1L13-1C3
OF max.
RF min.
i
0.02
0
02 N {2 gf}
f}
(reference value)
PT max.
3.3 mm
OT min.
1.9 mm
MD max.
0.7 mm
OP
18.71.2 mm
(7.5)
39.30.8
Note:
Stainless-steel lever
+0.15
3.2 0.07 dia.
t=0.5
Three, solder terminals
Note: 1. Stainless-steel lever
2. Oilless polyacetar resin roller
138
PT max.
Model
Note:
D2MV-01L22-1C3
D2MV-1L22-1C3
0.02
0
02 N {2 gf}
f}
(reference value)
+0.15
3.2 0.07 dia.
D2MV-01L13-1C3
D2MV-1L13-1C3
RF min.
i
Stainless-steel lever
OF max.
19.80.8
+0.15
3.2 0.07 dia.
D2MV-01L-1C3
D2MV-1L-1C3
Model
D2MV-01L22-1C3
D2MV-1L22-1C3
OF max.
RF min.
i
0.04
0
04 N {4 gf}
f}
(reference value)
PT max.
1.7 mm
OT min.
1.0 mm
MD max.
0.4 mm
OP
20.70.6 mm
D2MV
D2MV
Hinge Roller Lever Models
D2MV-01L2-1C3
D2MV-1L2-1C3
Model
4.8 dia. 4.8 (see note 2)
A
340.8
PT
t = 0.5
(see note 1) 8.1
5.1
3 +0.07
0.05
dia. holes
2.8
OP
10.30.1
11.6
15.9 19.80.8
+0.07
3 0.05
+0.15
2.8
0.5 t
Three, solder terminals
D2MV-01L2-1C3
D2MV-1L2-1C3
OF max.
RF min.
i
0.02
0
02 N {2 gf}
f}
(reference value)
PT max.
3.3 mm
OT min.
2.1 mm
MD max.
0.7 mm
OP
20.71.2 mm
10.3
(7.5)
39.30.8
Precautions
Cautions
Handling
Be careful not to drop the Switch. Doing so may cause damage to
the Switchs internal components because it is designed for a small
load.
Correct Use
Mounting
Use M3 mounting screws with plane washers or spring washers to
securely mount the Switch. Tighten the screws to a torque of 0.39 to
0.59 N S m {4 to 6 kgf S cm}.
Mounting Direction
For a Switch with an actuator, mount the Switch in a direction where
the actuator weight will not be applied to the Switch.
Since the Switch is designed for a small load, its resetting force is
small. Therefore, resetting failure may occur if unnecessary load is
applied to the Switch.
Operating
range for
D2MV-1
Operating
range for
D2MV-01
Inoperable
range
Current (mA)
139
RCW
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend
Kjj
1
1.
Barrier
1: With right-hand barrier
2: With left-hand barrier
3: Without barrier
2.
Actuator
None: Pin plunger
L:
Hinge lever
L13: Simulated roller lever
L2:
Hinge roller lever
List of Models
Actuator
OF
max.
Without barrier
Pin plunger
0.25 N
{25 gf}
K1
K2
K3
Hinge lever
0.15 N
{15 gf}
K1L
K2L
K3L
K1L13
K2L13
K3L13
K1L2
K2L2
K3L2
Specifications
Ratings
Rated voltage
125 VAC
250 VAC
Note:
140
Resistive load
5A
3A
K
Switching Capacity per Load (Reference Values)
Voltage
Non-inductive load
Resistive load
NC
Inductive load
Lamp load
NO
NC
Inductive load
NO
NC
Motor load
NO
NC
NO
125 VAC
5A
1.5 A
0.7 A
3A
1.5 A
0.7 A
250 VAC
3A
1A
0.5 A
2A
1A
0.5 A
8 VDC
5A
3A
3A
4A
3A
14 VDC
5A
3A
3A
4A
3A
30 VDC
5A
3A
3A
4A
3A
125 VDC
0.4 A
0.05 A
0.05 A
0.4 A
0.05 A
250 VDC
0.2 A
0.05 A
0.03 A
0.2 A
0.03 A
Note:
Characteristics
Operating speed
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
30 m max.
1,000 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between terminals of the same polarities
2,000 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between current-carrying metal part and ground, and between
each terminal and non-current-carrying metal part
Degree of protection
IEC IP40
Class I
175
Weight
Note:
141
K
Approved Standards
Consult your OMRON sales representative for specific models with
standard approvals.
Contact Specifications
Contact
125 VAC
5A
250 VAC
3A
Inrush current
250 VAC
3A
Rivet
Material
Silver
Gap
(standard value)
0.5 mm
NC
10 A max.
NO
10 A max.
125 VAC
Specification
Note:
160 mA at 5 VDC
Contact Form
SPDT
1,000
100
Without load
Operating frequency: 300 operations/min
50
K1
30
20
10
7
5
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
1.0
Operating frequency:
30 operations/min
At full OT
125 VAC cos = 1
700
70
Electrical Durability
500
300
100
70
50
1.2
Overtravel (mm)
K1
Dimensions
Note:
Terminals
Mounting Holes
Two, 3.1-dia. mounting holes or
M3 screw holes
3.7
5.1
4.750.1
5.1
2.4 dia.
142
10.3 0.1
1.3 dia.
22.2 0.1
K
Dimensions and Operating Characteristics
Note:
Model
2R (see note)
20.20.25
+0.13
2.8
A
2.8
OP
10.30.15
4.2
3.7
5.1
0.25 N {{25 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.05 N {5 gf}
PT max.
1.6 mm
OT min.
0.8 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
OP
14.40.7 mm
2.8
15.9
5.1
+0.13
3.1 0.03
3.40.15 dia.
K1
OF max.
10.3
t=0.5
Three, quick-connect
terminals (#187)
2.8
22.20.15
13.40.8
170.8
43.30.8
Model
20.20.25
2.8
+0.13
4.2
2.8
PT
K2
OF max.
0.25 N {{25 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.05 N {5 gf}
PT max.
1.6 mm
OT min.
0.8 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
OP
14.40.7 mm
2.8
10.3 OP
15.9
10.3
13.350.8
(t=0.5)
3.1 0.03
2.8
170.8
43.30.8
Three,
quick-connect
terminals
(#187)
+0.13
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.15
Model
+0.13
3.1 0.03
35.60.8
8.1
dia. holes
KjL
OF max.
0.15 N {{15 g
gf}}
RF min.
2.8
PT max.
4.7 mm
10.30.15
OT min.
1.3 mm
MD max.
2.4 mm
OP
14.92 mm
4.3
2.8
OP
15.9
+0.13
3.1 0.03
3.40.15 dia.
10.3
2.8
22.20.15
13.40.8
170.8
43.30.8
t=0.5
Three,
quick-connect
terminals (#187)
143
K
Simulated Roller Lever Models
KjL13
PT
Model
3.1 +0.13
0.03 dia. holes
32.60.8
3.5R
4.3
2.8
8.1
2.8
OP
10.30.15
15.9
3.1 +0.13
0.03
3.40.15 dia.
KjL13
OF max.
0.15 N {{15 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
4.7 mm
OT min.
1.3 mm
MD max.
2.4 mm
OP
18.42 mm
10.3
2.8
22.20.15
13.40.8
170.8
t=0.5
Three,
quick-connect
terminals (#187)
43.30.8
Model
340.8
+0.13
2.8
OP
10.30.15
15.9
3.1 +0.13
0.03
3.40.15 dia.
10.3
KjL2
OF max.
0.15 N {{15 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
4.7 mm
OT min.
1.3 mm
MD max.
2.4 mm
OP
20.42 mm
Note:
2.8
22.20.15
13.40.8
170.8
43.30.8
t=0.5
Three,
quick-connect
terminals (#187)
Precautions
Refer to pages 26 to 31 for common precautions.
Correct Use
Mounting Direction
144
D2RV
RC
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend
D2RV-jj
1
1.
Actuator
None: Pin plunger
L11: Short hinge lever
L:
Hinge lever
L13: Simulated roller lever
L22: Short hinge roller lever
L2:
Hinge roller lever
2.
List of Models
Actuator
Pin plunger
p g
Short hinge
g lever
Hinge
g lever
Short hinge
g roller lever
OF max.
D2RV
D2RV-E
D2RV
D2RV-G
D2RV-L11E
D2RV-L11
D2RV-L11G
D2RV-LE
D2RV-L
D2RV-LG
D2RV-L13E
D2RV-L13
D2RV-L13G
D2RV-L22E
D2RV-L22
D2RV-L22G
D2RV-L2
D2RV-L2G
145
D2RV
D2RV
Specifications
Ratings
Switching voltage
Switching current
Contact capacity
10 W max.
Note:
Characteristics
Operating speed
Operating frequency
150 m max.
Dielectric strength
Degree of protection
IEC IP40
Class I
175
Weight
Note:
Approved Standards
Consult your OMRON sales representative for specific models with
standard approvals.
Contact Form
SPST-NO
Reed switch
146
D2RV
0.1 A
D2RV
D2RV
Dimensions
Note:
Terminals
Mounting Holes
Two, 3.1-dia. mounting holes or
M3 screw holes
10.3 0.1
2.4 dia.
1.3 dia.
22.2 0.1
D2RV-j
PT
2.8
OP
20.20.25
+0.13
1.5R
5.4
10.30.1
15.9
2.8
+0.13
3.1 0.03
3.40.15 dia.
10.3
22.20.1
1
2.8
27.8
Model
(10)
D2RV-E
OF max.
PT max.
1.6
6 mm
OT min.
0.6 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
OP
14.40.6 mm
D2RV
D2RV-G
D2RV-L11j
PT
22.1
+0.13
4.3
3.1
8.1
OP
10.30.1
2.8
15.9
5.4
3.1 +0.13
0.03
10.3
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1 2.8
27.8
1
(10)
Model
D2RV-L11E
OF max.
PT max.
1.8 mm
OT min.
0.4 mm
MD max.
1 mm
OP
150.6 mm
D2RV-L11
D2RV-L11G
1.6 mm
1 mm
147
D2RV
D2RV
Hinge Lever Models
D2RV-Lj
35.60.8
8.1
+0.13
4.3 3.1
OP
10.30.1
5.4
15.9
2.8
+0.13
3.1 0.03
10.3
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1
2.8 1
27.8
(10)
Model
D2RV-LE
OF max.
PT max.
4 mm
OT min.
1 mm
MD max.
1.6 mm
OP
14.41.2 mm
D2RV-L
0.25 N {25 gf}
D2RV-LG
0.49 N {50 gf}
D2RV-L13j
32.60.8
PT
3.5R
4.3 3.1
8.1
+0.13
OP
10.30.1
5.4 15.9
+0.13
3.1 0.03
10.3
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1
2.8
27.8
(10)
Model
D2RV-L13E
OF max.
PT max.
4 mm
OT min.
1 mm
MD max.
1.6 mm
OP
18.11.2 mm
148
D2RV-L13
0.25 N {25 gf}
D2RV-L13G
0.49 N {50 gf}
D2RV
D2RV
Short Hinge Roller Lever Models
Unlubricated
polyacetal
resin roller
PT
D2RV-L22j
20.1
A
5.15
t = 0.5
(stainless lever)
+0.13
3.1 0.03 dia. hole
8.1
OP
10.30.1
2.8
5.4
15.9
3.1 +0.13
0.03
3.40.15 dia.
10.3
22.20.1
2.8
27.8
Model
D2RV-L22E
OF max.
PT max.
1.8 mm
OT min.
0.4 mm
MD max.
1 mm
OP
20.40.6 mm
(10)
D2RV-L22
D2RV-L22G
Unlubricated
polyacetal
t = 0.5 (stainless lever)
resin roller
4.8 dia. 4.8
PT
A
34.00.8
+0.13
8.1
3.1 0.03 dia. hole
5.15
OP
10.30.1
5.4 15.9
2.8
+0.13
3.1 0.03
10.3
3.40.15 dia.
22.20.1
2.8
27.8
(10)
Model
D2RV-L2
OF max.
PT max.
4 mm
OT min.
1 mm
MD max.
1.6 mm
OP
20.71.2 mm
D2RV-L2G
0.49 N {50 gf}
149
D2RV
D2RV
Precautions
Refer to pages 26 to 31 for common precautions.
Designing
To obtain R, start on the load voltage E axis on the graph. Run up to
the point on the axis indicating the given load voltage and then
across to the R axis. For example, if E is 24 VDC, R is about 115 .
Next, to determine C, L must be known. Suppose L is 0.5 H, I is
0.5 A, and E is 24 VDC. Then C can be obtained by following these
steps:
1. Plot the value of E, 24 V, on the E axis.
2. Plot the point where the EC curve corresponding to E, or the
EC = 24 V curve intersects with the value of I, 0.5 A.
3. Join points E and the intersection of EC with I with a straight
line. This line is the top dotted line in the graph.
4. Find the point the E-EC line intersects with the value of L,
0.5 H. This intersection indicates the value of 0.14 F. This is
the capacitance the constant C must satisfy.
Contact Protection
Depending on the load, an appropriate protective circuit must be
connected across or to the Switch so as to ensure the rated durability of the Switch.
Inductive Load
If the load is inductive, connect a spark killer across the Switch to
diminish the spark discharge that may occur when the Switch contacts release.
Miniature Reed Switch
Supply
voltage
Load
C
Inductive load
Resistive
load
0.25 (H) 0.5 (H) 1 (H) 2 (H) 5 (H)
0.5 1
2
4
10
0.05
100
2,000
EC = 100 V
EC = 48 V
48
EC = 36 V
36
EC = 24 V
460
24
115
12
29
0.14
260
EC = 12 V
1.1
0.005
0.05
0.1
0.2
0.4
1
EC = 5 V
0.0005
50 PF
0.0005
0.001
0.002
100 PF
50 PF
5 PF
0.004
0.01
400 PF
200 PF
0.001
0.1
Another Example
For the sake of practice, obtain the value of C where I = 0.4 A, E =
12 VDC, and L = 5 H. The E-EC line in this case is the bottom dotted
line on the graph. It indicates the value of 1.1 F. So, use a capacitor
having a capacitance of 1.1 F.
150
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5
Load current I (A)
D2RV
D2RV
Example of Other Protective Circuits
For AC circuit load
R
Z
L load
L load
L load
Correct Use
Connector
Refer to terminal connections on page 282.
Handling
Do not drop the Reed Switch on a hard object such as floor because
the internal mechanism of the Switch may be damaged and, as a
result, the characteristics of the Switch may be degraded.
Install the Switch so that the actuator can move at least 70% of the
rated travel and returns to the free position when the Switch is released.
Take adequate preventive measures against inrush current and
surge voltage. Under the load conditions where severe transient
phenomena take place, metal deposition may occur between the
mating contacts of the Switch, degrading the electrical and mechanical characteristics and contact reliability of the Switch.
Lead Wiring
To solder the lead to the terminal, apply a soldering iron rated at
30 W max. quickly (within 5 seconds) with the actuator at the free
position.
Applying a soldering iron for too long a time or using one that is rated
at more than 30 W may degrade the Switch characteristics.
Mounting
Use two M3 mounting screws with plain or spring washers to mount
the Switch. Tighten the screws to a torque of 0.39 N S m {4 to
6 kgf S cm}.
When installing two or more Switches side by side, provide at least
8 mm between the adjacent Switches. If this is impossible, attach
the optional magnetic baffle D2RV-j-I to the Switches.
151
D3V/V/VX/D2MV/K/D2RV
D3V/V/VX/D2MV/K/D2RV
Thickness
Separator for Vj
Model
0.18
0.25
Separator
Leaf Spring
Two, M3
152
16
OF max.
2.26 N {{230 g
gf}}
RF min.
OT min.
0.8 mm
MD max.
0.4 mm
FP max.
17 mm
OP
14.90.5 mm
D3V/V/VX/D2MV/K/D2RV
D3V/V/VX/D2MV/K/D2RV
Simulated Leaf Spring
Two, M3
OF max.
2.26 N {{230 g
gf}}
RF min.
OT min.
0.8 mm
MD max.
0.4 mm
FP max.
22.9 mm
OP
20.50.8 mm
16
Two, M3
Note:
OF max.
2.26 N {{230 g
gf}}
RF min.
OT min.
0.8 mm
MD max.
0.4 mm
FP max.
22.6 mm
OP
20.50.5 mm
16
VAV
Two, M3
OF max.
0.34 N {{35 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.04 N {4 gf}
PT max.
7.6 mm
min
OT min.
3 6 mm
3.6
MD max.
4.7 mm
OP
Approx. 10.6
mm
16
Two, M3
16
OF max.
0.03 N {{2.8 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
16 mm
min
OT min.
2 mm
MD max.
5 mm
OP
Approx. 16.7
mm
153
D3V/V/VX/D2MV/K/D2RV
D3V/V/VX/D2MV/K/D2RV
Hinge Roller Lever
VAV2
19R
Two, M3
16
0.74 N {{75 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.09 N {9 gf}
PT max.
4.8 mm
min
OT min.
1 5 mm
1.5
MD max.
1.2 mm
OP
18.61.6 mm
VAM
62R
Two, M3
20
OF max.
1.96 N {{200 g
gf}}
RF min.
OT min.
7 mm
(reference value)
MD max.
5 mm
FP max.
45 mm
OP
209 mm
t=1
(stainlesssteel lever)
VAM21
26R
Two, M3
20
OF max.
3.53 N {{360 g
gf}}
RF min.
OT min.
5 mm
(reference value)
MD max.
4 mm
FP max.
30 mm
OP
204 mm
VAM-1
t=1
7R (stainlesssteel lever)
46.5R
Two, M3
154
OF max.
20
OF max.
2.94 N {{300 g
gf}}
RF min.
OT min.
5 mm
(reference value)
MD max.
6 mm
FP max.
47 mm
OP
305 mm
D3V/V/VX/D2MV/K/D2RV
D3V/V/VX/D2MV/K/D2RV
Reverse Hinge Roller Lever
VAM22
25R
OF max.
3.53 N {{360 g
gf}}
RF min.
OT min.
3 mm
(reference value)
MD max.
4 mm
Two, M3
20
FP max.
38 mm
OP
31.33 mm
VAM2
9.5 dia.
51R
OF max.
2.45 N {{250 g
gf}}
RF min.
OT min.
7 mm
(reference value)
MD max.
6 mm
Two, M3
FP max.
48 mm
OP
316 mm
20
155
D2MC
RC
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend
D2MC-jjj
1
3.
1.
Ratings
5: 5 A at 250 VAC
0.1: 0.5 A at 30 VDC
2.
Direction of Actuator
None: Clockwise
L:
Counterclockwise
List of Models
Direction of actuation
Clockwise
Counterclockwise
Note:
156
OTq max.
5A
0.5 A
D2MC-5E
D2MC-01E
D2MC-5F
D2MC-01F
D2MC-5H
D2MC-01H
D2MC-5EL
D2MC-01EL
D2MC-5FL
D2MC-01FL
D2MC-5HL
D2MC-01HL
All the models listed here are supplied without actuator lever. If an actuator lever is required, please order separately by indicating the
model number of the actuator lever (CAA1M). Refer to page 160.
D2MC
D2MC
Specifications
Ratings
Item
Model
D2MC-5
D2MC-01
Note:
Resistive load
Rated voltage
125 VAC
5A
250 VAC
5A
125 VAC
0.5 A
30 VDC
0.5 A
Characteristics
Item
D2MC-5
D2MC-01
Operating speed
1 to 360/sec
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
Contact resistance
(initial value)
20 m max.
Dielectric strength
Vibration resistance
(see note 2)
Shock resistance
(see note 2)
Degree of protection
IEC IP40
Degree of protection
against electric shock
Class I
175
Ambient operating
temperature
Ambient operating
humidity
Weight
Approx. 10 g
Note:
100 m max.
157
D2MC
D2MC
Approved Standards
Contact Form
SPDT
D2MC-01
D2MC-5
125 VAC
0.5 A
5A
250 VAC
---
5A
30 VDC
0.5 A
---
Contact Specifications
Item
Contact
Inrush
currentt
D2MC-5
Rivet
Crossbar
Material
Silver alloy
Gold alloy
0.5 mm
NC
15 A max.
0.5 A max.
NO
7 A max.
0.5 A max.
160 mA at
5 VDC
1 mA at
5 VDC
D2MC-01
Specification
Overtravel
158
Electrical Durability
Mechanical Durability
D2MC
D2MC
Dimensions
Mounting Holes
Note:
8.7 0.1
23.8 0.1
Clockwise
Model
D2MC-5E
D2MC-01E
D2MC-5F
D2MC-01F
OTq
max.
0.5 mN S m
gf S cm}}
{{5.1 g
0.75 mN S m
gf S cm}}
{{7.6 g
1.0 mN S m
{{10.2 gf
g S cm}}
RTq min.
0.06 mN S m
{0.6 gf S cm}
0.09 mN S m
{0.9 gf S cm}
0.13 mN S m
{1.3 gf S cm}
PT max.
21
21
21
OT min.
17
17
17
MD min.
RT min.
TT min.
38
FP
D2MC-jj
3.10.05 dia.
Operating
direction
40.1 dia.
t=0.8
Quick-connect terminals (#205)
Counterclockwise
Model
D2MC-jjL
3.10.05 dia.
Operating
direction
D2MC-5EL
D2MC-01EL
D2MC-5FL
D2MC-01FL
D2MC-5H
D2MC-01H
D2MC-5HL
D2MC-01HL
OTq
max.
0.5 mN S m
{{5.1 g
gf S cm}}
0.75 mN S m
{{7.6 g
gf S cm}}
1.0 mN S m
{{10.2 gf
g S cm}}
RTq min.
0.06 mN S m
{0.6 gf S cm}
0.09 mN S m
{0.9 gf S cm}
0.13 mN S m
{1.3 gf S cm}
PT max.
21
21
21
OT min.
17
17
17
MD min.
RT min.
TT min.
38
FP
40.1 dia.
t=0.8
Quick-connect terminals (#205)
159
D2MC
D2MC
Rotary shaft
Center of
rotating axis
Precautions
Refer to pages 26 to 31 for common precautions.
Correct Use
Mounting/Soldering
Use M3 mounting screws with plane washers or spring washers to
mount the switch. Tighten the screws to a torque of 0.20 to
0.29 N S m {2 to 3 kgf S cm}.
Do not change the operating position by modifying the actuator.
160
D3M
RCE
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend
D3M-01jjj
1
1.
L:
Note:
2.
Actuator
None: Pin plunger
1:
Hinge lever
2:
Hinge roller lever
3:
Simulated roller lever
3.
Contact Form
None: SPST-NC (with red pushbutton)
-3:
SPST-NO (with black pushbutton)
For details about models with a low operating force, contact your OMRON sales representative.
161
D3M
D3M
List of Models
Actuator
Pin plunger
p g
---
Hinge
g lever
K
L
Hinge
g roller lever
K
L
K
L
Contact type
Model
SPST-NC
D3M-01
SPST-NO
D3M-01-3
SPST-NC
D3M-01K1
SPST-NO
D3M-01K1-3
SPST-NC
D3M-01L1
SPST-NO
D3M-01L1-3
SPST-NC
D3M-01K2
SPST-NO
D3M-01K2-3
SPST-NC
D3M-01L2
SPST-NO
D3M-01L2-3
SPST-NC
D3M-01K3
SPST-NO
D3M-01K3-3
SPST-NC
D3M-01L3
SPST-NO
D3M-01L3-3
Specifications
Ratings
Rated voltage
Resistive load
30 VDC
0.1 A
Note: The ratings values apply under the following test conditions:
Ambient temperature: 202C
Ambient humidity: 655%
Operating frequency: 30 operations/min
Characteristics
Operating speed
Operating
p
g frequency
q
y
Insulation resistance
1,000 VAC at 50/60 Hz for 1 min between terminals of the same polarity
1,500 VAC at 50/60 Hz for 1 min between charged metal part and ground
1,500 VAC at 50/60 Hz for 1 min between non-charged metal part and each terminal
Durability
y ((see note 5))
Degree of protection
IEC IP40
Class I
175
Weight
Note:
162
D3M
D3M
Approved Standards
Consult your OMRON sales representative for specific models with
standard approvals.
D3M
0.1 A
D3M
0.1 A
Contact Specifications
Contact
Crossbar
Material
Gold alloy
0.5 mm
Inrush current
1 A max.
1 mA at 5 VDC
Note:
Contact Form
SPST-NC
SPST-NO
163
D3M
D3M
Dimensions
Mounting Holes
Note:
Model
(see note 2)
A
(see note 2)
OP
(see note 1)
2.35 +0.1
dia.
0.05
FP
D3M-01
D3M-01-3
OF max.
1.50 N {{153 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
0.6 mm
OT min.
0.4 mm
MD max.
0.1 mm
OP
8.40.3 mm
2.5 dia.
Note:
Model
(see note 2)
A
(see note 2)
D3M-01K1
D3M-01K1-3
OF max.
0.50 N {{51 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.06 N {6 gf}
OT min.
1.2 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
FP max.
14.0 mm
OP
10.00.8 mm
FP
OP
(see note 1)
2.35 +0.1
dia.
0.05
2.5 dia.
Note:
164
D3M
D3M
Hinge Lever Models (L)
D3M-01L1
D3M-01L1-3
Model
(see note 2)
A
(see note 2)
FP
OP
(see note 1)
2.35 +0.1
dia.
0.05
D3M-01L1
D3M-01L1-3
OF max.
1.00 N {{102 g
gf}}
RF min.
OT min.
0.7 mm
MD max.
0.6 mm
FP max.
11.5 mm
OP
9.20.6 mm
2.5 dia.
Note:
Model
(see note 2)
(see note 2)
D3M-01K2
D3M-01K2-3
OF max.
0.50 N {{51 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.06 N {6 gf}
OT min.
1.2 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
FP max.
19.7 mm
OP
15.70.8 mm
FP
OP
2.5 dia.
(see note 1)
2.35 +0.1
dia.
0.05
Note:
Model
(see note 2)
(see note 2)
D3M-01L2
D3M-01L2-3
OF max.
1.00 N {{102 g
gf}}
RF min.
OT min.
0.7 mm
MD max.
0.6 mm
FP max.
17.2 mm
OP
14.90.6 mm
FP
OP
(see note 1)
2.35 +0.1
dia.
0.05
2.5 dia.
Note:
165
D3M
D3M
Simulated Roller Lever Models (K)
D3M-01K3
D3M-01K3-3
Model
(see note 2)
A
(see note 2)
FP
OP
(see note 1)
2.35 +0.1
dia.
0.05
2.5 dia.
Note:
D3M-01K3
D3M-01K3-3
OF max.
0.50 N {{51 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.06 N {6 gf}
OT min.
1.2 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
FP max.
16.2 mm
OP
12.20.8 mm
Model
(see note 1)
2.35 +0.1
dia.
0.05
D3M-01L3
D3M-01L3-3
OF max.
1.00 N {{102 g
gf}}
RF min.
OT min.
0.7 mm
MD max.
0.6 mm
FP max.
13.6 mm
OP
11.30.6 mm
FP
2.5 dia.
Note:
166
D3M
D3M
Precautions
Refer to pages 26 to 31 for common precautions.
Correct Use
Mounting
Use M2.3 mounting screws with plane washers or spring washers to
securely mount the Switch. Tighten the screws to a torque of 0.23 to
0.26 N S m {2.3 to 2.7 kgf S cm}.
Voltage (V)
Connectors
The terminals connect to JSTs XA Connector.
The XA Connector consists of the following components.
Contact: SXA-001T-P0.6
Housing: XAP-02V-1
OMRON does not sell the XA Connector. Contact the following.
J.S.T. Manufacturing Co., Ltd. (Japan)
Tel: (81)6-6968-6855
Fax: (81)6-6964-2085
Operating
range
Inoperable
range
Current (mA)
167
SS
RCEW
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend
SS-jjjjj
1
1.
Ratings
10: 10.1 A at 125 VAC
5: 5 A at 125 VAC
01: 0.1 A at 30 VDC
4.
Contact Form
None: SPDT
-2:
SPST-NC
-3:
SPST-NO
2.
Actuator
None: Pin plunger
GL:
Hinge lever
GL13: Simulated roller lever
GL2: Hinge roller lever
5.
Terminals
None: Solder terminals
T:
Quick-connect terminals (#110)
D:
PCB terminals (see note 2)
3.
Note:
Contact Form
SPDT
168
SPST-NC
SPST-NO
SS
SS
List of Models
Rating
0.1 A
Actuator
Solder terminals
Quick-connect
terminals (#110)
SS-01-E
SS-01-ET
SS-01-ED
SS-01-F
SS-01-FT
SS-01-FD
SS-01
SS-01T
SS-01D
0.08 N {8 gf}
SS-01GL-E
SS-01GL-ET
SS-01GL-ED
SS-01GL-F
SS-01GL-FT
SS-01GL-FD
SS-01GL
SS-01GLT
SS-01GLD
0.08 N {8 gf}
SS-01GL13-E
SS-01GL13-ET
SS-01GL13-ED
SS-01GL13-F
SS-01GL13-FT
SS-01GL13-FD
SS-01GL13
SS-01GL13T
SS-01GL13D
0.08 N {8 gf}
SS-01GL2-E
SS-01GL2-ET
SS-01GL2-ED
SS-01GL2-F
SS-01GL2-FT
SS-01GL2-FD
SS-01GL2
SS-01GL2T
SS-01GL2D
SS-5-F
SS-5-FT
SS-5-FD
SS-5
SS-5T
SS-5D
SS-5GL-F
SS-5GL-FT
SS-5GL-FD
SS-5GL
SS-5GLT
SS-5GLD
SS-5GL13-F
SS-5GL13-FT
SS-5GL13-FD
SS-5GL13
SS-5GL13T
SS-5GL13D
SS-5GL2-F
SS-5GL2-FT
SS-5GL2-FD
SS-5GL2
SS-5GL2T
SS-5GL2D
Pin plunger
SS-10
SS-10T
SS-10D
Hinge lever
SS-10GL
SS-10GLT
SS-10GLD
SS-10GL13
SS-10GL13T
SS-10GL13D
SS-10GL2
SS-10GL2T
SS-10GL2D
Pin plunger
p g
Hinge
g lever
Hinge
g roller lever
5A
Pin plunger
p g
Hinge
g lever
Simulated roller lever
10.1 A
Note:
OF max.
PCB terminals
Consult your OMRON sales representative for details on SPST-NO and SPST-NC models.
169
SS
SS
Specifications
Ratings
Item
Model
Resistive load
Rated voltage
SS-10
250 VAC
10.1 A
SS-5
125 VAC
250 VAC
5A
3A
SS-01
125 VAC
0.1 A
30 VDC
0.1 A
Note:
SS-10, SS-5
SS-01
Non-inductive load
Resistive load
NC
NO
Inductive load
Lamp load
NC
NO
Inductive load
NC
NO
Non-inductive load
Motor load
NC
NO
Resistive load
NC
NO
125 VAC
5 (10.1) A
(see
note 1))
(
1.5 A
0.7 A
3A
2.5 A
1.3 A
0.1 A
250 VAC
3 (10.1) A
(see note 1)
1A
0.5 A
2A
1.5 A
0.8 A
---
8 VDC
5 (10.1) A
(see note 1)
2A
5A
4A
3A
0.1 A
14 VDC
5 (10.1) A
(see note 1)
2A
4A
4A
3A
0.1 A
30 VDC
4A
2A
3A
3A
3A
0.1 A
125 VDC
0.4 A
0.05 A
0.4 A
0.4 A
0.05 A
---
250 VDC
0.2 A
0.03 A
0.2 A
0.2 A
0.03 A
---
Note:
170
SS
SS
Characteristics
Operating speed
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
Contact resistance
(initial value)
50 m max.
100 m max.
150 m max.
Dielectric strength
(see note 2)
1,000 VAC (600 VAC for SS-01 models), 50/60 Hz for 1 min between terminals of the same polarities
1,500 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between current-carrying metal part and ground, and between each
terminal and non-current-carrying metal part
Vibration resistance
(see note 3)
Shock resistance
(see note 4)
Mechanical: 30,000,000 operations min. (60 operations/min) (Refer to the following Engineering Data.)
10,000,000 operations min. (60 operations/min) for SS-10 models
Electrical: 200,000 operations min. (30 operations/min) (Refer to the following Engineering Data.)
50,000 operations min. (30 operations/min) for SS-10 models
Degree of protection
IEC IP40
Degree of protection
against electrical shock
Class 1
175
Ambient operating
temperature
Ambient operating
humidity
Weight
Note:
Approved Standards
Contact Specifications
SS-10
SS-5
SS-01
125 VAC
250 VAC
--10.1 A
5A
3A
0.1 A
---
30 VDC
---
---
0.1 A
SS-10
10 A
Item
Contact
SS-5
5A
Inrush
currentt
Rivet
Material
Silver
alloy
Gap
(standard
value)
0.5 mm
NC
20 A max.
NO
15 A max.
Minimum applicable
load (see note)
Note:
SS-10
Specification
SS-5
SS-01
Crossbar
Silver
Gold alloy
0.25 mm
1 A max.
10 A max.
160 mA at 5 VDC
1 A max.
1 mA
at 5 VDC
SS-10
10 A
SS-5
5A
171
SS
SS
SS-5 Models
40,000
5,000
Ambient temperature: 202C
Ambient humidity: 655%
Without load
Operating frequency: 60 operations/min
30,000
20,000
10,000
5,000
3,000
1,000
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5
0.6
0.7
125 VAC
500
300
250 VAC
100
50
30
10
0.1
Overtravel (mm)
Dimensions
Note:
Terminals
Terminal plate thickness is 0.5 mm for all models.
Solder Terminals
2.9
PCB Terminals
2.9
2.9
6.4
7.1
3.2
1.6
8.8
COM
terminal
(C)
9.50.1
19.8
NO terminal
NC terminal
(1.6)
+0.15
8.8 0.05
16.10.1
Mounting Holes
Two, 2.4-dia. mounting holes or
M2.3 screw holes
9.5 0.1
172
1.6
8.8
2.8
1.6
7.3
8.8
7.3
9.50.1
19.8
3.2
NO terminal
NC terminal
0.6
3.3
10.6
COM
terminal
(C)
7.3
0.5
1.2
9.50.1
19.8
NO terminal
3.2
t = 0.5
NC terminal
7.0
SS
SS
Dimensions and Operating Characteristics
Note:
7.5
PT
SS-01(-E, -F)
SS-5(-F)
SS-10
3.2
2
A
+0.075
2.35 0.05
OP
9.5 10.2
2.9
6.4
2.5
6.4
2.50.07 dia.
1.6
Model
2.35 +0.075
0.05 dia. holes
3.2
6.4
8.8
7.3
5.1 9.50.1
19.8
SS-01-E
SS-01-F
SS-5-F
SS-01
SS-5
SS-10
OF max.
0.25 N {{25 g
gf}}
0.49 N {{50 g
gf}}
1.47 N {{150 g
gf}}
1.47 N {{150 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.02 N {2 gf}
0.04 N {4 gf}
PT max.
0.5 mm
0.5 mm
0.5 mm
0.6 mm
OT min.
0.5 mm
0.5 mm
0.5 mm
0.4 mm
MD max.
0.1 mm
0.1 mm
0.1 mm
0.12 mm
OP
8.40.5 mm
SS-01GL(-E, -F)
SS-5GL(-F)
SS-10GL
+0.075
OP
2.35 0.05
2.9
FP
9.5 10.2
2.5
6.4
+0.075
2.50.07 dia.
1.6
Note:
3.6
3.2
6.4
1. Stainless-steel lever
2. Besides the SS-jGL models with a hinge lever length of 14.5, the SS-jGL11 models with a hinge lever length of 18.5, the
SS-jGL111 models with a hinge lever length of 22.6, and the SS-jGL1111 models with a hinge lever length of 37.8 are available.
Contact your OMRON representative for these models
Model
SS-01GL-E
SS-01GL-F
SS-5GL-F
SS-01GL
SS-5GL
SS-10GL
OF max.
0.08 N {8 gf}
RF min.
i
0.01
0
01 N {1 gf}
f}
(reference value)
0 02 N {2 gf}
0.02
f}
0 06 N {6 gf}
0.06
f}
0 06 N {6 gf}
0.06
f}
OT min.
1.2 mm
1.2 mm
1.2 mm
1.0 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
0.8 mm
0.8 mm
1.0 mm
FP max.
13.6 mm
OP
8.80.8 mm
Note:
The values indicated in parentheses are reference values for cases when the installation direction is such that the lever weight is not
applied to the plunger.
173
SS
SS
Simulated Roller Lever Models
A 1.3R
15.8
t = 0.3
(see note)
SS-01GL13(-E, -F)
SS-5GL13(-F)
SS-10GL13
3.6
OP
+0.075
2.35 0.05
FP
9.5 10.2
2.5
2.9
6.4
2.35 +0.075
0.05 dia. holes
2.50.07 dia.
1.6
8.8
3.2
6.4
7.3
Note:
5.1 9.50.1
19.8
Model
SS-01GL13-E
SS-01GL13-F
SS-5GL13-F
SS-01GL13
SS-5GL13
SS-10GL13
OF max.
0.08 N {8 gf}
RF min.
i
0.01
0
01 N {1 gf}
f}
(reference value)
0 02 N {2 gf}
0.02
f}
0 06 N {6 gf}
0.06
f}
0 06 N {6 gf}
0.06
f}
OT min.
1.2 mm
1.2 mm
1.2 mm
1.0 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
0.8 mm
0.8 mm
1.0 mm
FP max.
15.5 mm
OP
10.70.8 mm
Note:
The values indicated in parentheses are reference values for cases when the installation direction is such that the lever weight is not
applied to the plunger.
14.5
SS-01GL2(-E, -F)
SS-5GL2(-F)
SS-10GL2
t = 0.3
(see note 1)
OP
FP
+0.075
9.5 10.2
2.5
6.4
2.50.07 dia.
1.6
+0.075
7.3
3.2
6.4
5.1 9.50.1
19.8
Model
SS-01GL2-E
SS-01GL2-F
SS-5GL2-F
SS-01GL2
SS-5GL2
SS-10GL2
OF max.
0.08 N {8 gf}
RF min.
i
0.01
0
01 N {1 gf}
f}
(reference value)
0 02 N {2 gf}
0.02
f}
0 06 N {6 gf}
0.06
f}
0 06 N {6 gf}
0.06
f}
OT min.
1.2 mm
1.2 mm
1.2 mm
1.0 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
0.8 mm
0.8 mm
1.0 mm
FP max.
19.3 mm
OP
14.50.8 mm
Note:
174
The values indicated in parentheses are reference values for cases when the installation direction is such that the lever weight is not
applied to the plunger.
SS
SS
Precautions
Cautions
Terminal Connection
When soldering the lead wire to the terminal, first insert the lead wire
conductor through the terminal hole and then conduct soldering.
Make sure that the capacity of the soldering iron is 60 W maximum.
Do not take more than 5 s to solder the switch terminal. Improper
soldering involving an excessively high temperature or excessive
soldering time may deteriorate the characteristics of the Switch.
Be sure to apply only the minimum required amount of flux. The
Switch may have contact failures if flux intrudes into the interior of
the Switch.
Use the following lead wires to connect to the solder terminals.
Model
Conductor size
SS-5
SS-10
0.75 mm2
If the PCB terminal models are soldered in the solder bath, flux will
permeate inside the Switch and cause contact failure. Therefore,
manually solder the PCB terminal.
Wire the quickconnect terminals (#110) with receptacles. Insert
the terminals straight into the receptacles. Do not impose excessive
force on the terminal in the horizontal direction, otherwise the terminal may be deformed or the housing may be damaged.
Operating range
for micro load
models SS-01
Operating
range for
general-load
models
SS-5, SS-10
Inoperable
range
Insulation Distance
According to EN61058-1, the minimum insulation thickness for this
Switch should be 1.1 mm and minimum clearance distance between the terminal and mounting plate should be 1.6 mm. If the insulation distance cannot be provided in the product incorporating
the Switch, either use a Switch with insulation barrier or use a Separator to ensure sufficient insulation distance. Refer to Separator on
page 152.
Correct Use
Mounting
Current (mA)
Separators
Applicable
Switch
SS,, D2S,, D2SW
0.18
0.4
Thickness (mm)
Separator
Note:
Connector
Refer to Terminal Connectors on page 282.
175
Ordering Information
SS-@@@P@
1 2 3
1. Ratings
3:
3 A at 125 VAC
01:
0.1 A at 30 VDC
2. Contact Gap
G:
0.5 mm
3. Actuator
None: Pin plunger
L:
Hinge lever
L13: Simulated roller lever
176
4. Terminals
None: Solder terminals
T:
Quick-connect terminals (#110)
D:
PCB terminals (Uneven pitch)
B:
PCB terminals (Even pitch)
SS-P
SS-P
SS-P
List of Models
Terminals
Solder terminals
Quick-connect
terminals (#110)
PCB terminals
Rating
Actuator
3A
Pin plunger
SS-3GP
SS-3GPT
SS-3GPD
SS-3GPB
Hinge lever
SS-3GLP
SS-3GLPT
SS-3GLPD
SS-3GLPB
SS-3GL13P
SS-3GL13PT
SS-3GL13PD
SS-3GL13PB
Pin plunger
SS-01GP
SS-01GPT
SS-01GPD
SS-01GPB
Hinge lever
SS-01GLP
SS-01GLPT
SS-01GLPD
SS-01GLPB
SS-01GL13P
SS-01GL13PT
SS-01GL13PD
SS-01GL13PB
0.1 A
Uneven pitch
Even pitch
Specifications
Ratings
Model
Rated voltage
SS-3P
Item
SS-01P
Resistive load
125 VAC
3A
0.1 A
30 VDC
3A
0.1 A
Note:
Characteristics
Operating speed
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
SS-3P: 50 m max.
SS-01P: 100 m max.
1,000 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between terminals of the same polarities
1,500 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between current-carrying metal parts and ground,
and between each terminal and non-current-carrying metal parts
Degree of protection
IEC IP40
Class I
175
Weight
Note:
177
SS-P
SS-P
Approved Standards
Contact Specifications
Item
Model
Contact Specification
SS-01P
125 VAC
3A
0.1 A
30 VDC
3A
0.1 A
SS-01P
125 VAC
3A
0.1 A
30 VDC
3A
0.1 A
SS-01P
Crossbar
Material
Silver alloy
Gold alloy
Gap
(standard value)
0.5 mm
SS-3P
Rivet
For more information on the minimum applicable load, refer to Using Micro Loads on page 180.
Contact Form
SPDT
COM
NO NC
Dimensions
Terminals
Note:
All units are in millimeters unless otherwise indicated. (Terminal plate thickness is 0.5 mm for all models.)
Solder Terminals
7.550.2
7.3
11
3.30.1
3.30.1
7.1
0.5
Three, 1.6-dia. holes
8.55
15.5
2.15
3-2.8
0.5
7.60.2 7.60.2
7.550.2
(4.82)
(5.25)
1.8
1.8
3.9
3.30.1
3.30.1
1.85
3-1.2
8.80.2
3-0.8
1.3
0.5
16.10.2
7.620.2
Mounting Holes
Two, 2.4-dia. mounting holes or M2.3 screw holes
9.50.1
178
1.3
3-0.8
0.5
7.620.2
16.10.1
8.80.1
3-1.2
3.9
SS-P
SS-P
Note:
7.550.2
PT
Model
3.5
2.50.07 dia.
2
A
2.35+0.075
0.05 dia.
+0.075
OP 2.350.05
6.9
7.7
3.30.1
7.3
8.55
15.5
2.15
0.5
SS-3GP
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
0.6 mm
0.4 mm
0.15 mm
OP
8.40.3 mm
SS-01GP
6.40.2
5.15 9.50.1
19.80.2
14.5
3.6
Model
2.50.07 dia.
2.35+0.075
0.05
6.9
7.7
OP
FP
3.30.1
7.3
8.55
15.5
2.15
2.35+0.075
0.05 dia.
Three, 1.6 dia. holes
0.5
SS-3GLP
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
1.0 mm
0.8 mm
FP max.
OP
13.6 mm
8.80.8 mm
SS-01GLP
6.40.2
5.15 9.50.1
19.80.2
15.8
3.6
A
R1.2
Model
2.50.07 dia.
2.35+0.075
0.05
6.9
7.7
OP
FP
3.30.1
7.3
2.35+0.075
0.05 dia.
2.15
8.55
15.5
0.5
SS-3GL13P
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
1.0 mm
0.8 mm
FP max.
OP
15.5 mm
10.70.8 mm
SS-01GL13P
6.40.2
5.15 9.50.1
19.80.2
179
SS-P
SS-P
Precautions
Cautions
30
0.16 mA
26 mA
24
100 mA
Operating range
for micro load
models SS-01P
Operating
range for
generalload models
SS-3P
12
Inoperable
range
100 mA 160 mA
1 mA
Correct Use
Mounting
Turn OFF the power supply before mounting or removing the
Switch, wiring, or performing maintenance or inspection. Failure
to do so may result in electric shock or burning.
Use M2.3 mounting screws with plane washers or spring washers
to securely mount the Switch. Tighten the screws to a torque of
0.23 to 0.26 Nm {2.3 to 2.7 kgfcm}.
Mount the Switch onto a flat surface. Mounting on an uneven surface may cause deformation of the Switch, resulting in faulty operation or breakage in the housing.
180
0.1
10
100
1,000
Current (mA)
SS-P
SS-P
Separators
Thickness
Model
0.18 mm
0.4 mm
Separator
Note:
Connectors
Use the following quick-connect connector made by Nippon Tanshi or Tyco Electronics. This connector is not sold by OMRON.
Contact the following Nippon Tanshi or Tyco Electronics office to
purchase this connector.
Nippon Tanshi Co., Ltd.
Japan
Tel: (81)463-30-1150
Hong Kong Tel: (852)2191-2727
Tel: (81)44-844-8111
Tel (1)800-522-6752
This connector is for use with the SS-P and the terminal direction
is 90 different from the SS Series.
181
SSG
ERCW
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend
SSG-jjjjj
1
1.
Ratings
5: 5 A at 125 VAC
01: 0.1 A at 125 VAC
2.
Actuator
None: Pin plunger
L1:
Hinge lever
L3:
Simulated roller lever
L2:
Hinge roller lever
3.
Contact Form
None: SPDT
-2:
SPST-NC
-3:
SPST-NO
4.
Terminals
H: Solder terminals
T: Quick-connect terminals (#110)
P: PCB terminals (SPDT only)
5.
Contact Form
SPDT
182
SPST-NC
SPST-NO
SSG
SSG
List of Models
Actuator
Rating
Pin plunger
OF max.
5A
0.1 A
Hinge
g lever
5A
0.1 A
5A
0.1 A
Hinge
g roller lever
5A
0.1 A
Note:
Solder
terminals
Quick-connect
terminals (#110)
PCB terminals
SSG-5H
SSG-5T
SSG-5P
SSG-5H-5
SSG-5T-5
SSG-5P-5
SSG-01H
SSG-01T
SSG-01P
SSG-01H-5
SSG-01T-5
SSG-01P-5
SSG-5L1H
SSG-5L1T
SSG-5L1P
SSG-5L1H-5
SSG-5L1T-5
SSG-5L1P-5
SSG-01L1H
SSG-01L1T
SSG-01L1P
SSG-01L1H-5
SSG-01L1T-5
SSG-01L1P-5
SSG-5L3H
SSG-5L3T
SSG-5L3P
SSG-5L3H-5
SSG-5L3T-5
SSG-5L3P-5
SSG-01L3H
SSG-01L3T
SSG-01L3P
SSG-01L3H-5
SSG-01L3T-5
SSG-01L3P-5
SSG-5L2H
SSG-5L2T
SSG-5L2P
SSG-5L2H-5
SSG-5L2T-5
SSG-5L2P-5
SSG-01L2H
SSG-01L2T
SSG-01L2P
SSG-01L2H-5
SSG-01L2T-5
SSG-01L2P-5
Consult your OMRON sales representative for details on SPST-NO and SPST-NC models.
Specifications
Ratings
General Ratings
Rated voltage
Non-inductive load
Resistive load
NC
Inductive load
Lamp load
NO
NC
Inductive load
NO
NC
Motor load
NO
NC
NO
125 VAC
1.5 A
0.7 A
3A
2.5 A
1.3 A
250 VAC
3A
1A
0.5 A
2A
1.5 A
0.8 A
8 VDC
5A
2A
5A
3A
14 VDC
5A
2A
4A
3A
30 VDC
2A
3A
3A
125 VDC
0.4 A
0.05 A
0.4 A
0.05 A
250 VDC
0.2 A
0.03 A
0.2 A
0.05 A
Note:
The above current ratings are the values of the steady-state current.
Inductive load has a power factor of 0.7 min. (AC) and a time constant of 7 ms max. (DC).
Lamp load has an inrush current of 10 times the steady-state current.
Motor load has an inrush current of 6 times the steady-state current.
If the Switch is used in a DC circuit and is subjected to a surge current, connect a surge suppressor across the switch.
The ratings values apply under the following test conditions:
Ambient temperature: 202C
Ambient humidity: 655%
Operating frequency: 30 operations/min
183
SSG
SSG
Characteristics
Operating speed
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
100 M min.
Contact resistance
Dielectric strength
1,000 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between contacts of the same polarity
(600 VAC for SSG-01H and SSG-01T models)
1,500 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between each terminal and ground
1,500 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between each terminal and non-current-carrying metal part
Vibration resistance
Malfunction: 10 to 2,000 Hz, 196 m/s2 {20G} (Contact open: 10 s max., lever position: at TTP)
Shock resistance
Malfunction: 490 m/s2 {approx. 50G} (Contact open: 10 s max., lever position: at TTP)
IEC IP40
Class I
175
Ambient operating
temperature
Weight
Note:
Approved Standards
Consult your OMRON sales representative for specific models with standard approvals.
SSG-5
SSG-01
125 VAC
5A
0.1 A
250 VAC
3A
---
30 VDC
---
0.1 A
SSG-5
SSG-01
250 VAC
5A
---
30 VDC
---
0.1 A
Contact Specifications
Item
Contact
Inrush current
184
SSG-01H.T
SSG-01P
Rivet
Crossbar
Crossbar
Material
Silver
Gold alloy
Gold alloy
0.5 mm
0.25 mm
0.5 mm
NC
20 A max.
1 A max.
1 A max.
NO
10 A max.
1 A max.
1 A max.
160 mA at 5 VDC
1 mA at 5 VDC
1 mA at 5 VDC
SSG-5
Specification
For more information on the minimum applicable load, refer to Using Micro Loads on page 189.
SSG
SSG
SSG-5 Models
SSG-5 Models
40,000
5,000
Ambient temperature: 202C
Ambient humidity: 655%
Without load
Operating frequency: 60 operations/min
30,000
20,000
10,000
5,000
3,000
1,000
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5
0.6
125 VAC
500
300
250 VAC
100
50
30
10
0.1
0.7
Overtravel (mm)
Dimensions
Note:
Terminals
Solder Terminals
7.50.3
PT
1.8
2.2
+0.1
0
PT
NO
3.5
1.8
+0.1
6.9
2.2
6.1
7.50.3
3.5
2.2 0
7.7 OP
6.9 7.7
OP
2.2
NC
NO
NC
10.6
7.1
2.5 dia.
5.1
2.2 +0.1
0 dia. hole
9.50.1
8.9
1.6
7.2
0.5
3.2
6.40.2
Three, 1.6-dia. holes
2.5 dia.
5.1
1.6
19.8
2.2 +0.1
0
dia. hole
9.50.1
7.2
8.9
Three,
1.2-dia.
holes
2.80.2
3.2
6.40.2
0.5
19.8
PCB Terminals
2.870.1
3.5
1.8
+0.1
2.2 0
2.780.1
3.40.1
6.9 7.7
NO
OP
9.50.1
7.620.1
NC
15.240.1
2.2 +0.1
0
dia. hole
2.5 dia.
5.15
7.620.2
9.50.1
1.8
40.3
19.8
185
SSG
SSG
Mounting Holes
Two, 2.2-dia. mounting holes or
M2.2 screw holes
9.5 0.1
Make sure that the plate to which the SSG is mounted is flat. If the
plate has protruding or warped part, the SSG may not operate properly.
Solder/Quick-connect Terminals
Pin Plunger Models
SSG-01j
SSG-5j
SSG-01j-5
SSG-5j-5
7.50.3
PT
1.8
+0.1
2.2 0
7.7 OP
6.9
2.2
6.1
NO
2.5 dia.
5.1
NC
2.2 +0.1
0 dia. hole
9.50.1
8.9
1.6
3.5
7.2
Model
SSG-01j
SSG-5j
SSG-01j-5
SSG-5j-5
OF max.
1.50 N {{153 g
gf}}
0.50 N {51
{ gf}
g}
RF min.
0.04 N {4 gf}
PT max.
0.6 mm
OT min.
0.4 mm
MD max.
0.1 mm
FP max.
---
OP
8.40.3 mm
3.2
6.40.2
0.5
19.8
Model
SSG-01L1j
SSG-5L1j
SSG-01L1j-5
SSG-5L1j-5
OF max.
0.60 N {{61 g
gf}}
0.20 N {{20 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.06 N {6 gf}
0.02 N {2 gf}
PT max.
1.0 mm
OT min.
0.8 mm
MD max.
---
FP max.
13.6 mm
OP
8.80.6 mm
A
5.30.4
3.6
+0.1
2.2 0
OP
6.9 7.7
2.2
NO
FP
NC
10
+1.0
6.1
2.2
2.5 dia.
5.1
1.6
7.2
dia. hole
3.2
6.4+0.2
9.50.1
8.9
+0.1
0
0.5
19.8
Note:
186
Also available are models with a hinge lever length of 39 mm under the following model numbers; SSG-01L14j, SSG-5L14j,
SSG-01L14j-5, and SSG-5L14j-5. Consult your OMRON sales representative for these models.
SSG
SSG
Simulated Roller Lever Models
SSG-01L3j
SSG-5L3j
SSG-01L3j-5
SSG-51L3j-5
A
6.30.4
1.3R
3.6
OP
2.2 0
2.2
6.9 7.7
6.1
NO
NC
2.2 +0.1
0 dia. hole
2.5 dia.
5.1
1.6
9.50.1
8.9
7.2
Model
SSG-01L3j
SSG-5L3j
SSG-01L3j-5
SSG-5L3j-5
OF max.
0.60 N {{61 g
gf}}
0.20 N {{20 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.06 N {6 gf}
0.02 N {2 gf}
PT max.
1.0 mm
OT min.
0.8 mm
MD max.
---
FP max.
15.5 mm
OP
10.7
10
+1.0
0.6
mm
3.2
6.40.2
Three, 1.6-dia. holes
0.5
19.8
50.4
A
t0.3 Stainless-steel lever
OP
+0.1
2.2 0
2.2
FP
6.9 7.7
NO
Model
SSG-01L2j
SSG-5L2j
SSG-01L2j-5
SSG-5L2j-5
OF max.
0.60 N {{61 g
gf}}
0.20 N {{20 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.06 N {6 gf}
0.02 N {2 gf}
PT max.
1.0 mm
OT min.
0.8 mm
MD max.
---
FP max.
19.0 mm
OP
14.5
+1.0
10
0.6
mm
NC
6.1
+0.1
2.2 0
dia. hole
Three, 1.6-dia. holes
2.5 dia.
5.1
1.6
3.2
6.40.2
9.50.1
7.2
8.9
0.5
19.8
2.870.1
3.5
1.8
+0.1
2.2 0
3.40.1
6.9 7.7
NO
+0.1
2.2 0
2.5 dia.
5.15
7.620.2
9.50.1
OP
NC
Model
SSG-01P
SSG-5P
SSG-01P-5
SSG-5P-5
OF max.
1.50 N {{153 g
gf}}
0.50 N {51
{ gf}
g}
RF min.
0.04 N {4 gf}
PT max.
0.6 mm
OT min.
0.4 mm
MD max.
0.1 mm
FP max.
---
OP
11.80.4 mm
dia. hole
1.8
40.3
19.8
187
SSG
SSG
Hinge Lever Models
SSG-01L1P
SSG-5L1P
SSG-01L1P-5
SSG-5L1P-5
5.30.4
Model
SSG-01L1P
SSG-5L1P
SSG-01L1P-5
SSG-5L1P-5
OF max.
0.60 N {{61 g
gf}}
0.20 N {{20 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.06 N {6 gf}
0.02 N {2 gf}
PT max.
---
OT min.
1.0 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
FP max.
17.0 mm
OP
12.2
2.2 0
3.40.1
FP
6.9 7.7
NO
OP
11
+1.1
0.7
mm
NC
+0.1
2.5 dia.
5.15
7.620.2
9.50.1
1.30.3
0.50.05
6.40.2
1.8
40.3
19.8
Note:
Also available are models with a hinge lever length of 39 mm under the following model numbers; SSG-01L14P, SSG-5L14P,
SSG-01L14P-5, and SSG-5L14P-5. Consult your OMRON sales representative for these models.
1.3R
6.30.4
3.6
2.2 0
3.40.1
6.9 7.7 OP
NO
FP
Model
SSG-01L3P
SSG-5L3P
SSG-01L3P-5
SSG-5L3P-5
OF max.
0.60 N {{61 g
gf}}
0.20 N {{20 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.06 N {6 gf}
0.02 N {2 gf}
PT max.
---
OT min.
1.0 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
FP max.
18.9 mm
OP
14.4
+1.1
11
0.7
mm
NC
+0.1
2.5 dia.
5.15
7.620.2
9.50.1
1.30.3
0.50.05
6.40.2
1.8
40.3
19.8
50.4
+0.1
2.2 0
6.9 7.7
3.40.1
NO
FP
NC
+0.1
2.5 dia.
5.15
7.620.2
9.50.1
19.8
188
1.30.3
0.50.05
6.40.2
1.8
40.3
Model
SSG-01L2P
SSG-5L2P
SSG-01L2P-5
SSG-5L2P-5
OF max.
0.60 N {{61 g
gf}}
0.20 N {{20 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.06 N {6 gf}
0.02 N {2 gf}
PT max.
---
OT min.
1.0 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
FP max.
22.4 mm
OP
17.9
+1.1
11
0.7
mm
SSG
SSG
Precautions
Refer to pages 26 to 31 for common precautions.
Cautions
Correct Use
Terminal Connection
Mounting
When soldering the lead wire to the terminal, first insert the lead wire
conductor through the terminal hole and then take the following
steps promptly.
Operating Stroke
Conductor size
SSG-01
AWG 22 to 20
SSG-5
AWG 20 to 18
Make sure that the operating stroke is 70% to 100% of the rated OT
distance. Do not operate the actuator exceeding the OT distance,
otherwise the durability of the Switch may be shortened.
Insulation Distance
The Switch does not have a ground terminal. According to
EN61058-1, the minimum insulation thickness for this Switch
should be 0.9 mm. If the insulation distance cannot be provided in
the product incorporating the Switch, either use a Switch with insulation barrier or use a Separator to ensure sufficient insulation
distance.
Operating
range for
SSG-5
(generalload models)
Inoperable
range
Current (mA)
189
D2S
RC
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend
D2S-jjjj
1
1.
Ratings
10: 10.1 A at 250 VAC
5: 5 A at 125 VAC
01: 0.1 A at 30 VDC
3.
2.
Actuator
None: Pin plunger
L:
Hinge lever
L13: Simulated roller lever
L2:
Hinge roller lever
4.
Terminals
None: Solder terminals
D:
Self-clinching PCB terminals
List of Models
Actuator
Model
Terminals
OF max.
Solder terminals
D2S-10
D2S-5
D2S-01
10.1 A
Pin plunger
p g
Hinge
g lever
Simulated roller
l
lever
Hinge
g roller lever
0.1 A
---
D2S-5-F
D2S-01-F
Self-clinching
g PCB
t
terminals
i l
D2S-10D
D2S-5D
D2S-01D
---
D2S-5-FD
D2S-01-FD
Solder terminals
D2S-10L
D2S-5L
D2S-01L
---
D2S-5L-F
D2S-01L-F
Self-clinching
g PCB
t
terminals
i l
D2S-10LD
D2S-5LD
D2S-01LD
---
D2S-5L-FD
D2S-01L-FD
Solder terminals
D2S-10L13
D2S-5L13
D2S-01L13
---
D2S-5L13-F
D2S-01L13-F
Self-clinching
g PCB
t
terminals
i l
D2S-10L13D
D2S-5L13D
D2S-01L13D
---
D2S-5L13-FD
D2S-01L13-FD
Solder terminals
D2S-10L2
D2S-5L2
D2S-01L2
---
D2S-5L2-F
D2S-01L2-F
D2S-10L2D
D2S-5L2D
D2S-01L2D
---
D2S-5L2-FD
D2S-01L2-FD
Self-clinching
g PCB
t
i l
terminals
190
5A
D2S
D2S
Specifications
Ratings
Item
Model
Resistive load
Rated voltage
D2S-10
250 VAC
10.1 A
D2S-5
125 VAC
250 VAC
5A
3A
D2S-01
125 VAC
0.1 A
30 VDC
0.1 A
Note:
Voltage
g
Non-inductive load
Resistive load
NC
NO
Inductive load
Lamp load
NC
Inductive load
NO
NC
NO
Non-inductive load
Motor load
NC
Resistive load
NO
NC
125 VAC
5 (10.1) A
1.5 A
0.7 A
3A
2.5 A
1.3 A
0.1 A
250 VAC
3 (10.1) A
1A
0.5 A
2A
1.5 A
0.8 A
---
8 VDC
5 (10.1) A
2A
5A
4A
3A
0.1 A
14 VDC
5 (10.1) A
2A
4A
4A
3A
0.1 A
30 VDC
4A
2A
3A
3A
3A
0.1 A
125 VDC
0.4 A
0.05 A
0.4 A
0.4 A
0.05 A
---
250 VDC
0.2 A
0.03 A
0.2 A
0.2 A
0.03 A
---
Note:
NO
191
D2S
D2S
Characteristics
Operating speed
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
Contact resistance
(initial value) (see note 2)
Vibration resistance
(see note 4)
Destruction:
Malfunction:
Degree of protection
IEC IP40
Class 1
175
Ambient operating
temperature
Weight
Note:
192
D2S
D2S
Approved Standards
Contact Form
SPDT
D2S-10
D2S-5
D2S-01
125 VAC
---
5A
0.1 A
250 VAC
10.1 A
3A
---
30 VDC
---
---
0.1 A
Contact Specifications
Item
Contact
Inrush
currentt
D2S-10
Specification
Rivet
Material
Silver
alloy
Gap
(standard
value)
0.5 mm
NC
20 A max.
NO
15 A max.
Minimum applicable
load (see note)
Note:
D2S-5
D2S-01
Crossbar
Silver
Gold alloy
1 A max.
10 A max.
160 mA at 5 VDC
1 A max.
1 mA at
5 VDC
D2S-10 models
Overtravel (mm)
Number of operations (x 10 4)
Number of operations (x 10 4)
Mechanical Durability
(Pin Plunger Models)
D2S-5 models
193
D2S
D2S
Dimensions
Note:
Terminals
Solder terminals
2
3.30.1
3.30.1
1.80.1
7.3
3.9
1.6
8.80.2
5.15 9.50.1
0.5
6.40.2
3.2
1.85
16.10.2
8.80.2
5.15 9.50.1
16.10.2
0.5
0.8
1.2
1.3
6.40.2
8.8
16.1
Mounting Holes
Two, 2.4-dia. mounting hole
or M2.3 screw holes
9.50.1
(5.3) 7.50.1
1.8
2.350.05
2.350.05 dia. PT
7.7
3.6
3.30.1
3.9
0.5
1.3
9.50.1
194
16.10.2
19.80.2
D2S-01j
D2S-5j
D2S-10j
OF max.
1.47 N {{150 g
gf}}
0.49 N {50
{ gf}
g}
RF min.
0.04 N {4 gf}
PT max.
0.7 mm
OT min.
0.4 mm
MD max.
0.1 mm
OP
8.40.25 mm
OP
1.80.1
2.50.07 dia.
Model
A
6.40.2
D2S-01-Fj
D2S-5-Fj
D2S
D2S
Hinge Lever Models
Model
t = 0.3*
14.5
2.350.05
3.6
2.350.05 dia.
FP
OP
7.7
1.80.1
2
3.30.1
3.9
0.5
1.3
9.50.1
16.10.2
19.80.2
2.50.07 dia.
D2S-01Lj
D2S-5Lj
D2S-10Lj
D2S-01L-Fj
D2S-5L-Fj
OF max.
0.49 N {{50 g
gf}}
0.18 N {{18 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.06 N {6 gf}
0.02 N {2 gf}
OT min.
1.0 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
FP max.
13.6 mm
OP
9.40.8 mm
6.40.2
*Stainless-steel lever
t = 0.3*
2.350.05
dia.
2.350.05
7.7
Model
3.6
R1.3
15.8
OP
FP
1.80.1
3.30.1
3.9
0.5
1.3
9.50.1
16.10.2
2.50.07 dia.
6.40.2
4.8 dia.
2.350.05
dia.
OP
2.350.05
3.2**
FP
7.7
1.80.1
2
3.30.1
3.9
0.5
1.3
2.50.07 dia.
OF max.
0.49 N {{50 g
gf}}
0.18 N {{18 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.06 N {6 gf}
0.02 N {2 gf}
OT min.
1.0 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
FP max.
15.5 mm
OP
11.40.8 mm
Model
14.5
t = 0.3*
9.50.1
16.10.2
19.80.2
D2S-01L13-Fj
D2S-5L13-Fj
*Stainless-steel lever
19.80.2
D2S-01L13j
D2S-5L13j
D2S-10L13j
D2S-01L2j
D2S-5L2j
D2S-10L2j
D2S-01L2-Fj
D2S-5L2-Fj
OF max.
0.49 N {{50 g
gf}}
0.18 N {{18 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.06 N {6 gf}
0.02 N {2 gf}
OT min.
1.0 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
FP max.
19.3 mm
OP
15.10.8 mm
6.40.2
*Stainless-steel lever
**Oil-less polyacetal resin roller
195
D2S
D2S
Precautions
Refer to pages 26 to 31 for common precautions.
Cautions
Correct Use
Mounting
Terminal Connection
When soldering the lead wire to the terminal, first insert the lead wire
conductor through the terminal hole and then conduct soldering.
Make sure that the capacity of the soldering iron is 60 W maximum.
Do not take more than 5 s to solder the switch terminal. Improper
soldering involving an excessively high temperature or excessive
soldering time may deteriorate the characteristics of the Switch.
When soldering the lead wire to the PCB terminal, pay careful attention so that the flux and solder liquid level does not exceed the PCB
level.
Voltage (V)
Operating range
for micro load
models D2S-01
Operating
range for
general load
models
D2S-5,
D2S-10
Inoperable
range
Current (mA)
196
D2F
RC
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend
D2F-jjjj
1
1.
2.
3.
Ratings
None: General loads
01:
Micro loads (0.1 A at 30 VDC)
Maximum Operating Force
None: 1.47 N {150 gf}
F:
0.74 N {75 gf}
Note: These values are for the pin plunger models.
4.
Terminals
None: PCB terminals/straight terminals
-T:
Self-clinching PCB terminals
-A:
Right-angled PCB terminals
-A1: Left-angled PCB terminals
-D3: Solder terminals
-D:
Compact solder terminals
Actuator
None: Pin plunger
L:
Hinge lever
L2:
Hinge roller lever
L3:
Simulated roller lever
197
D2F
D2F
List of Models
Actuator
General loads
General loads
PCB terminals
General-purpose
1.47 N {150 gf}
0.1 A
Low operating
force 0.74 N {75 gf}
D2F-F
D2F-01
D2F-01F
D2F-F-T
D2F-01-T
D2F-01F-T
Right-angled
terminals
D2F-A
D2F-F-A
D2F-01-A
D2F-01F-A
Left-angled terminals
D2F-A1
D2F-F-A1
D2F-01-A1
D2F-01F-A1
D2F-D3
D2F-F-D3
D2F-01-D3
D2F-01F-D3
D2F-D
D2F-F-D
D2F-01-D
D2F-01F-D
PCB terminals
D2F-L
D2F-FL
D2F-01L
D2F-01FL
Self-clinching
terminals
D2F-L-T
D2F-FL-T
D2F-01L-T
D2F-01FL-T
Right-angled
terminals
D2F-L-A
D2F-FL-A
D2F-01L-A
D2F-01FL-A
Left-angled terminals
D2F-L-A1
D2F-FL-A1
D2F-01L-A1
D2F-01FL-A1
D2F-L-D3
D2F-FL-D3
D2F-01L-D3
D2F-01FL-D3
D2F-L-D
D2F-FL-D
D2F-01L-D
D2F-01FL-D
Compact solder
terminals
PCB terminals
D2F-L3
D2F-FL3
D2F-01L3
D2F-01FL3
Self-clinching
terminals
D2F-L3-T
D2F-FL3-T
D2F-01L3-T
D2F-01FL3-T
Right-angled
terminals
D2F-L3-A
D2F-FL3-A
D2F-01L3-A
D2F-01FL3-A
Left-angled terminals
D2F-L3-A1
D2F-FL3-A1
D2F-01L3-A1
D2F-01FL3-A1
D2F-L3-D3
D2F-FL3-D3
D2F-01L3-D3
D2F-01FL3-D3
D2F-L3-D
D2F-FL3-D
D2F-01L3-D
D2F-01FL3-D
Solder terminals
Compact solder
terminals
PCB terminals
D2F-L2
D2F-FL2
D2F-01L2
D2F-01FL2
Self-clinching
terminals
D2F-L2-T
D2F-FL2-T
D2F-01L2-T
D2F-01FL2-T
Right-angled
terminals
D2F-L2-A
D2F-FL2-A
D2F-01L2-A
D2F-01FL2-A
Left-angled terminals
D2F-L2-A1
D2F-FL2-A1
D2F-01L2-A1
D2F-01FL2-A1
D2F-L2-D3
D2F-FL2-D3
D2F-01L2-D3
D2F-01FL2-D3
D2F-L2-D
D2F-FL2-D
D2F-01L2-D
D2F-01FL2-D
Solder terminals
Compact solder
terminals
Note:
Low operating
force 0.74 N {75 gf}
D2F-T
Solder terminals
Hinge
g roller
l
lever
General-purpose
1.47 N {150 gf}
D2F
Compact solder
terminals
Simulated
ll lever
l
roller
1A
Self-clinching
terminals
Solder terminals
Hinge
g lever
Micro loads
3A
The OF values shown in the table are for the pin plunger models.
Specifications
Ratings
Item
D2F models
OF max.
D2F-01 models
Resistive load
Rated voltage
Note:
125 VAC
3A
1A
---
30 VDC
2A
0.5 A
0.1 A
1. Consult your OMRON sales representative before using the Switch with inductive or motor loads.
2. The ratings values apply under the following test conditions:
Ambient temperature: 202C
Ambient humidity: 655%
Operating frequency: 30 operations/min
198
D2F
D2F
Characteristics
Operating speed
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
Contact resistance
(initial value)
D2F models:
D2F-F models:
D2F-01 models:
600 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between terminals of the same polarity
1,500 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between current-carrying metal parts and ground, and between
each terminal and non-current-carrying metal part
Vibration resistance
(see note 3)
Shock resistance
(see note 3)
Degree of protection
IEC IP40
Class I
175
Ambient operating
temperature
Weight
Note:
30 m max.
50 m max.
100 m max.
Approved Standards
Contact Form
SPDT
D2F (generalpurpose)
D2F (low
operating
force)
D2F-01
125 VAC
3A
1A
---
30 VDC
2A
0.5 A
0.1 A
Contact Specifications
Item
Contact
Crossbar
Material
Silver alloy
Gap
(standard
value)
0.25 mm
D2F models
Specification
100 mA
at 5 VDC
D2F-01 models
Gold alloy
1 mA at 5 VDC
199
D2F
D2F
5,000
7,000
3,000
1,000
700
500
300
100
300
100
125 VAC
50
30 VDC
30
20
10
OT (mm)
Dimensions
Note:
Terminals
PCB Terminals (Standard)
3.15
6.50.1
1.5
1.5
3.5
3.4
0.4
0.9
5.08
5.08
12.80.15
3.15
6.50.1
0.9
5.08
5.08
12.80.15
5.80.15
1.60.15
1.5
1.5
2.60.2
6.50.1
5.08
5.08
12.80.15
0.9
2.60.2
3.15
0.4
5.80.15
3.10.2
Solder Terminals
6.50.1
5.08
5.08
12.80.15
1.5
0.5
3.15
6.50.1
5.08
5.08
12.80.15
200
0.9
5.80.15
0.4
3.10.2
1.5 2.4
3.5
5.80.15
3.15
1.5
0.40.05
1.250.15
1.2
2.2
3.15
0.4
5.80.15
6.50.1
5.08
5.08
12.80.15
1.6
0.4
5.80.15
D2F
D2F
PCB Mounting Dimensions
(Reference)
Mounting Holes
2.54
5.8 0.15
6.5 0.15
2.54
Three,
1.2 dia. holes
5.08 0.1
12.8 0.15
Model
D2Fj
D2F-01j
D2F-Fj
D2F-01Fj
OF max.
1.47 N {{150 g
gf}}
0.74 N {75
{ gf}
g}
RF min.
0.05 N {5 gf}
OP
PT max.
0.5 mm
1.5
OT min.
0.25 mm
3.5
MD max.
0.12 mm
OP
5.50.3 mm
12.7
1.2
+0.12
2.2 0
5
2 +0.12
0
0.4
0.9
6.50.1
3.15
5.7
2.9
PT +0.12
20
dia. holes
5.2
dia.
5.08
5.08
12.80.15
5.80.15
Model
D2F-Lj
D2F-01Lj
D2F-FLj
D2F-01FLj
OF max.
0.78 N {{80 g
gf}}
0.25 N {{25 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.05 N {5 gf}
0.02 N {2 gf}
OT min.
0.55 mm
MD max.
0.5 mm
FP max.
10 mm
6.81.5 mm
12.8
(10.8)
t = 0.3 (see note)
FP
OP
OP
Note:
Stainless-steel lever
12.7
(7.5)
10
2.1
1.3R
OP
Note:
FP
Model
D2F-L3j
D2F-01L3j
OF max.
0.78 N {{80 g
gf}}
0.39 N {{40 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.05 N {5 gf}
0.02 N {2 gf}
OT min.
0.5 mm
MD max.
0.45 mm
FP max.
13 mm
OP
8.51.2 mm
D2F-FL3j
D2F-01FL3j
Stainless-steel lever
201
D2F
D2F
Hinge Roller Lever Models
D2F-L2j
D2F-01L2j
D2F-FL2j
D2F-01FL2j
12.8
Model
D2F-L2j
D2F-01L2j
OF max.
0.78 N {{80 g
gf}}
0.39 N {{40 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.05 N {5 gf}
0.02 N {2 gf}
OT min.
0.55 mm
MD max.
0.5 mm
FP max.
16.5 mm
OP
132 mm
4
(10)
t = 0.3
(see
note)
4
OP FP
Note:
D2F-FL2j
D2F-01FL2j
Stainless-steel lever
Precautions
Cautions
Terminal Connection
When soldering a lead wire to the terminal, first insert the lead wire
conductor into the terminal hole and then perform soldering.
Make sure that the capacity of the soldering iron is 30 W maximum
and that the temperature of the soldering iron tip is approximately
300C. (350C maximum.) Complete the soldering within 3 s.
Using a switch with improper soldering may result in abnormal heating, possibly resulting in burn.
Applying a soldering iron for more than 3 s or using one that is rated
at more than 30 W may deteriorate the switch characteristics.
When soldering the lead wire to the PCB terminal, pay careful attention so that the flux and solder liquid level does not exceed the PCB
level.
Correct Use
Voltage (V)
Mounting
Turn OFF the power supply before mounting or removing the
Switch, wiring, or performing maintenance or inspection. Failure to
do so may result in electric shock or burning.
Use M2 mounting screws with plane washers or spring washers to
securely mount the Switch. Tighten the screws to a torque of 0.08 to
0.1 Nm {0.8 to 1 kgfcm}.
Mount the Switch onto a flat surface. Mounting on an uneven surface may cause deformation of the Switch, resulting in faulty operation or breakage in the housing.
Operating range
for micro load
models D2F-01
Operating
range for
general-load
models
D2F
Inoperable
range
Current (mA)
202
RC
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend
J-7j-j
1
1.
Ratings
7:
7 A at 250 VAC
2.
Contact Material
None: Gold-plated silver
Y:
Silver
3.
Actuator
None: Pin plunger
V:
Short hinge lever
V3:
Hinge lever
V4:
Long hinge lever
V22: Short hinge roller lever
V2:
Hinge roller lever
List of Models
Actuator
Model
Pin plunger
J-7
Short hinge
lever
J-7-V
Hinge lever
J-7-V3
J-7-V4
J-7-V22
J-7-V2
Note:
Externally mounted levers JAL and JAL2 are sold separately. Refer to page 208.
203
Specifications
Ratings
Rated voltage
Resistive load
125 VAC
7A
250 VAC
7A
Note:
Non-inductive load
Resistive load
NC
Inductive load
NC
NO
Motor load
NC
NO
NC
NO
125 VAC
7A
1.5 A
0.7 A
4A
2.5 A
1.3 A
250 VAC
7A
1.5 A
0.7 A
4A
2.5 A
1.3 A
8 VDC
7A
1.5 A
0.7 A
3A
2.5 A
1.3 A
14 VDC
7A
1.5 A
0.7 A
3A
2.5 A
1.3 A
30 VDC
5A
1.5 A
0.7 A
3A
2.5 A
1.3 A
125 VDC
0.4 A
0.4 A
0.4 A
0.03 A
0.03 A
0.03 A
250 VDC
0.2 A
0.2 A
0.2 A
0.02 A
0.02 A
0.02 A
Note:
NO
Inductive load
Lamp load
Characteristics
Operating speed
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
15 m max.
Dielectric strength
600 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between terminals of the same polarity
1,500 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between each terminal and non-current-carrying metal part and
between current-carrying metal part and ground.
Degree of protection
IEC IP40
Class I
175
Weight
Note:
204
J
Approved Standards
Contact Form
SPDT
J-7
125 VAC
7A
250 VAC
Contact Specifications
Contact
Inrush
currentt
Specification
Rivet
Material
Silver plated
Gold plated
0.35 mm
NC
15 A max.
NO
7 A max.
30 mA at 5 VDC
Electrical Durability
100,000
1,000
Without load
Operating frequency:
400 operations/min
50,000
30,000
10,000
7,000
5,000
3,000
1,000
0.1
0.2
0.3
Overtravel (mm)
700
70,000
0.4
0.5
500
300
200
125 VAC
100
250 VAC
70
50
30
20
10
205
Dimensions
Mounting Holes
Note:
4.8 0.1
1.5 dia.
PT
0.8R (plastic pin plunger)
+0.05
OP
2.35 0.025
8.9
2.3
5.1
2.5 +0.05
0.025dia.
1.5 dia.
3.95
6.6
2.3
2.5 +0.05
0.025dia.
OP
11.450.4
5.1
+0.05
2.35 0.025
1 dia.
1.5 dia.
+0.05
4.80.05 3.95
12.7
14.7
5.10.1
t = 0.3
(see note)
A
22R0.4
PT
2.3
0.6 mm
OT min.
0.1 mm
MD max.
0.15 mm
OP
8.10.3 mm
1 dia.
1.5 dia.
+0.05
12.7
14.7
0.49 N {{50 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.08 N {9 g}
PT max.
1.7 mm
OT min.
0.35 mm
MD max.
0.5 mm
OP
8.31.2 mm
Model
5.1
+0.05
J-7-V
OF max.
11.450.4
2.5 0.025dia.
4.80.05 3.95
Note:
2.3
6.6 OP
+0.05
2.35 0.025
206
PT max.
Model
2.3
PT
9.150.4 8
9.150.4
1.37 N {{140 g
gf}}
RF min.
5.10.1
t = 0.3
(see note)
A
9.3
J-7-V3
OF max.
+0.05
4.80.05
12.7
J-7-V
J-7
Model
3.5 dia.
J-7
Note:
J-7-V3
OF max.
0.29 N {{30 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.04 N {5 gf}
PT max.
2.9 mm
OT min.
0.5 mm
MD max.
0.7 mm
OP
8.31.9 mm
J
t = 0.3
(Stainless-steel
spring lever)
A
Model
J-7-V4
+0.05
2.5 0.025dia.
J-7-V22
+0.05
4.8 dia.
t = 0.3
(see note)
+0.05
2.5 0.025dia.
+0.05
1 dia.
1.5 dia.
Note:
t = 0.3
(see note)
2.5 +0.05
0.025dia.
+0.05
0.20 N {{20 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.02 N {3 gf}
PT max.
4.5 mm
OT min.
0.8 mm
MD max.
1.2 mm
OP
8.32.9 mm
1 dia.
1.5 dia.
J-7-V4
OF max.
Note:
1 dia.
1.5 dia.
Model
J-7-V22
OF max.
0.54 N {{55 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.04 N {5 gf}
PT max.
1.6 mm
OT min.
0.25 mm
MD max.
0.4 mm
OP
14.71 mm
Model
J-7-V2
OF max.
0.324 N {{33 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.02 N {3 gf}
PT max.
2.7 mm
OT min.
0.45 mm
MD max.
0.7 mm
OP
14.71.9 mm
207
J
Accessories (Sold Separately)
Actuators
Leaf Spring
8.3
JAL
FP
Model
t = 0.3
(see note 1)
3.6
Two, M2.3 10
OP
2.3
5.2
4.8
Insulating separator
see note 2
4.80.1
13.6
3
5.6
Note:
JAL
OF max.
1.95 N {{199 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
5.2 mm
(reference value)
OT min.
0.3 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
FP max.
13.1 mm
OP
8.70.8 mm
JAL2
6.3
Model
4.8 dia. 27
(see note 1)
FP
OP
Two, M2.3 10
5.2
2.3
see note 2
Insulating separator
4.80.1
4.8
3
5.6
JAL2
OF max.
1.95 N {{199 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
3.6 mm
(reference value)
OT min.
0.3 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
FP max.
19.5 mm
OP
15.10.8 mm
13.6
Note:
Precautions
Refer to pages 26 to 31 for common precautions.
Correct Use
Mounting
Use two M2.3 screws with plain washers or spring washers to securely mount the Switch. Tighten the screws to a torque of 0.19 to
0.29 N S m {2 to 3 kgf S cm}.
Soldering
To solder the lead to the terminal, apply a soldering iron rated at
30 W max. quickly (within 3 seconds) with the actuator at the free
position.
Applying a soldering iron for too long a time or using one that is rated
at more than 30 W may degrade the Switch characteristics.
208
D2MQ
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend
D2MQ-1j-j-j
1
1.
Ratings
1: Silver-plated contact type (0.5 A at 30 VDC)
Gold-plated contact type (50 mA at 30 VDC)
3.
Contact Material
None: Silver-plated
105: Gold-plated
2.
Actuator
None: Pin plunger
L:
Leaf lever
4.
Terminals
None: Straight terminals
TL:
Left-angled terminals
TR:
Right-angled terminals
3.
Terminals
None: Straight terminals
L:
Left-angled terminals
R:
Right-angled terminals
D2MQ-4L-j-1-j
1
1.
Actuator
4L: Hinge leaf lever
2.
List of Models
Standard model (Ag-plated)
Actuator
Terminals
Straight
terminals
Left-angled
terminals
Right-angled
terminals
Straight
terminals
Right-angled
terminals
Pin plunger
D2MQ-1
D2MQ-1-TL
D2MQ-1-TR
D2MQ-1-105
---
---
Leaf lever
D2MQ-1L
D2MQ-1L-TL
D2MQ-1L-TR
D2MQ-1L-105
---
---
D2MQ-4L-1
D2MQ-4L-1-L
D2MQ-4L-1-R
D2MQ-4L-105-1
D2MQ-4L-105-1-L
D2MQ-4L-105-1-R
Note:
The terminal shape drawings indicate the shape when the Switch is viewed from the direction of the arrow in the drawing below.
209
D2MQ
D2MQ
Specifications
Ratings
Type
Rated voltage
30 VDC
Note:
Item
Resistive load
0.5 A
50 mA
Characteristics
Operating speed
(see note 2)
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
Contact resistance
(initial value)
100 m max.
Dielectric strength
500 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between terminals at the same polarity
500 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between current-carrying metal parts and ground
Vibration resistance
(see note 3)
Shock resistance
(see note 3)
Degree of protection
IEC IP40
Degree of protection
against electric shock
Class I
175
Ambient operating
temperature
Ambient operating
humidity
Weight
Approx. 0.3 g
Note:
Contact Specifications
Item
Contact
Inrush
currentt
Gold-plated
contact type
Specification
Rivet
Material
Silver plated
Gap (standard
value)
0.15 mm
NC
0.5 A max.
0.05 A max.
NO
0.5 A max.
0.05 A max.
50 mA
at 5 VDC
5 mA at 5 VDC
210
Silver-plated
contact type
Contact Form
Gold plated
SPDT
D2MQ
D2MQ
Electrical Durability
(D2MQ-1)
1,000
100
Ambient temperature: 202C
Ambient humidity: 655%
Without load
Operating frequency: 120 operations/min
500
300
100
70
50
30
10
Ambient temperature:
Ambient humidity:
Operating frequency:
OT:
cos=1
70
700
50
30
202C
655%
20 operations/min
Full stroke
10
7
5
3
1
0
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.1
Overtravel (mm)
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5
0.6
Dimensions
Note:
Terminals
Straight Terminals
Left-angled Terminals
Right-angled Terminals
3.4
Mounting Dimensions
Three,
1.6 dia. holes
(see note)
Note:
Mounting Holes
Two, 1.6-dia. mounting
holes or M1.4 screw holes
4.0 0.1
211
D2MQ
D2MQ
Dimensions and Operating Characteristics
Note:
2.6
0.8
PT
A 8.1
0.45
OP
6.5
+0.1
Two, 1.6 0
dia.
1.6
0.8
1.3
1.6
2.1
8.1
7.7R
0.6R (plastic
A leaf lever)
2.6
0.45
FP
6.5
1.6
dia.
8.1
5.350.1
0.7R
Two,
1.6 +0.1
0
6.3R
2.6
2.4
0.8
4.45
0.5R
1.6
dia.
0.6
4.00.05
1.6 2.5 2.5
8.2
212
0.4 mm
OT min.
0.1 mm
MD max.
0.1 mm
OP
5.70.2 mm
OF max.
0.59 N {{60 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.08 N {8 gf}
PT max.
2.4 mm
OT min.
0.3 mm
MD max.
0.7 mm
FP max.
9.6 mm
OP
6.70.5 mm
OF max.
0.39 N {{40 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.04 N {4 gf}
PT max.
2.1 mm
OT min.
0.3 mm
MD max.
0.7 mm
FP max.
8.7 mm
OP
7.10.5 mm
2.5 2.5
40.05
8.2
6.6
5.9
D2MQ-4L-1
D2MQ-4L-1-L
D2MQ-4L-1-R
PT max.
0.6
2.7
0.45
0.8
1.3
1.6
2.1
5.0
OP
FP
+0.1
0.6
2.7
OP
Two, 1.6 0
1.18 N {{120 g
gf}}
RF min.
2.5 2.5
40.05
8.2
5.0
OF max.
2.7
D2MQ
D2MQ
Precautions
Refer to pages 26 to 31 for common precautions.
Cautions
Correct Use
Mounting
Terminal Connections
Make sure that the capacity of the soldering iron is 15 W maximum
(temperature of soldering iron: 250C max.). Do not take more than
3 s to solder the switch terminal.
If soldering is not carried out under the proper conditions there is a
danger of over-heating and subsequent heat damage
Applying a soldering iron for more than 3 s or using one that is rated
at more than 15 W may deteriorate the Switch characteristics.
When soldering the lead wire to the PCB terminal, pay careful attention so that the flux and solder liquid level does not exceed the PCB
level.
Operation
Do not apply a force more than two times the rated operating force to
the actuator and leaf lever.
Provide an amount of OT that equals or exceeds the standard.
Do not change the operating position by modifying the actuator.
Do not use the Switch in an application where the operating speed is
extremely slow or the actuator is set in the midpoint between the
free position and operating position.
Install the pin plunger switch so that the operating force is applied in
alignment with the stroke of the actuator.
Do not apply a shock to the actuator, otherwise, the Switch may be
damaged.
Do not apply excessive force to the actuator of the Leaf Lever
Switch in the operating, releasing, and horizontal directions.
Separator
When mounting the Switch on a metallic surface, be sure to provide
a Separator between the Switch and mounting plate.
The Separator must be made of hard material and must be processed as shown below.
Dimensions of Separator
40.1
1.20.1
2.6
Two 1.6-dia.
mounting holes
0.8
8.2 1.3
t = 0.25
8.5
213
D2VW
WRC
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend
D2VW-jj-jj
1
1.
Ratings
5: 5 A at 250 VAC
01: 0.1 A at 30 VDC
2.
Actuator
None: Pin plunger
L1A:
Short hinge lever
L1:
Hinge lever
L1B:
Long hinge lever
L3:
Simulated roller lever
L2A:
Short hinge roller lever
L2:
Hinge roller lever
3.
Contact Form
1:
SPDT
2:
SPST-NC
3:
SPST-NO
4.
Terminals
None, HS: Solder terminals
(HS for UL and CSA approval.)
M, MS:
Molded lead wires (MS for UL and CSA approval)
List of Models
Actuator
Pin plunger
p g
Short hinge
g lever
Hinge
g Lever
Long
g hinge
g lever
Simulated roller lever
Short hinge
g roller lever
Hinge roller lever
Note:
Model
5A
0.1 A
Solder terminals
D2VW-5-1
D2VW-01-1
D2VW-5-1M
D2VW-01-1M
Solder terminals
D2VW-5L1A-1
D2VW-01L1A-1
D2VW-5L1A-1M
D2VW-01L1A-1M
Solder terminals
D2VW-5L1-1
D2VW-01L1-1
D2VW-5L1-1M
D2VW-01L1-1M
Solder terminals
D2VW-5L1B-1
D2VW-01L1B-1
D2VW-5L1B-1M
D2VW-01L1B-1M
Solder terminals
D2VW-5L3-1
D2VW-01L3-1
D2VW-5L3-1M
D2VW-01L3-1M
Solder terminals
D2VW-5L2A-1
D2VW-01L2A-1
D2VW-5L2A-1M
D2VW-01L2A-1M
Solder terminals
D2VW-5L2-1
D2VW-01L2-1
D2VW-5L2-1M
D2VW-01L2-1M
1. The standard lengths of the molded lead wires (AV0.75f) of models incorporating them are 30 cm.
2. Consult your OMRON sales representative for details on SPST-NO and SPST-NC models.
3. Add HS or MS to the end of the model number for the UL/CSA-approved version (e.g., D2VW-01-1 D2VW-01-1HS).
Consult your OMRON sales representative for details.
214
D2VW
D2VW
Specifications
Ratings
Item
Model
D2VW-5
D2VW-01
Note:
Resisteve load
Rated voltage
250 VAC
5A
125 VAC
5A
30 VDC
5A
125 VAC
0.1 A
30 VDC
0.1 A
Note:
Voltage
NC
Inductive load
Lamp load
NO
NC
Inductive load
NO
NC
125 VAC
5A
0.5 A
4A
250 VAC
5A
0.5 A
4A
30 VDC
5A
3A
4A
125 VDC
0.4 A
0.1 A
0.4 A
NO
1. The above current ratings are the values of the steady-state current.
2. Inductive load has a power factor of 0.7 min. (AC) and a time constant of 7 ms max. (DC).
3. Lamp load has an inrush current of 10 times the steady-state current.
Characteristics
Operating speed
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
Degree of protection
Class I
175
Weight
Note:
215
D2VW
D2VW
Approved Standards
Contact Specifications
Item
Contact
D2VW-5
3A
3A
0.1 A
---
30 VDC
---
0.1 A
Rated voltage
D2VW-5
125 VAC
250 VAC
Crossbar
Material
Silver alloy
Gold alloy
Gap
(standard value)
0.5 mm
NC
15 A max.
---
NO
15 A max.
---
160 mA
at 5 VDC
1 mA
at 5 VDC
Inrush
currentt
--3A
D2VW-01
Rivet
D2VW-01
125 VAC
250 VAC
D2VW-5
Specification
Note:
0.1 A
---
Testing conditions:
25E3 (25,000 operations), T85 (0C to 85C) for D2VW-5,
1E5 (100,000 operations), T85 (0C to 85C) for D2VW-01
Contact Form
SPDT
SPST-NC
NC (red)
NO (blue)
COM (black)
Note:
SPST-NO
NC (red)
NO (blue)
COM (black)
COM (black)
Dimensions
Note:
Terminals
The pin plunger model is shown here as a typical example. Operating characteristics and dimensions of the actuator section are the same as for
the molded lead wire models.
Molded Lead Wires
10.3
4.8
1.2
5.2
8.4
0.5
2.5
5.2
5.2
t=0.5
Three, solder terminals
33
41.4
Mounting Holes
Two, 3.1-dia. mounting holes or
M3 screw holes
10.3 0.1
22.2 0.1
216
33
10.3
30010
22.20.1
2.8
(5)
22.20.1
2.8
D2VW
D2VW
Dimensions and Operating Characteristics
Note:
OF max.
1.96 N {{200 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
1.2 mm
OT min.
1.0 mm
MD max.
0.4 mm
OP
14.70.4 mm
OF max.
1.96 N {{200 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
1.6 mm
OT min.
0.8 mm
MD max.
0.5 mm
OP
15.20.5 mm
OF max.
1.18 N {{120 g
gf}}
D2VW-01L1-1M
D2VW-5L1-1M
RF min.
PT max.
4.0 mm
OT min.
1.6 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
OP
15.21.2 mm
OF max.
0.59 N {{60 g
gf}}
D2VW-01L1B-1M
D2VW-5L1B-1M
RF min.
0.05 N {5 gf}
PT max.
9.0 mm
OT min.
3.2 mm
MD max.
2.0 mm
OP
15.22.6 mm
D2VW-01-1
D2VW-5-1
10.3
4.8
1.2
5.2
20.20.25
A
2.5 dia.
2.8
PT
OP
8.4
+0.13
15.9 10.30.1
2.5
5.2
5.2
3.20.1 dia.
+0.13
3.1 0.03
22.20.1
2.8
t=0.5
Three, solder terminals
33
41.4
4.3
24.30.8
t=0.5* 5
PT
OP
15.9
*Stainless-steel lever
35.60.8
t=0.5*
10.3
4.3
PT
OP 15.9
*Stainless-steel lever
59.40.8
t=0.5*
10.3
4.3
PT
OP
15.9
*Stainless-steel lever
10.3
217
D2VW
D2VW
Simulated Roller Lever Models
D2VW-01L3-1M
D2VW-5L3-1M
A
PT
32.60.8
3.5R
t=0.5*
4.3
OP
15.9
D2VW-01L2A-1M
D2VW-5L2A-1M
4.8 dia.
4.8 **
PT
24.30.8
A
20.10.8
5
t=0.5*
7.2
OP
15.9
*Stainless-steel lever
**Oil-less polyacetal resin roller
340.8
4.8 dia. 4.8 **
PT
7.2
t=0.5*
OP
15.9
*Stainless-steel lever
**Oil-less polyacetal resin roller
218
RF min.
PT max.
4.0 mm
OT min.
1.6 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
OP
18.71.2 mm
OF max.
2.25 N {{230 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
1.6 mm
OT min.
0.8 mm
MD max.
0.5 mm
OP
20.70.6 mm
OF max.
1.18 N {{120 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
4.0 mm
OT min.
1.6 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
OP
20.71.2 mm
10.3
1.18 N {{120 g
gf}}
10.3
*Stainless-steel lever
OF max.
10.3
D2VW
D2VW
Precautions
Refer to pages 26 to 31 for common precautions.
Cautions
Correct Use
Mounting
Degree of Protection
Do not use the Switch underwater. The Switch was tested and found
to meet the conditions necessary to meet the following standard.
The test checks for water intrusion after immersion for a specified
time period. The test does not check for switching operation underwater.
IEC Publication 529, degree of protection IP67.
Operating Body
With the pin plunger models, set the Switch so that the plunger can
be pushed in from directly above. Since the plunger is covered with
a rubber cap, applying a force from lateral directions may cause
damage to the plunger or reduction in the sealing capability.
Prevent the Switch from coming into contact with oil and chemicals.
Otherwise, damage to or deterioration of Switch materials may result.
Correct
Incorrect
Incorrect
Handling
Handle the Switch carefully so as not to break the sealing rubber of
the plunger.
Voltage (V)
Operating range
for micro load
models D2VW-01
Operating
range for
general-load
models
D2VW-05
Inoperable
range
Current (mA)
219
D2SW
RC W
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend
D2SW-jjjj
1
1.
Ratings
3:
3 A at 125 VAC
01: 0.1 A at 30 VDC
2.
Actuator
None: Pin plunger
L1:
Hinge lever
L2:
Hinge roller lever
L3:
Simulated roller lever
3.
Contact Form
None: SPDT
-2:
SPST-NC (Molded lead wire models only)
-3:
SPST-NO (Molded lead wire models only)
4.
Terminals
H, HS: Solder terminals (HS for UL and CSA approval)
D, DS: PCB terminals (DS for UL and CSA approval)
T, TS: Quick-connect terminals (#110) (TS for UL and CSA approval)
M, MS: Molded lead wires (MS for UL and CSA approval)
List of Models
Actuator
Model
3A
Pin plunger
p g
Hinge
g lever
Hinge
g roller lever
Note:
220
0.1A
Solder terminals
D2SW-3H
D2SW-01H
D2SW-3T
D2SW-01T
PCB terminals
D2SW-3D
D2SW-01D
D2SW-3M
D2SW-01M
Solder terminals
D2SW-3L1H
D2SW-01L1H
D2SW-3L1T
D2SW-01L1T
PCB terminals
D2SW-3L1D
D2SW-01L1D
D2SW-3L1M
D2SW-01L1M
Solder terminals
D2SW-3L3H
D2SW-01L3H
D2SW-3L3T
D2SW-01L3T
PCB terminals
D2SW-3L3D
D2SW-01L3D
D2SW-3L3M
D2SW-01L3M
Solder terminals
D2SW-3L2H
D2SW-01L2H
D2SW-3L2T
D2SW-01L2T
PCB terminals
D2SW-3L2D
D2SW-01L2D
D2SW
D2SW
Specifications
Ratings
Item
Model
D2SW-3
D2SW-01
Note:
Resistive load
Rated voltage
250 VAC
2A
125 VAC
3A
30 VDC
3A
125 VAC
0.1 A
30 VDC
0.1 A
Voltage
Non-inductive load
Resistive load
NC
D2SW-3
Note:
Inductive load
Lamp load
NO
NC
Inductive load
NO
NC
Motor load
NO
NC
NO
125 VAC
3A
1A
0.5 A
1A
0.5 A
1A
0.5 A
250 VAC
2A
0.5 A
0.3 A
0.5 A
0.3 A
0.5 A
0.3 A
30 VDC
3A
1A
1A
1A
1. The above current ratings are the values of the steady-state current.
2. Inductive load has a power factor of 0.7 min. (AC) and a time constant of 7 ms max. (DC).
3. Lamp load has an inrush current of 10 times the steady-state current.
4. Motor load has an inrush current of 6 times the steady-state current.
221
D2SW
D2SW
Characteristics
Item
D2SW-3
D2SW-01
Operating speed
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
Contact resistance
(i iti l value)
l )
(initial
Dielectric strength
(see note 2)
Vibration resistance
(see note 3)
Shock resistance
(see note 3)
Durability
y
(
(see
note
t 4)
Degree of protection
Degree of protection
against electric shock
Class 1
175
Ambient operating
temperature
Ambient operating
humidity
Weight
Note:
222
D2SW
D2SW
Approved Standards
Contact Form
SPDT
D2SW-3
D2SW-01
125 VAC
250 VAC
3A
2A
0.1 A
---
30 VDC
3A
0.1 A
COM NO
NC
(Black*) (Blue*) (Red*)
SPST-NC
D2SW-01
0.1 A
Contact Specifications
Item
Contact
Inrush
currentt
D2SW-3
Specification
Rivet
Crossbar
Material
Silver
Gold alloy
Gap
(standard
value)
0.5 mm
NC
20 A max.
1 A max.
NO
10 A max.
1 A max.
160 mA
at 5 VDC
1 mA
at 5 VDC
D2SW-01
COM
(Black)
NC
(Red)
SPST-NO
COM
(Black)
NO
(Blue)
Thickness (mm)
Model
0.18
0.4
Separator
Note:
223
D2SW
D2SW
Dimensions
Terminals
Note:
3.30.1
3.30.1
3.30.1
2.9
7.3
1.8
10.1
1.6
8.50.2
5.15 9.50.1
0.8R
1.6
3.2
0.5
8.70.2
5.15 9.50.1
6.40.2
7.2
3.9
0.8
1.2
8.80.2
5.15 9.50.1
0.5
6.40.2
15.50.2
19.80.2
2.15
15.50.2
18.70.2
0.55
Three,
1.2 dia.
holes
Three,
2.8
6.6
1.80.1
2.9
2.9
1.85
0.7
0.5
1.3
6.40.2
16.10.2
19.80.2
19.80.2
PCB Mounting
Three, 1.35-dia. to 1.5 holes
16.4 16.9
8.80.2
9.2
16.10.2
30010
Common terminal (black) (see note)
Vinyl insulator
(5)
9.50.1
0.7
5.15
Normally
closed terminal
6.40.2
(red)*
21.2
Mounting Holes
Two, 2.4-dia. mounting hole or M2.3 screw hole
9.5
D2SW-3j
D2SW-01j
1.8 dia.
2.35 +0.1
0.05 dia.
holes
PT
2.35 +0.1
0.05
3.30.1
10.1
7.7 OP
2.9
7.3
1.8
1.6
2.5 dia.0.07
8.50.2
5.15 9.50.1
0.55
224
15.50.2
18.70.2
19.80.2
0.8R
1.6
3.2
0.5
6.40.2
OF
1.77 N {{180 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
0.6 mm
OT min.
0.5 mm
MD max.
0.1 mm
OP
8.40.3 mm
D2SW
D2SW
Hinge Lever Models
OF
0.59 N {{60 g
gf}}
D2SW-3L1j
D2SW-01L1j
RF min.
0.06 N {6 gf}
OT min.
1.0 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
FP max.
13.6 mm
OP
8.80.8 mm
OF
0.59 N {{60 g
gf}}
D2SW-3L3j
D2SW-01L3j
5.9
RF min.
0.06 N {6 gf}
3.6
OT min.
1.0 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
FP max.
15.5 mm
OP
10.70.8 mm
OF
0.59 N {{60 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.06 N {6 gf}
OT min.
1.0 mm
MD max.
0.8 mm
FP max.
19.3 mm
OP
14.50.8 mm
5.9
3.6
A
14.5
OP
FP
A
t = 0.3 Stainless-steel lever
15.8
1.3R
OP
FP
5.9
14.5
t = 0.3 Stainless-steel lever
OP FP
225
D2SW
D2SW
Precautions
Refer to pages 26 to 31 for common precautions.
Cautions
Correct Use
Mounting
Degree of Protection
Do not use the Switch underwater. The Switch was tested and found
to meet the conditions necessary to meet the following standard.
The test checks for water intrusion after immersion for a specified
time period. The test does not check for switching operation underwater.
IEC Publication 529, degree of protection IP67.
Operating Body
With the pin plunger models, set the Switch so that the plunger can
be pushed in from directly above. Since the plunger is covered with
a rubber cap, applying a force from lateral directions may cause
damage to the plunger or reduction in the sealing capability.
Prevent the Switch from coming into contact with oil and chemicals.
Otherwise, damage to or deterioration of Switch materials may result.
Correct
Incorrect
Incorrect
Handling
Handle the Switch carefully so as not to break the sealing rubber of
the plunger.
Voltage (V)
Operating range
for micro load
models D2SW-01
Operating
range for
general-load
models
D2SW-3
Inoperable
range
Current (mA)
226
D2SW-P
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend
D2SW-P @@@@
1 2 3 4
1. Ratings
2:
01:
2A at 250 VAC
0.1A at 30 VDC
2. Actuator
None:
L1:
L2:
L3:
Pin plunger
Hinge lever
Hinge roller lever
Simulated roller lever
3. Contact Form
None: SPDT
-2:
SPST-NC (Molded lead wire models only)
-3:
SPST-NO (Molded lead wire models only)
4. Terminals
H:
T:
D:
B:
M:
Solder terminals
Quick-connect terminals (#110)
PCB terminals (Uneven pitch)
PCB terminals (Even pitch)
Molded lead wires
227
D2SW-P
D2SW-P
List of Models
Terminal
Rating
2A
0.1A
Note
Actuator
Solder
terminals
Quick-connect
terminals (#110)
PCB terminals
Uneven pitch
Even pitch
Pin plunger
D2SW-P2H
D2SW-P2T
D2SW-P2D
P2SW-P2B
D2SW-P2M
Hinge lever
D2SW-P2L1H
D2SW-P2L1T
D2SW-P2L1D
D2SW-P2L1B
D2SW-P2L1M
D2SW-P2L2H
D2SW-P2L2T
D2SW-P2L2D
D2SW-P2L2B
D2SW-P2L2M
D2SW-P2L3H
D2SW-P2L3T
D2SW-P2L3D
D2SW-P2L3B
D2SW-P2L3M
Pin plunger
D2SW-P01H
D2SW-P01T
D2SW-P01D
D2SW-P01B
D2SW-P01M
Hinge lever
D2SW-P01L1H
D2SW-P01L1T
D2SW-P01L1D
D2SW-P01L1B
D2SW-P01L1M
D2SW-P01L2H
D2SW-P01L2T
D2SW-P01L2D
D2SW-P01L2B
D2SW-P01L2M
D2SW-P01L3H
D2SW-P01L3T
D2SW-P01L3D
D2SW-P01L3B
D2SW-P01L3M
Consult your OMRON sales representative for details on SPST-NO and SPST-NC models.
Specifications
Ratings
Model
D2SW-P2
Rated voltage
30 VDC
Resistive load
2A
250 VAC
D2SW-P01
30 VDC
0.1 A
125 VAC
Note
Characteristics
Item
Model
D2SW-P2
D2SW-P01
Operating speed
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
1,500 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between current-carrying metal parts and ground, and between each
terminal and non-current-carrying metal parts
Vibration resistance (see note 3)
Degree of protection
Class 1
175
Weight
Note:
228
D2SW-P
D2SW-P
Approved Standards
Contact
SPDT
Form
COM NO NC
(Black) (Blue) (Red)
D2SW-P2
D2SW-P01
125 VAC
250 VAC
--2A
0.1 A
---
30 VDC
2A
0.1 A
COM
(Black)
Model
Contact
D2SW-P2
Note
D2SW-P01
Specification
Rivet
Crossbar
Material
Silver alloy
Gold alloy
Gap
(Standard value)
0.5 mm
NC
(Red)
SPST-NO
(Molded lead wire models only)
Contact Specifications
Item
SPST-NC
(Molded lead wire models only)
160 mA at 5
VDC
COM NO
(Black) (Blue)
Note
1 mA at 5 VDC
For more information on the minimum applicable load, refer to Using Micro Loads on page 232.
Dimensions
Terminals
Note: 1. All units are in millimeters unless otherwise indicated.
2. Terminal plate thickness is 0.5 mm for all models.
Solder Terminals
C
NC
NC
3.30.1
7.3
3.2
2.15
3.30.1
11
8.55
7.1
0.5
15.5
5.15 9.50.1
19.80.2
3.9
3.9
3-1.2
3-0.8
16.10.2
0.5
3-1.2
3-0.8
1.3
6.40.2
5.15 9.50.1
19.80.2
1.8
3.30.1
1.8
3.30.1
8.80.2
6.40.2
7.60.2 7.60.2
5.15 9.50.1
19.80.2
1.85
0.5
3-2.8
6.40.2
1.3
5.15 9.50.1
7.620.2 7.620.2
19.80.2
0.5
6.40.2
229
D2SW-P
D2SW-P
9.2
6.40.2
30010
Normally closed
terminal (red)
(5)
Normally open
terminal (blue)
0.7
5.15 9.50.1
21.2
Mounting Holes
Two, M2.3 screw hole
9.50.1
Note:
7.550.2
A
PT
Model
1.8 dia.
2.50.07 dia.
2.35 +0.075
0.05 dia.
OP
6.9 7.7
3.30.1
2.35+0.075
0.05
7.3
3.2
2.15
8.55
15.5
0.5
D2SW-P2@@
OF max.
RF min.
PT max.
OT min.
MD max.
0.6 mm
0.4 mm
0.15 mm
OP
8.40.3 mm
D2SW-P01@@
6.40.2
5.15 9.50.1
19.80.2
A
t=0.3 Stainless-steel lever
14.50.6
2.50.07 dia.
Model
2.35 +0.075
0.05 dia.
OP FP
6.9 7.7
2.35 +0.075
0.05
3.30.1
7.3
3.2
2.15
230
8.55
15.5
5.15 9.50.1
19.80.2
0.5
6.40.2
D2SW-P2L1@@
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
0.8 mm
0.8 mm
FP max.
OP
13.6 mm
8.80.8 mm
D2SW-P01L1@@
D2SW-P
D2SW-P
D2SW-P2L2@@
D2SW-P01L2@@
t=0.3 Stainless-steel lever
14.50.6
2.50.07 dia.
2.35 +0.075
dia. FP
-0.05
OP
6.9 7.7
2.35 +0.075
-0.05
3.30.1
7.3
3.2
2.15
8.55
15.5
5.15 9.50.1
19.80.2
Model
D2SW-P2L2@@
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
0.8 mm
0.8 mm
FP max.
OP
19.3 mm
14.50.8 mm
D2SW-P01L2@@
0.5
6.40.2
A
t=0.3 Stainless-steel lever
15.80.6
Model
R1.3
2.35 +0.075
0.05 dia.
2.50.07 dia.
6.9 7.7
2.35 +0.075
0.05
OP FP
3.30.1
7.3
3.2
2.15
8.55
15.5
5.15 9.50.1
19.80.2
D2SW-P2L3@@
OF max.
RF min.
OT min.
MD max.
0.8 mm
0.8 mm
FP max.
OP
15.5 mm
10.70.8 mm
D2SW-P01L3@@
0.5
6.40.2
Precautions
Cautions
Degree of Protection
Do not use this product in water. Although this models satisfy the
test conditions for the standard given below, this test is to check
the ingress of water into the switch enclosure after submerging
the Switch in water for a given time. Satisfying this test condition
does not mean that the Switch can be used in water.
IEC 60529: 2001 Degrees of protection provided by enclosures
(IP Code)
Code: IP67 (The test to meet the standard checks for water intrusion after immersion for 30 minutes.)
Do not operate the Switch when it is exposed to water spray, or
when water drops adhere to the Switch surface, or during sudden
temperature changes, otherwise water may intrude into the interior of the Switch due to a suction effect.
Prevent the Switch from coming into contact with oil and chemicals. Otherwise, damage to or deterioration of Switch materials
may result.
Do not use the Switch in areas where it is exposed to silicon
adhesives, oil, or grease, otherwise faulty contact may result due
to the generation of silicon oxide.
The environment-resistant performance of the switch differs
depending on operating loads, ambient atmospheres, and installation conditions, etc. Please perform an operating test of the
switch in advance under actual usage conditions.
Connecting to Terminals
Make sure that the temperature at the tip of the soldering iron is
350 to 400C. Do not take more than 3 seconds to solder the
switch terminal, and do not impose external force on the terminal
for 1 min after soldering. Improper soldering involving an excessively high temperature or excessive soldering time may deteriorate the characteristics of the Switch.
Connecting to Quick-connect Terminals
Wire the quick-connect terminals (#110) with receptacles. Insert
the terminals straight into the receptacles. Do not impose excessive force on the terminal in the horizontal direction, otherwise the
terminal may be deformed or the housing may be damaged.
Connecting to PCB Terminal Boards
When using automatic soldering baths, we recommend soldering
at 2605C within 5 seconds. Make sure that the liquid surface of
the solder does not flow over the edge of the board.
When soldering by hand, as a guideline, solder with a soldering
iron with a tip temperature of 350 to 400C within 3 seconds, and
do not apply any external force for at least 1 minutes after soldering. When applying solder, keep the solder away from the case of
the Switch and do not allow solder or flux to enter the case.
231
D2SW-P
Correct Use
Mounting
Turn OFF the power supply before mounting or removing the
Switch, wiring, or performing maintenance or inspection. Failure
to do so may result in electric shock or burning.
Use M2.3 mounting screws with plane washers or spring washers
to securely mount the Switch. Tighten the screws to a torque of
0.23 to 0.26 Nm {2.3 to 2.7 kgfcm}. Exceeding the specified
torgue may result in deterioration of the sealing or damage.
Mount the Switch onto a flat surface. Mounting on an uneven surface may cause deformation of the Switch, resulting in faulty operation or damage.
D2SW-P
30
0.16mA
26mA
24
Operating Body
Use an operating body with low frictional resistance and of a
shape that will not interfere with the sealing rubber, otherwise the
plunger may be damaged or the sealing may deteriorate.
With the pin plunger models, set the Switch so that the plunger
can be pushed in from directly above. Since the plunger is covered with a rubber cap, applying a force from lateral directions
may cause damage to the plunger or reduction in the sealing
capability.
100mA
Operating
range for
general-load
models
D2SW-P2
12
Inoperable
range
1mA
100mA 160mA
0
0.1
10
100
1,000
Current (mA)
Correct
Incorrect
Incorrect
Handling
Do not handle the Switch in a way that may cause damage to the
sealing rubber.
When handling the Switch, ensure that uneven pressure or, as
shown in the following diagram, pressure in a direction other than
the operating direction is not applied to the Actuator, otherwise
the Actuator or Switch may be damaged, or durability may be
decreased.
232
D2HW
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend:
D2HW-@@@@@
1 2 3 4 5
1. Mounting Structure
A:
BR:
BL:
C:
2. Ratings
2:
1 mA at 5 VDC to 2 A at 12 VDC
3. Actuator
0:
1:
2:
3:
4:
6:
7:
8:
Pin plunger
Hinge lever
Long hinge lever
Simulated roller hinge lever
Hinge roller lever
Leaf lever
Simulated roller leaf lever
Long leaf lever
4. Contacts
1:
2:
3:
SPDT
SPST-NC (Molded lead wire models only.)
SPST-NO (Molded lead wire models only.)
5. Terminals
D: Straight PCB terminals
DR: Right-angled PCB terminals
DL: Left-angled PCB terminals
H: Solder terminals
M: Molded lead wires downwards
MR: Molded lead wires on right-side
ML: Molded lead wires on left-side
Note Add S to the end of the model number for the UL/CSAapproved version.
233
D2HW
D2HW
List of Models
PCB-mounted Models
Actuator
Terminals
Contact form
Model
---
---
D2HW-A201D
D2HW-BR201DR
D2HW-BL201DL
---
Straight
---
---
D2HW-A211D
Angled
D2HW-BR211DR
D2HWBL211DL
---
Long hinge
lever
Straight
---
---
D2HW-A221D
Angled
D2HW-BR221DR
D2HW-BL221DL
---
Simulated roller
hinge lever
Straight
---
---
D2HW-A231D
Angled
D2HW-BR231DR
D2HW-BL231DL
---
Hinge lever
Note
Straight
SPDT
Without posts
Angled
Pin plunger
For PCB
Add S to the end of the model number for the UL/CSA-approved version. Consult your OMRON sales epresentative for details.
Terminals
Contact form
Model
With posts on
right
Pin plunger
Solder
Molded lead
wires
Hinge lever
Long hinge
lever
Note:
234
SPDT
D2HW-BR201H
D2HW-BL201H
D2HW-C201H
SPDT
D2HW-BR201M
D2HW-BL201M
D2HW-C201M
SPST-NC
D2HW-BR202M
D2HW-BL202M
D2HW-C202M
SPST-NO
D2HW-BR203M
D2HW-BL203M
D2HW-C203M
Right-side
SPST-NC
D2HW-BR202MR
D2HW-BL202MR
D2HW-C202MR
SPST-NO
D2HW-BR203MR
D2HW-BL203MR
D2HW-C203MR
Left-side
SPST-NC
D2HW-BR202ML
D2HW-BL202ML
---
SPST-NO
D2HW-BR203ML
D2HW-BL203ML
---
SPDT
D2HW-BR211H
D2HW-BL211H
D2HW-C211H
SPDT
D2HW-BR211M
D2HW-BL211M
D2HW-C211M
SPST-NC
D2HW-BR212M
D2HW-BL212M
D2HW-C212M
SPST-NO
D2HW-BR213M
D2HW-BL213M
D2HW-C213M
Right-side
SPST-NC
D2HW-BR212MR
D2HW-BL212MR
D2HW-C212MR
SPST-NO
D2HW-BR213MR
D2HW-BL213MR
D2HW-C213MR
Left-side
SPST-NC
D2HW-BR212ML
D2HW-BL212ML
---
SPST-NO
D2HW-BR213ML
D2HW-BL213ML
---
SPDT
D2HW-BR221H
D2HW-BL221H
D2HW-C221H
SPDT
D2HW-BR221M
D2HW-BL221M
D2HW-C221M
SPST-NC
D2HW-BR222M
D2HW-BL222M
D2HW-C222M
SPST-NO
D2HW-BR223M
D2HW-BL223M
D2HW-C223M
Right-side
SPST-NC
D2HW-BR222MR
D2HW-BL222MR
D2HW-C222MR
SPST-NO
D2HW-BR223MR
D2HW-BL223MR
D2HW-C223MR
Left-side
SPST-NC
D2HW-BR222ML
D2HW-BL222ML
---
SPST-NO
D2HW-BR223ML
D2HW-BL223ML
---
Downwards
Solder
Molded lead
wires
Downwards
Solder
Molded lead
wires
M3-screw
mounting
With posts on
left
Downwards
1. The length of standard lead wires (AVSS0.5) for molded lead wire models is 30 cm.
2. Add S to the end of the model number for the UL/CSA-approved version. Consult your OMRON sales representative for details.
D2HW
D2HW
Actuator
Terminals
Contact form
Model
With posts on
right
Simulated roller
hinge lever
Hinge roller
lever
Leaf lever
Solder
Molded lead
wires
Simulated roller
leaf lever
SPDT
D2HW-BR231H
D2HW-BL231H
D2HW-C231H
D2HW-BR231M
D2HW-BL231M
D2HW-C231M
SPST-NC
D2HW-BR232M
D2HW-BL232M
D2HW-C232M
SPST-NO
D2HW-BR233M
D2HW-BL233M
D2HW-C233M
Right-side
SPST-NC
D2HW-BR232MR
D2HW-BL232MR
D2HW-C232MR
SPST-NO
D2HW-BR233MR
D2HW-BL233MR
D2HW-C233MR
Left-side
SPST-NC
D2HW-BR232ML
D2HW-BL232ML
---
SPST-NO
D2HW-BR233ML
D2HW-BL233ML
---
SPDT
D2HW-BR241H
D2HW-BL241H
D2HW-C241H
SPDT
D2HW-BR241M
D2HW-BL241M
D2HW-C241M
SPST-NC
D2HW-BR242M
D2HW-BL242M
D2HW-C242M
SPST-NO
D2HW-BR243M
D2HW-BL243M
D2HW-C243M
Right-side
SPST-NC
D2HW-BR242MR
D2HW-BL242MR
D2HW-C242MR
SPST-NO
D2HW-BR243MR
D2HW-BL243MR
D2HW-C243MR
Left-side
SPST-NC
D2HW-BR242ML
D2HW-BL242ML
---
SPST-NO
D2HW-BR243ML
D2HW-BL243ML
---
SPDT
D2HW-BR261H
D2HW-BL261H
D2HW-C261H
SPDT
D2HW-BR261M
D2HW-BL261M
D2HW-C261M
SPST-NC
D2HW-BR262M
D2HW-BL262M
D2HW-C262M
SPST-NO
D2HW-BR263M
D2HW-BL263M
D2HW-C263M
Right-side
SPST-NC
D2HW-BR262MR
D2HW-BL262MR
D2HW-C262MR
SPST-NO
D2HW-BR263MR
D2HW-BL263MR
D2HW-C263MR
Left-side
SPST-NC
D2HW-BR262ML
D2HW-BL262ML
---
SPST-NO
D2HW-BR263ML
D2HW-BL263ML
---
SPDT
D2HW-BR271H
D2HW-BL271H
D2HW-C271H
SPDT
D2HW-BR271M
D2HW-BL271M
D2HW-C271M
SPST-NC
D2HW-BR272M
D2HW-BL272M
D2HW-C272M
SPST-NO
D2HW-BR273M
D2HW-BL273M
D2HW-C273M
Right-side
SPST-NC
D2HW-BR272MR
D2HW-BL272MR
D2HW-C272MR
SPST-NO
D2HW-BR273MR
D2HW-BL273MR
D2HW-C273MR
Left-side
SPST-NC
D2HW-BR272ML
D2HW-BL272ML
---
SPST-NO
D2HW-BR273ML
D2HW-BL273ML
---
Downwards
SPDT
D2HW-BR281M
D2HW-BL281M
D2HW-C281M
SPST-NC
D2HW-BR282M
D2HW-BL282M
D2HW-C282M
SPST-NO
D2HW-BR283M
D2HW-BL283M
D2HW-C283M
SPST-NC
---
---
D2HW-C282MR
SPST-NO
---
---
D2HW-C283MR
Downwards
Solder
Molded lead
wires
Downwards
Solder
Molded lead
wires
Molded lead
wires
Downwards
Rightside
Note:
M3-screw
mounting
SPDT
Downwards
Solder
Molded lead
wires
With posts on
left
1. The length of standard lead wires (AVSS 0.5) for molded lead wire models is 30 cm.
2. Add S to the end of the model number for the UL/CSA-approved version. Consult your OMRON sales representative for details.
Specifications
Ratings
Note
Resistive load
125 VAC
0.1 A
12 VDC
24 VDC
42 VDC
2A
1A
0.5 A
235
D2HW
D2HW
Characteristics
Item
Specification
Operating speed
Operating frequency
30 operations/min max.
Insulation resistance
Contact resistance
(initial value)
Dielectric strength
600 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between terminals of the same polarity
1,500 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between current-carrying metal parts and ground, and between
each terminal and non-current-carrying metal parts
Degree of protection
175
Weight
Note:
Approved Standards
Contact Specifications
D2HW
125 VAC
0.1 A
12 VDC
2A
Item
Specification
Specification
Crossbar
Material
Gold alloy
0.5 mm
1 mA at 5 VDC
Note
Minimum applicable loads are indicated by N standard reference values. This value represents the failure rate at a
60% (60) reliability level.
The equation 60=035106/operations indicates that a
failure rate of 1/2,000,000 operations can be expected at
a reliability level of 60%.
Contact Form
SPDT
SPST-NC
(Molded Lead Wire Models Only)
COM
NO
NC
(Black) (Blue) (Red)
Note
236
COM
(Black)
NC
(Red)
SPST-NO
(Molded Lead Wire Models Only)
COM
NO
(Black) (Blue)
D2HW
D2HW
Dimensions
D2HW-A@
D2HW-B@
D2HW-C@
1.7 dia.
1.7 dia.
0
3 0.1
dia.
Reference
position
Reference
position
Reference
position
3.30.15 dia.
3 +0.1
0 dia. hole
(depth: 1.5 mm min.)
2.6
M3 tap
Terminals
Straight PCB Terminals
Solder Terminals
3.5
Three-0.6
Three-0.6
Three-2
(3.1)
2.6
Three, 1+0.1
dia. hole
0
(12)
(12)
(13.3)
(12)
(13.3)
237
D2HW
D2HW
Note:
Characteristic
D2HW-@20@@
A
1.7 dia.
t = 0.3 stainless
steel lever
OT ref.
MD max.
FP max.
OP
TTP max.
11.2 mm
10.40.2 mm
9.1 mm
15
t = 0.3 stainless
steel lever
Models without
posts
7.2 mm
6.40.2 mm
5.1 mm
OF max.
RF min.
OT ref.
MD max.
FP max.
OP
TTP max.
12.8 mm
11.50.5 mm
10 mm
Models without
posts
8.8 mm
7.50.5 mm
6 mm
OF max.
RF min.
OT ref.
MD max.
FP max.
OP
TTP max.
15.5 mm
13.30.8 mm
11 mm
Characteristic
D2HW-@23@@
238
Characteristic
D2HW-@22@@
OF max.
RF min.
Characteristic
D2HW-@21@@
Models without
posts
Models without
posts
11.5 mm
9.30.8 mm
7 mm
OF max.
RF min.
OT ref.
MD max.
FP max.
OP
TTP max.
16.5 mm
15.20.5 mm
13.5 mm
12.5 mm
11.20.5 mm
9.5 mm
D2HW
D2HW
Characteristic
D2HW-@24@@
4.8 dia. 2.8
resin roller
80.1
(4.6)
15
FP OP
t=0.3 stainless
steel lever
(1.15)
TTP
3
(0.4)
OF max.
RF min.
OT ref.
MD max.
FP max.
OP
TTP max.
15.3 mm
140.6 mm
12.3 mm
6.5
Characteristic
D2HW-@26@@
A
t = 0.3 stainless
steel lever
OF max.
RF min.
OT ref.
MD max.
FP max.
OP
TTP max.
9.3 mm
7.40.5 mm
5.8 mm
Characteristic
D2HW-@27@@
A
t = 0.3 stainless
steel lever
OT ref.
MD max.
FP max.
OP
TTP max.
12.5 mm
10.80.5 mm
8.9 mm
Characteristic
20.851
t = 0.2 stainless
steel lever
3.30.15 dia.
(12)
OF max.
RF min.
D2HW-@28@@
A
OF max.
RF min.
OT ref.
MD max.
FP max.
OP
TTP max.
19 mm
15.41.5 mm
12.8 mm
3 -0.1 dia.
COM AVSS 0.5
(Black)
NO AVSS 0.5 (Blue)
NC AVSS 0.5 (Red)
(13.3)
239
D2HW
D2HW
Precautions
Cautions
Degree of Protection
Do not use this product in water. Although molded lead wire models satisfy the test conditions for the standard given below, this
test is to check the ingress of water into the switch enclosure after
submerging the Switch in water for a given time. Satisfying this
test condition does not mean that the Switch can be used in
water.
IEC Publication 529, degree of protection IP67.
Do not operate the Switch when it is exposed to water spray, or
when water drops adhere to the Switch surface, or during sudden
temperature changes, otherwise water may intrude into the interior of the Switch due to a suction effect.
Prevent the Switch from coming into contact with oil and chemicals. Otherwise, damage to or deterioration of Switch materials
may result.
Do not use the Switch in areas where it is exposed to silicon
adhesives, oil, or grease, otherwise faulty contact may result due
to the generation of silicon oxide.
Correct Use
Mounting
Turn OFF the power supply before mounting or removing the
Switch, wiring, or performing maintenance or inspection. Failure
to do so may result in electric shock or burning.
For M3-screw mounting models, use M3 mounting screws with
plane washers or spring washers to securely mount the Switch.
Tighten the screws to a torque of 0.27 to 0.29 Nm. Exceeding the
specified torque may result in deterioration of the sealing or damage.
For models with posts, secure the posts by thermal caulking or by
pressing into an attached device. When pressed into an attached
device, provide guides on the opposite ends of the posts to
ensure that they do not fall out or rattle.
Mount the Switch onto a flat surface. Mounting on an uneven surface may cause deformation of the Switch, resulting in faulty operation or damage.
Terminal Connection
Operating Body
When soldering the lead wire to the terminal, first insert the lead
wire conductor through the terminal hole and then conduct soldering.
Made sure that the capacity of the soldering iron is 30 W maximum. Do not take more than 3 s to solder the switch terminal.
Improper soldering involving an excessively high temperature or
excessive soldering time may deteriorate the characteristics of
the Switch.
When soldering the lead wire to the PCB terminal, pay careful
attention so that the flux and solder liquid level does not exceed
the PCB level.
Handling
Do not handle the Switch in a way that may cause damage to the
sealing rubber.
When handling the Switch, ensure that pressure is not applied to
the posts in the directions shown in the following diagram. Also,
ensure that uneven pressure or pressure in a direction other than
the operating direction is not applied to the Actuator as shown in
the following diagram. Otherwise, the post, Actuator, or Switch
may be damaged, or the service life may be reduced.
240
D2JW
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend
D2JW-01j-j-j
1
1.
Ratings
01:
0.1 A at 30 VDC
2.
Actuator
None: Pin plunger
K1A: Short hinge lever
K1:
Hinge lever
K3:
Simulated roller lever
K2:
Hinge roller lever
3.
Contact Form
1:
SPDT
2:
SPST-NC
3:
SPST-NO
4.
Terminals
None: Solder terminals
MD: Molded lead wires
List of Models
Actuator
Model
Solder terminals
Pin plunger
D2JW-011
D2JW-011-MD
D2JW-01K1A1
D2JW-01K1A1-MD
Hinge lever
D2JW-01K11
D2JW-01K11-MD
D2JW-01K31
D2JW-01K31-MD
D2JW-01K21
D2JW-01K21-MD
Note:
1. The standard lengths of the lead wires (AVS0.3f) of models incorporating them are 30 cm.
2. Consult your OMRON sales representative for details on SPST-NO and SPST-NC models.
241
D2JW
D2JW
Specifications
Ratings
Electrical ratings
Characteristics
Operating speed (see note 2)
1 mm to 250 mm/s
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
Contact resistance
(initial value)
600 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between terminals of the same polarity
1,000 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between current-carrying metal parts and ground, and between
each terminal and non-current-carrying metal parts
Degree of protection
Class I
175
40C to 85C (at ambient humidity of 60% max.) (with no icing or condensation)
Weight
Note:
Contact Specifications
Contact
Inrush current
Specification
Crossbar
Material
Gold alloy
Gap (standard
value)
0.5 mm
NC
0.1 A max.
NO
0.1 A max.
1 mA at 5 VDC
Contact Form
SPDT
COM NO
NC
(Black*) (Blue*) (Red*)
COM
(Black)
242
SPST-NO
SPST-NC
NC
(Red)
COM
(Black)
NO
(Blue)
D2JW
D2JW
Dimensions
Note:
Terminals
Solder Terminals
NC (red)
NO (blue)
COM
(black)
Mounting Holes
M2.3 mounting holes
4.8 0.1
1.6 dia.
A
PT
D2JW-011
OP
+0.05
2.35 0.025 dia.
OF max.
2.45 N {{250 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
0.6 mm
OT min.
0.3 mm
MD max.
0.1 mm
OP
8.10.3 mm
OF max.
1.15 N {117
{
gf}
g}
RF min.
PT max.
5.4 mm
OT min.
0.7 mm
MD max.
0.5 mm
OP
8.40.8 mm
+0.05
PT
11.5R
A 0.3 t stainless-steel
spring lever
OP
+0.05
2.35 +0.05
0.025 dia.
243
D2JW
D2JW
Hinge Lever Models
OF max.
0.80 N {{82 g
gf}}
RF min.
PT max.
6.4 mm
OT min.
1.4 mm
MD max.
0.7 mm
OP
8.40.8 mm
OF max.
0.95 N {{97 g
gf}}
D2JW-01K31
RF min.
PT max.
5.5 mm
OT min.
1.1 mm
MD max.
0.6 mm
OP
10.30.8 mm
OF max.
0.98 N {{100 g
gf}}
D2JW-01K21
RF min.
PT max.
5.2 mm
OT min.
1.1 mm
MD max.
0.5 mm
OP
14.60.8 mm
D2JW-01K11
PT
A 0.3 t stainless-steel
spring lever
16.5R
OP
+0.05
+0.05
12.7
PT
0.3 t stainless-steel
spring lever
A
1.3R
OP
+0.05
PT
A
13.5R
OP
+0.05
244
2.35 +0.05
0.025 dia.
D2JW
D2JW
Precautions
Refer to pages 26 to 31 for common precautions.
Cautions
Terminal Connection
When soldering, make sure that the capacity of the soldering iron is
30 W maximum (temperature of soldering iron: 250C max.). Do not
take more than 3 s to solder the switch terminal.
If soldering is not carried out under the proper conditions there is a
danger of over-heating and subsequent heat damage.
Applying a soldering iron for more than 3 s or using one that is rated
at more than 30 W may deteriorate the Switch characteristics.
Correct Use
Use M2.3 mounting screws with plane washers or spring washers to
securely mount the Switch. Tighten the screws to a torque of 0.20 to
0.29 Nm {2 to 3 kgfcm}.
Separator
When mounting the Switch on a metallic surface, be sure to provide
a Separator between the Switch and the mounting plate.
Degree of Protection
Do not use the Switch underwater. The Switch was tested and found
to meet the conditions necessary to meet the following standard.
The test checks for water intrusion after immersion for a specified
time period. The test does not check for switching operation underwater.
IEC Publication 529, degree of protection IP67.
t=0.18
245
D2FW-G
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend
D2FW-GjjjM
1
1.
Ratings/Contact Specifications
2: For general load
0: For micro load
2.
Actuator
7
Leaf lever
8: Long leaf lever
3.
Contact Form
1: SPDT
2: SPST-NC
3: SPST-NO
List of Models
Actuator
Leaf lever
Rated load
1A
0.1 A
Long
g leaf lever
1A
0.1 A
Note:
246
Contact specifications
(molded lead wires)
Model
SPDT
D2FW-G271M
SPST-NC
D2FW-G272M
SPST-NO
D2FW-G273M
SPDT
D2FW-G071M
SPST-NC
D2FW-G072M
SPST-NO
D2FW-G073M
SPDT
D2FW-G281M
SPST-NC
D2FW-G282M
SPST-NO
D2FW-G283M
SPDT
D2FW-G081M
SPST-NC
D2FW-G082M
SPST-NO
D2FW-G083M
D2FW-G
D2FW-G
Specifications
Ratings
D2FW-G2j (general load models)
Rated voltage
g
Resistive load
30 VDC
Note:
1A
0.1 A
Voltage
g
Resistive load
Lamp load
Inductive load
Inductive load
Motor load
14 VDC
1.5 A
0.5 A
0.5 A
0.5 A
30 VDC
1 A
0.3 A
0.3 A
0.3 A
Note:
1. Inductive load has a power factor of 0.7 min. (AC) and a time constant of 7 ms max. (DC).
2. Lamp load has an inrush current of 10 times the steady-state current.
3. Motor load has an inrush current of 6 times the steady-state current.
Characteristics
Item
D2FW-G2j
D2FW-G0j
Operating speed
1 to 500 mm/s
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
Contact resistance
100 m max.
Dielectric strength
600 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between terminals of the same polarity
1,500 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between current-carrying metal parts and ground, and between
each terminal and non-current-carrying metal parts
Durability
y (see
(
note 3))
150 m max.
Degree of protection
IEC IP67
Class I
175
Weight
Note:
Contact Specifications
Item
Specification
Crossbar
Material
Silver alloy
0.25 mm
100 mA at 5 VDC
Note:
For more information on the minimum applicable load, refer to Using Micro Loads on page 249.
247
D2FW-G
D2FW-G
Contact Form
SPST-NC
SPDT
COM
(Black*)
COM
NO
NC
(Black*) (Blue*) (Red*)
SPST-NO
NC
(Red*)
COM
NO
(Black*) (Blue*)
Dimensions
Mounting Holes
Note:
16
4-dia. hole (depth 2 mm min.)
160.15
+0.2
4.2 0
dia.
4
0
0.15
dia.
5
+0.2
40
Free
Operating position
position (FP)
(OP)
D2FW-G
dia.
13.5
3.5R
30010
Molded lead wires
COM AVS0.5 (Black)
NO AVS0.5 (Blue)
NC AVS0.5 (Red)
248
(5)
4.7
15.3
23.5
8
5
Model
OF max.
2.45 N {{250 g
gf}}
RF min.
OT min.
1.0 mm
MD max.
1.0 mm
FP max.
15.5 mm
OP
11.52 mm
TTP
6.5
6
5 mm
(reference value)
D2FW-G
D2FW-G
Long Leaf Lever Models
D2FW-Gj8jM
(19)
160.15
8
5
Model
+0.2
4.2 0
dia.
4
0
0.15
dia.
5
4
+0.2
0
Free
position
Operating (FP)
position
(OP)
D2FW-G
dia.
13.5
3.5R
30010
Molded lead wires
COM AVS0.5 (Black)
NO AVS0.5 (Blue)
NC AVS0.5 (Red)
(5)
4.7
OF
2.94 N {{300 g
gf}}
RF min.
OT min.
1.0 mm
MD max.
1.0 mm
FP max.
19 mm
OP
122 mm
TTP
8.5
8
5 mm
(reference value)
15.3
23.5
Precautions
Refer to pages 26 to 31 for common precautions.
Cautions
Use the Switch within the specified electrical ratings. Using the
Switch outside of the rated values will not only shorten its service life
but may cause heat generation or fire damage. When turning the
power ON or OFF, use the rated voltage and current.
Degree of Protection
Do not use the Switch underwater. The Switch was tested and found
to meet the conditions necessary to meet the following standard.
The test checks for water intrusion after immersion for a specified
time period. The test does not check for switching operation underwater.
IEC Publication 529, degree of protection IP67.
Mounting
Turn OFF the power supply before mounting or removing the
Switch, wiring, or performing maintenance or inspection. Failure to
do so may result in electric shock or burning.
Use M4 mounting screws with plane washers or spring washers to
securely mount the Switch. Tighten the screws to a torque of 1.18
to1.47 Nm {12 to 15 kgfcm}.
Mount the Switch onto a flat surface. Mounting on an uneven surface may cause deformation of the Switch, resulting in faulty operation or breakage in the housing.
Voltage (V)
Correct Use
Operating
area of micro
load models
D2FW-G0j
Operating
area of
general-load
models
D2FW-G2j
Switch Mounting
When mounting the Switch, do not apply force to the actuator in any
direction other than its operating direction.
Operation
Make sure that the switching object is perfectly separated from the
actuator when the switch is not operated and the actuator is pressed
Current (mA)
249
D2A
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend
D2A-j1j0
1
1.
Switching Timing
1:
Non-shorting
2:
Shorting
2.
List of Models
Actuator
Pin plunger
250
D2A-1110
Shorting Model
D2A-2110
Shorting Model
D2A-2120
D2A
D2A
Specifications
Note:
Ratings
Electrical ratings 0.1 A at 30 VDC (resistive load)
Characteristics
Operating speed
1 to 500 mm/s
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
50 m max.
Dielectric strength
Vibration resistance
Shock resistance
Degree of protection
IEC IP00
Class III
175
Weight
Approx. 0.3 g
Note:
Contact Specifications
Contact specification
Slide
Contact material
Silver alloy
1 mA at 5 VDC
Note:
Contact Form
SPDT
NO COM NC
(3) (1) (2)
251
D2A
D2A
Dimensions
Mounting Holes
Note:
Mounting Holes
M2 tap
2.54
3.80.1
2.54
5.50.1
1.6 dia
4.2
D2A-1110/-1120
D2A-2110/2120
Released position
Operating position
Model
1.6
Non-shorting Models
D2A-1110
Shorting Models
D2A-1120
D2A-2110
D2A-2120
OF max.
0.98 N {{100 g
gf}}
0.49 N {50
{ gf}
g}
0.98 N {{100 g
gf}}
0.49 N {50
{ gf}
g}
RF min.
0.05 N {5 gf}
0.05 N {5 gf}
FP max.
9.5 mm
9.5 mm
OP1
8.10.3 mm
8.00.3 mm
OP2
7.40.3 mm
7.50.3 mm
TTP
6.50.2 mm
6.50.2 mm
Switching Timing
Non-shorting Model
(2) (NC) FP
(1)
(3) (NO)
252
OP1
OP2
Shorting Model
TTP
(2) (NC) FP
(1)
(3) (NO)
OP1
OP2
TTP
D2A
D2A
Precautions
Cautions
Terminal Connection
When soldering the lead wire to the terminal, first bind the lead wire
to the terminal and then apply the 6 (Sn) : 4 (Pb) solder to the terminal. Complete soldering within 5 s at a soldering iron temperature of
260C. Soldering at a temperature exceeding 260C, soldering for
more than 5 s, or repeated soldering will degrade the Switch characteristics.
When soldering the lead wire to the PCB terminal, pay careful attention so that the flux and solder liquid level does not exceed the PCB
level.
It is also recommended that you apply flux guard to the mounting
surface of the Switch.
Operating range
Correct Use
Inoperable
range
Mounting
Turn OFF the power supply before mounting or removing the
Switch, wiring, or performing maintenance or inspection. Failure to
do so may result in electric shock or burning.
Use M1.6 mounting screws with plane washers or spring washers to
securely mount the Switch. Tighten the screws to a torque of 4.9 to
9.8 102 N S m {0.5 to 1 kgf S cm}.
Mount the Switch onto a flat surface. Mounting on an uneven surface may cause deformation of the Switch, resulting in faulty operation or breakage in the housing.
Current (mA)
Incorrect
Correct
Mounting Plate
Use materials other than ABS or polycarbonate for the mounting
plate. Since grease is used for the Switch, cracks may be caused if
grease from the Switch comes in contact with such materials.
253
D3C
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend
D3C-j2j0
1
1.
Switching Timing
1:
Non-shorting
2:
Shorting
2.
List of Models
Actuator
Rotary lever
D3C-1210
Shorting Model
D3C-2210
Specifications
Ratings
Electrical ratings 0.1 A at 30 VDC (resistive load)
Note:
254
Shorting Model
D3C-2220
D3C
D3C
Characteristics
Operating speed
1 to 500 mm/s
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
50 m max.
Dielectric strength
Vibration resistance
Shock resistance
Degree of protection
IEC IP00
Class III
175
Weight
Approx. 0.3 g
Note:
Contact Specifications
Contact
Specification
Slide
Material
Silver plated
1 mA at 5 VDC
For more information on the minimum applicable load, refer to Using Micro Loads on page 257.
Contact Form
SPDT
NO COM NC
(3) (1) (2)
255
D3C
D3C
Dimensions
Mounting Holes
Note:
40.1
5.70.1
1.6 dia
D3C-1210/-2210
D3C-1220/-2220
+0.12
1.6 0
1-dia. hole
1R
4.7
PCB Dimensions
2.54
5.70.15
6
5.6
4.2
1.6
OP FP
2.54
40.15
4.6 max.
4.2
3.5
2.5 2.5
0.3
0.9
0.8
4
8
Model
Non-shorting Models
D3C-1210
Shorting Models
D3C-1220
D3C-2210
D3C-2220
OF max.
1.28 N {130
{
gf}
g } (0.98
(
N))
0.39 N {{40 g
gf}} ((0.29 N))
1.28 N {130
{
gf}
g } (0.98
(
N))
0.39 N {{40 g
gf}} ((0.29 N))
RF min.
FP max.
4.8 mm
4.8 mm
OP1
3.50.3 mm
3.40.3 mm
OP2
2.50.3 mm
2.60.3 mm
TTP
1.30.4 mm
1.30.4 mm
Note:
The values for operating characteristics apply for operation in the A direction ( ) shown above. The values in parentheses indicate
those for operation in the B direction ( ).
Switching Timing
Non-shorting Model
(2) (NC) FP
(1)
(3) (NO)
256
OP1
OP2
Shorting Model
TTP
(2) (NC) FP
(1)
(3) (NO)
OP1
OP2
TTP
D3C
D3C
Precautions
Cautions
Terminal Connection
When soldering the lead wire to the terminal, first bind the lead wire
to the terminal and then apply the 6 (Sn) : 4 (Pb) solder to the terminal. Complete soldering within 5 s at a soldering iron temperature of
260C. Soldering at a temperature exceeding 260C, soldering for
more than 5 s, or repeated soldering will degrade the Switch characteristics.
When soldering the lead wire to the PCB terminal, pay careful attention so that the flux and solder liquid level does not exceed the PCB
level.
It is also recommended that you apply flux guard to the mounting
surface of the Switch.
Operating range
Correct Use
Inoperable
range
Mounting
Turn OFF the power supply before mounting or removing the
Switch, wiring, or performing maintenance or inspection. Failure to
do so may result in electric shock or burning.
Use M1.6 mounting screws with plane washers or spring washers to
securely mount the Switch. Tighten the screws to a torque of 4.9 to
9.8 102 N S m {0.5 to 1 kgf S cm}.
Mount the Switch onto a flat surface. Mounting on an uneven surface may cause deformation of the Switch, resulting in faulty operation or breakage in the housing.
Current (mA)
Incorrect
Incorrect
Correct
Mounting Plate
Use materials other than ABS or polycarbonate for the mounting
plate. Since grease is used for the Switch, cracks may be caused if
grease from the Switch comes in contact with such materials.
257
D2X
Ordering Information
Model
D2X-C
Specifications
Ratings
30 VDC
Note:
Characteristics
Operating speed
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
200 m max.
Dielectric strength
Vibration resistance
Shock resistance
Degree of protection
IEC IP00
Class I
175
Weight
Approx. 1 g
Note:
258
D2X
D2X
Contact Specifications
Contact
Specification
Slide
Material
Gold plated
Contact Form
SPST-NC
Dimensions
Mounting Holes
Note:
4.8
3.5
80.1 dia.
12.9
+0.1
Two,
0.5R 4.4
3.2 0
dia.
3.2
4
2.70.1
5.2 10.8
Two,
0.5R
+0.1
0
4.9
Two, 0.6R
+0.8
0
Four, 1R
1.8
3.20.05 dia.
3.20.05 dia.
Two, 0.5R
Two, 0.5R 4.4
10.8
+0.8
0
Two,
1.6R
5
12.2
3.4
Two, 0.6R
259
D2X
D2X
Dimensions and Operating Characteristics
Note:
D2X-C
Direction A
TTP = 6.34 min. (equivalent to
a turning angle of 25)
Stroke measurement reference
position Direction B: 20
OP = 2.35 max. (equivalent to
a turning angle of 9)
4.8
6.34 mm
Direction B
0.52 min.
12.2
2.35 max.
2.35 max.
(17)
3.3
260
0.52 to 2.35 mm
TTP min.
Direction A
0.52 min.
OFF
3.8
5.8
0.02 N {2 gf}
OP
ON
11.9
RF min.
15
5.1
0.49 N {{50 g
gf}}
(0.2)
1.55
OF max.
0.4
6.2
D2X
D2X
Precautions
Refer to pages 26 to 31 for common precautions.
Correct Use
Wiring Connector
The operating object must fully press the lever when the operating
object travels and must be perfectly separated from the lever when
the operating object is in the free position. The operating object
must not be pressed excessively to exceed the TTP, otherwise the
D2X may be damaged. Be sure that the operating object imposes a
proper load on the lever according to the motion of the lever.
Lever Load
Do not impose loads in the following directions on the lever, otherwise the Switch may be damaged or malfunction.
Japan
Phone: 81-44-844-8111
U.S.A.
Phone: 1-800-522-6752
Great Britain
Phone: 44-208-954-2356
Hong Kong
Phone: 852-2735-1628
Operating Object
100 mA
30
Operating
range
Inoperable
range
Current (mA)
261
D3K
ensured
through
quick-connect
Ordering Information
Model
D3K-B
Note:
Minimum order
100
Specifications
Ratings
12 VDC
10 mA (resistive load)
Note: The ratings values apply under the following test conditions:
Ambient temperature: 202C
Ambient humidity: 655%
Operating frequency: 30 operations/min
Characteristics
Operating speed
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
200 m max.
Dielectric strength
Degree of protection
IEC IP00
Class III
175
10C to 70C (at ambient humidity of 60% max.) (with no icing or condensation)
Weight
Approx. 1 g
Note:
262
D3K
D3K
Contact Specifications
Contact
Specification
Slide
Material
Silver plated
Contact Form
1 mA at 5 VDC
Dimensions
Mounting Holes
Note:
2. The switch lever is set in the direction indicated by an arrow in the above illustrations.
Refer to the following mounting hole dimensions and be sure that the burred side is opposite to the Switch mounting side.
If further mounting security is required for the prevention of rattling, consult your OMRON sales representative.
By changing the 1.90.05-dia. hole to a 1.7 to 1.8-dia. hole, the pin on the Switch side will need to be pressed in. This will reduce the clattering of
the pin.
Two, 0.3R
max.
1.90.05 dia.
Two,
0.3R0.1
Two, 0.3R
max.
Two, 0.3R
max.
Two,
0.3R0.1
Two,
0.5R0.1
Two, 0.3R
max.
Two, 0.3R
max.
Two, 0.3R
max.
263
D3K
D3K
Dimensions and Operating Characteristics
Note:
D3K
3R
2.1
A
27.4
24.4
1.8
OF max.
0.03 N {3
{ gf}
g}
TTF max.
0.05 N {5 gf}
FP max.
28.7 mm {{50}}
OP
21.62 mm {{305}}
TTP max.
11.4 mm {5}
264
D3K
D3K
Precautions
Refer to pages 26 to 31 for common precautions.
Connector
Correct Use
Application of Operation Force to the Lever
Apply operation forces to the lever in its operating direction. Applying operating force to the lever in any other directions will damage
the Switch or cause malfunction.
Incorrect
Incorrect
Incorrect
Japan
Phone: 81-44-844-8111
U.S.A.
Phone: 1-800-522-6752
Great Britain
Phone: 44-208-954-2356
Hong Kong
Phone: 852-2735-1628
Voltage (V)
Operating range
Inoperable
range
Current (mA)
265
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend
D3D-@@1
1 2
1. Actuator
1:
Plunger
2:
Lever
2. Contact Form
1:
SPDT
2:
SPST-NC
3:
SPST-NO
List of Models
Actuator
Contact form
SPDT
SPST-NC
SPST-NO
Plunger
D3D-111
D3D-121
D3D-131
Lever
D3D-211
D3D-221
D3D-231
266
D3D
D3D
D3D
Specifications
Ratings
Rated voltage
Resistive load
125 VAC
1A
250 VAC
0.5 A
Note
Characteristics
Operating speed
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
100 m max.
Dielectric strength
1,000 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between terminals of the same polarity
1,500 VAC, 50/60 Hz for 1 min between current-carrying metal parts and ground, and between
each terminal and non-current-carrying metal parts
Vibration resistance
Shock resistance
(see note 2)
Durability
(see note 3)
Degree of protection
IP40
600
85% max.
Weight
Approx. 4 g
Note:
Approved Standards
Contact Form
SPDT
NC
125 VAC
1A
COM
250 VAC
0.5 A
NO
SPST-NC
D3D
125 VAC
1A
250 VAC
0.5 A
NC
Contact Specifications
Contact
Specification
Crossbar
Material
Gold alloy
COM
SPST-NO
1 mA at 5 VDC
For more information on the minimum applicable load, refer to Using Micro Loads on page 269.
COM
NO
267
D3D
D3D
Dimensions
Note:
Plunger Models
D3D-111
D3D-121
D3D-131
Type
Plunger model
25
R3
11.4
OF max.
TTF max.
15
13.5
1.5
15.750.2
R0.5
6.5
TT
OP2 OP1
(See (See
note.) note.)
OP min.
2
15
10
11
13 mm
12 mm
Lever Models
D3D-211
D3D-221
D3D-231
Type
25
2
(90)
11.4
90.5
R1
5.5
15
1.5
OF max.
TTF max.
TT
OP2 OP1
(See (See
note.) note.)
15.70.5
3
OP min.
2
15
10
11
11.2+0.1
0
R1 MAX.
Switch insertion
direction
t
t = 0.8 to 1.5 mm
268
D3D-221 D3D-231
13 mm
11.5 mm
Note
Lever model
Model D3D-211
Connectors
D3D
D3D
Precautions
Cautions
Handling
Do not expose the Switch to shocks, such as by dropping it. Doing
so may damage or deform the Switch.
Do not apply lubrication to the sliding parts, such as pushbuttons
or actuators. Doing so may result in faulty operation or contact
failure.
In order to ensure stable contact force for NO contacts, use an
operating stroke of at least 5 mm.
Correct Use
Mounting
This product does not have a waterproof or drip-proof construction. Ensure that water does not enter the Switch interior. In particular, do not use the Switch in locations where water may be
spilt or flow over the Switch. Doing so may result in deterioration
of the insulation.
Wiring
Do not use the Switch with a large force applied to the connector
or lead wire. Doing so may result in rattling or contact failure.
Storage Environment
Storing the Switch in a plastic bag will help prevent discoloration
due to sulfuration of the (silver-plated) terminals.
Do not use the Switch in locations subject to harmful gases or to
high temperatures or humidity levels. Depending on the location,
it is recommended that Switches are inspected between 3 and 6
months after the date of manufacturer.
269
D2D
RCWE
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend
D2D-jj0j
1
1.
Construction
1:
Single pole, 3-mm contact gap
2:
Pull-on-lock type, 1-mm contact gap
3:
Double-pole, 3-mm contact gap
2.
Mounting
0:
Screw mounting
1:
Panel snap-fit mounting
3.
Contact Form
0:
SPDB-NO/NC
1:
SPDB-NO
2:
SPDB-NC
3:
SPDB-NO+SPDB-NO/NC
4:
DPDB-NO
List of Models
Mounting method
Contact form
Standard
Panel mounting
g
Note:
270
Contact gap: 1 mm
SPDB-NO/NC
D2D-1000
D2D-2000
SPDB-NO
D2D-1001
---
SPDB-NC
D2D-1002
---
SPDB-NO/NC
D2D-1100
D2D-2100
SPDB-NO
D2D-1101
---
SPDB-NC
D2D-1102
---
SPDB-NO+SPDB-NO/NC
D2D-3103
---
DPDB-NO
D2D-3104
---
D2D
D2D
Specifications
Ratings
Item
Type
Resistive load
Rated voltage
Standard
250 VAC
16 A
Pull-on lock
250 VAC
10 A
Note:
Voltage
g
Non-inductive load
Inductive load
Resistive load
NC
Standard
Pull-on lock
Note:
Motor load
NO
NC
NO
125 VAC
16 A
4A
250 VAC
16 A
4A
125 VAC
10 A
---
250 VAC
10 A
---
Characteristics
Item
D2D-1000 models
D2D-2000 models
D2D-3000 models
Operating speed
10 mm to 1 m/s
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
Contact resistance
(initial value)
50 m max.
Dielectric
strength
s
e g
(50/60 Hz
H
1mm)
Between terminals
of same polarity
2,000 VAC
1,000 VAC
2,000 VAC
Between terminals
and ground (see
note 2)
2,000 VAC
1,500 VAC
2,000 VAC
Between terminals
and non-currentcarrying metal part
2,500 VAC
1,500 VAC
---
Between terminals
and actuator
4,000 VAC
---
4,000 VAC
Vibration resistance
Shock resistance
Degree of protection
IEC IP40
Class II
175
Weight
Approx. 14 g (D2D-1000)
Note:
271
D2D
D2D
Approved Standards
Contact Specifications
D2D-1000
D2D-2000
Contact
D2D-3000
125 VAC
---
---
3/4 HP
250 VAC
16 A
10 A
16 A
A,
1-1/2 HP
D2D-1000
16 (4) A
D2D-2000
10 A
D2D-3000
16 (4) A
D2D-3104
4A
Contact Form
272
SPDB-NO/NC
SPDB-NO
SPDB-NO
+SPDB-NO/NC
DPDB-NO
Item
SPDB-NC
Inrush
currentt
Pull-on lock
model
Specification
Rivet
Material
Silver
Gap
(standard value)
3 mm min.
1 mm
NC
30 A max.
24 A max.
NO
30 A max.
24 A max.
Standard
model
160 mA at 5 VDC
For more information on the minimum applicable load, refer to Using Micro Loads on page 277.
D2D
D2D
70,000
50,000
30,000
10,000
7,000
5,000
3,000
1,000
10
20
30
40 50
60
70
80
90 100
OT (%)
State
Pull
Connection
NO-NO
ON
OFF
ON
NC-NC
OFF
ON
OFF
Example of D2D-1000.
273
D2D
D2D
Dimensions
Mounting Holes
Note:
13.5 0.1
2.2 0.1
Note
Note:
1.3 R max.
Standard Models
Screw Mounting
220.1
D2D-1000
D2D-1001
D2D-1002
16
8 dia.
A
13
4.30.05 dia.
1.8
FP
OP
5.8
TTP
23.6
33.6
10.4
25.2
Four quick-connect
terminals (#250)
30
Note:
6.350.1
+0.1
1.65 0
dia.
12.4
NC-OFF: The force applied to the actuator to cause it to move from the free position to the position at which the NC contact opens.
NO-ON: The force applied to the actuator to cause it to move from the free position to the position at which the NO contact closes.
Model
Screw mounting
D2D-1000
OF max.
D2D-1001
D2D-1002
NC-OFF
2.94 N {{300 g
gf}}
---
2.94 N {{300 g
gf}}
NO-ON
5.88 N {{600 g
gf}}
5.88 N {{600 g
gf}}
---
TTF max.
OT min.
2.3 mm
2.3 mm
5.5 mm
FP max.
16.4 mm
17 mm
16.4 mm
15.90.4 mm
---
15.90.4 mm
12.70.4 mm
12.70.4 mm
---
10 mm
10 mm
10 mm
OP
NC-OFF
NO-ON
TTP max.
274
D2D
D2D
Panel Mounting
400.1
8 dia.
D2D-1100
D2D-1101
D2D-1102
21.2
A
2.0
FP
OP
TTP
21.8
31.7
6.350.1
10.4
25.2
1.65 +0.1
0
dia.
12.4
30
Four quick-connect
terminals (#250)
Model
Panel mounting
D2D-1100
D2D-1101
D2D-1102
NC-OFF
2.94 N {{300 g
gf}}
---
2.94 N {{300 g
gf}}
NO-ON
5.88 N {{600 g
gf}}
5.88 N {{600 g
gf}}
---
TTF max.
OT min.
2.3 mm
2.3 mm
5.5 mm
FP max.
12.4 mm
13 mm
12.4 mm
NC-OFF
11.90.4 mm
---
11.90.4 mm
NO-ON
8.70.4 mm
8.70.4 mm
---
6 mm
6 mm
6 mm
OF max.
OP
TTP max.
Panel Mounting
40
Model
5.6 dia.
D2D-3103
OF max.
21.20.2
A
FP
OP
TTP
D2D-3103
NC-OFF
NC
OFF
NO-ON
TTF max.
OT min.
2.3 mm
FP max.
OP
31
TTP max.
41.5
+0.1
8.8
6.350.1
22.8
13
1.65 0
12.4 mm
NC-OFF
11.90.8 mm
NO-ON
8.70.8 mm
6.4 mm
dia.
31.6
34.4
Six quick-connect
terminals (#250)
275
D2D
D2D
Panel Mounting
40
5.6 dia.
D2D-3104
Model
21.20.2
D2D-3104
OF max.
A
FP
OP
TTP
NC-OFF
---
NO-ON
TTF max.
OT min.
2.3 mm
FP max.
OP
31
41.5
13.5 mm
NC-OFF
---
NO-ON
8.70.8 mm
TTP max.
+0.1
1.65 0
6.350.1
8.8
6.4 mm
dia.
13
31.6
Four quick-connect
terminals (#250)
34.4
Momentary Operation
(Normal Operation)
220.1
D2D-2000
16
8 dia.
Model
A
TTP
(see
note)
OP
(see
note)
FP
OP
13
4.30.05 dia.
1.8
5.8
OF
max.
D2D-2000
1.96 N
{200 gf}
1.96 N
{200 gf}
NO-ON
2.94 N
{300 gf}
2.94 N
{300 gf}
TTF max.
5.88 N
{600 gf}
5.88 N
{600 gf}
OT min.
4.5 mm
4.5 mm
FP max.
14.3 mm
10.3 mm
OP
NC-OFF
13.5
0.6 mm
9.50.6 mm
NO-ON
12.7
0.6 mm
8.70.6 mm
8.3 mm
4.3 mm
TTP
23.6
33.6
Note:
+0.1
6.350.1 1.65 0 dia.
10.4
25.2
Four quick-connect
terminals (#250)
400.1
8 dia.
D2D-2100
A
TTP
(see
note)
OP
(see
note)
Model
2.0
FP
OP
TTP
21.8
31.7
10.4
25.2
Note:
+0.1
6.350.1
12.4
30
Four quick-connect
terminals (#250)
276
TTP max.
12.4
30
Panel Mounting
D2D-2100
NC-OFF
1.65 0
dia.
D2D-2000
D2D-2100
OF max.
PT max.
2 mm
OT min.
0.4 mm
MD max.
1.5 mm
FP max.
14.3 mm
10.3 mm
OP
15 10 6 mm
15.10.6
11 10 6 mm
11.10.6
TTP max.
16.5 mm
12.5 mm
D2D
D2D
Precautions
Refer to pages 26 to 31 for common precautions.
Correct Use
Mounting
Apply operation force to the pin plunger in the direction it operates.
Applying forces laterally or from an oblique direction may damage
the pin plunger.
Incorrect
Correct
Incorrect
Voltage (V)
Inoperable
range
Operating
range
Current (mA)
277
D2T
RCW
Ordering Information
Model Number Legend
D2T-jT1j
1
1.
Actuator
None: Pin plunger
L:
Hinge lever
2.
Terminals
None: Right-angled solder terminals
S:
Straight solder terminals
List of Models
Actuator (see note)
Pin plunger
D2T-T1
D2T-T1S
Hinge lever
D2T-LT1
D2T-LT1S
Note:
278
The actuator of the D2T is identical to that used for OMRONs V Snap-action Switches. The actuator can be replaced with other types of
actuators. Consult your OMRON sales representatives for details.
D2T
D2T
Specifications
Ratings
Rated voltage
Resistive load
250 VAC
5A
125 VAC
0.1 A
Note:
Voltage
g
Between terminals 1 and 2
250 VAC
125 VAC
5A
5A
--0.1 A
30 VDC
6A
0.1 A
Characteristics
Operating speed
Operating frequency
Insulation resistance
Degree of protection
IEC IP40
Class I
175
Weight
Note:
50 m max.
100 m max.
279
D2T
D2T
Approved Standards
Contact Specifications
Item
Contact
Between
terminals 1 and 2
Between
terminals 3 and 4
125 VAC
5A
250 VAC
5A
---
Between
terminals 1 and 2
Between
terminals 3 and 4
125 VAC
---
0.1 A
250 VAC
5A
---
Rivet
Material
Silver
Gap
(standard value)
1 mm
1.4 mm
Inrush current
60 A max.
---
160 mA at
5 VDC
1 mA at 5 VDC
Contact Form
DPST-NO
COM
COM
NO
NO
Terminal 1 Terminal 3 Terminal 4 Terminal 2
Micro load
Power load
Note:
The circuit switching power loads has a snap-action mechanism and the circuit switching micro loads has a slow-action mechanism.
Dimensions
Note:
Terminals
Angled Terminals
2.80.1
Straight Terminals
1.2-dia.
hole
2.6-dia. hole
7.10.1
1
Solder terminal
t=0.5
280
2.6-dia. hole
7.10.1
1.2-dia. hole
2.80.1
Solder terminal
t=0.5
Between
terminals 3
and 4
Specification
Between
terminals 1
and 2
Plated
D2T
D2T
Mounting Holes
Panel Cutout Dimensions
(Panel thickness: 1.5 to 2 mm)
11.9 0
26.40.1
+0.2
31.0 0
Model
D2T-T1
D2T-T1S
26.40.15
3.40.15 dia.
A
3.1 +0.13
0.03
dia. holes
Two, 2.5R
15.350.2
2.80.1 1.2 hole
t=0.5
Solder terminal
OF max.
3.24 N {{330 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.5 N {50
{ gf}
g}
TTF max.
OT min.
0.8 mm
OP
4.40.6 mm
(see note)
Note:
Model
t = 0.5
(Stainlesssteel lever)
D2T-LT1
D2T-LT1S
2.6
hole
30.90.8
D2T-LT1
D2T-LT1S
OF max.
1.47 N {{150 g
gf}}
RF min.
0.2 N {20
{ gf}
g}
TTF max.
OT min.
1.6 mm
OP
6.91.3 mm
(see note)
Note:
t=0.5
Solder terminal
D2T-T1
D2T-T1S
Precautions
Refer to pages 26 to 31 for common precautions.
Correct Use
Mounting
Use M3 mounting screws to mount the Switch. Tighten the screws
to a torque of 0.4 to 0.6 N S m {4 to 6 kgf S cm}.
Mounting Holes
When mounting on a metal surface, be sure to provide a Separator
between the Switch and mounting plate.
281
Connectors
Connectors
Connectors
Microswitches for tab-terminals listed in this catalog are compatible with other companies products. The following AMP-made Connectors are
also available. For more details about AMP Connectors, contact one of the addresses listed below.
Tyco Electronics/AMP
Japan
Phone: 81-44-844-8013
Great Britain
Phone: 44-208-954-2356
Hong Kong
Phone: 852-2735-1628
U.S.A.
Phone: 1-800-522-6752
Note:
282
Other companies products are listed in this catalog as general user information. We assume no responsibility for the quality or price of
other companies products.